Professional Documents
Culture Documents
INTRODUCTION 1
DONATION PLEA 2
ANAESTHETICS 3
BREAST SURGERY 13
CANCER MEDICINE 27
CARDIOLOGY 72
ANGINA PECTORIS 73
AORTIC REGURGITATION (AR) 77
AORTIC STENOSIS (AS) 79
ATRIAL TACHYCARDIAS 80
BUNDLE BRANCH BLOCK 82
CARDIOGENIC SHOCK (ACUTE HEART FAILURE) 83
CHRONIC HEART FAILURE 85
INFECTIVE ENDOCARDITIS (IE) 90
MITRAL REGURGITATION (MR) 93
MITRAL STENOSIS (MS) 95
MYOCARDIAL INFARCTION (MI) 97
PULMONARY OEDEMA 101
UNSTABLE ANGINA 103
VENTRICULAR TACHYARRHYTHMIAS 104
WOLFF-PARKINSON-WHITE (WPW) SYNDROME 107
DERMATOLOGY 108
ENDOCRINOLOGY 127
ACROMEGALY 128
ADDISON’S DISEASE 130
CUSHING’S SYNDROME 133
DIABETES 136
COMPARING T1DM AND T2DM 136
CLINICAL PRESENTATION 136
INVESTIGATION OF DIABETES 137
IMPAIRED GLUCOSE TOLERANCE (IGT) 138
PRINCIPLES OF INSULIN TREATMENT 138
MEDICATION FOR DIABETES 140
COMPLICATIONS OF INSULIN THERAPY 142
TREATMENT OF HYPOGLYCAEMIA 143
THE DIABETIC DIET 143
MACROVASCULAR COMPLICATIONS OF DIABETES 144
MICROVASCULAR COMPLICATIONS OF DIABETES 146
MONITORING THE CONTROL OF DIABETES 151
DIABETIC KETOACIDOSIS (DKA) 152
NON-KETOTIC HYPEROSMOLAR STATE 155
GOITRE 156
GOUT AND HYPERURICAEMIA 159
HYPERCALCAEMIA 162
HYPERPROLACTINAEMIA 166
HYPERTHYROIDISM 168
HYPOCALCAEMIA 173
HYPOPITUITARISM 175
HYPOTHYROIDISM 177
MYXOEDEMA COMA 180
OSTEOPOROSIS 181
PAGET’S DISEASE 185
PITUITARY SPACE-OCCUPYING LESIONS AND TUMOURS 187
REGULATION OF CALCIUM METABOLISM 189
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
GASTROENTEROLOGY 191
GI SURGERY 387
Introduction
garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk
http://www.igarry.com
I should also add that these notes are not endorsed by Imperial
College in any way. Just thought I’d add that .
1
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Donation plea
Remember…
garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk
or visit:
http://www.igarry.com
(where there are some forums to chat on as well!)
2
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Anaesthetics
3
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Postoperative pain:
• This is best dealt with by preventing it happening in the first
place
• The patient who wakes up in severe pain following surgery
can be a difficult problem and the mainstay of dealing with
this sort of occurrence is the IV administration of opioid drugs
(e.g. morphine), larger doses of which may be necessary
Trauma pain:
• Anaesthetists are most likely to encounter a trauma patient in
pain when in the process of resuscitation or in preparation for
theatre
• It is important that analgesia in these circumstances does not
interfere with the resuscitation process or mask important
diagnostic signs in the patient
• For example, the use of IV morphine to treat a man with a
fractured femur, shock and head injury may lower his BP
further, depress his level of consciousness, interfere with
neurological observations and increase the risk of
regurgitation and aspiration of gastric contents
• It is still important to treat pain in these circumstances,
however, and a nerve block with local anaesthetics is often
the technique of choice
Labour pain:
• The pain of childbirth is, at its worst, one of the most severe
pains that can be experienced, and very few mothers are
lucky enough to go through labour without the need for some
form of analgesia
• Several features distinguish the pain of labour from the other
forms of pain:
o It gets worse, not better, with time
o It is non-pathological
o Is associated with a happy outcome
o Its relief must not result in compromise to the baby
o Its relief should not interfere with the ability of the
mother to share in the birth experience
• This means that the ideal pain relief in labour must be very
potent, very safe and not have any depressant effect upon the
CNS
• This is where regional block, in the form of epidural or spinal
anaesthesia, comes into its own
4
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Simple analgesic drugs:
• E.g. aspirin and paracetamol
• Are of little use when dealing with severe pain
• They are not strong enough and they can usually only be
administered orally, a route which is certainly not practical
following major surgery
• However, it is important not to forget these drugs in the
postoperative period; while recovery from painful surgery,
most patients need a ‘halfway’ drug to tide them over the
period between opioid usage and total freedom from pain
Opioids:
• Of the drugs available, morphine is the most commonly
prescribed in the UK. It has a duration of action of ~3-4 hours
following a single IM dose
• Diamorphine (heroin) is a powerful analgesic with some
advantages over morphine. However, its association with
addiction and abuse have, probably unfairly, somewhat
restricted its use
• Pethidine, used especially in labour, is slightly shorter-acting
and has atropine-like properties:
o Bronchodilation
o Tachycardia
o Reduction in secretions
• Pethidine derivatives (e.g. fentanyl and alfentanil) are very
potent, short-acting opioids that tend to be used
intraoperatively, although they can be used postoperatively
via the epidural/spinal route
• Opioid drugs may be administered via a variety of routes:
o IM:
• Painful
• Lag time of ~20 minutes
5
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Only effective if the muscle is well perfused
o IV:
• No lag time
• Can be painlessly via an indwelling cannula
• The dose can be accurately titrated
• No reliance on adequate tissue perfusion
o Infusions:
• Designed to maintain a constant blood level of
analgesia
o Patient-controlled analgesia (PCA):
• A syringe is filled with a large quantity of
morphine and connected to the patient via an
indwelling cannula
• The patient is given a button which, when
pressed, delivers a fixed small dose of morphine
• The machine ‘locks out’ for a short period of time
to give the dose a chance to achieve its effect
(usually 5 minutes), and then the patient may
take another dose if needed
• A typical prescription would allow 1mg of
morphine to be taken every 5 minutes, thus
allowing the patient up to 12mg/hour
o Epidural/spinal:
• Receptors for opioids are found in high
concentrations in the spinal cord, and small doses
of these drugs can have profound analgesic
effects when administered into the epidural or
intrathecal (spinal) regions
• A dose of morphine as small as 0.2mg (1/50th of
the IM dose) can produce highly effective pain
relief for 24 hours following lower abdominal
surgery
Side-effects of opioids:
• Sedation
• Respiratory depression
• Nausea and vomiting
• Itching
• Urinary retention
• Histamine release
• Miosis
6
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• This is achieved by intermittently inflating the lungs with a
positive pressure delivered by a ventilator and applied via an
endotracheal tube or a tracheostomy
• A number of refinements and modifications of IPPV have
been introduced with:
o Positive end-expiratory pressure (PEEP)
o Intermittent mandatory ventilation (IMV)
o High-frequency jet ventilation (HFJV)
• The rational use of IPPV depends on a clear understanding of
its potential beneficial effects as well as its dangers
Institution of IPPV:
• Requires endotracheal intubation
• Intubating patients in severe respiratory failure is an
extremely hazardous undertaking and should only be
performed by experienced staff
7
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• It extreme emergencies, it may be preferable to ventilate the
patient by hand using and oropharyngeal airway, a face mask
and a self-inflating bag until experienced help arrives
• The patient is usually hypoxic and hypercarbic, with increased
sympathetic activity:
o The stimulus of laryngoscopy and intubation can
precipitate dangerous arrhythmias and even cardiac
arrest
o ECG and O2 saturation should be monitored
o Patient should be preoxygenated with 100% O2 before
intubation
o In some deeply comatose patients, no sedation will be
required but in the majority of patients, a short-acting
IV anaesthetic agent followed by muscle relaxation will
be necessary
• Endotracheal tubes can now be left safely in place for several
weeks and tracheostomy is, therefore, less often performed
• Tracheostomy may be required for the long-term control of
excessive bronchial secretions and/or to maintain an airway
and protect the lungs in those with impaired pharyngeal and
laryngeal reflexes
• Tracheostomy can be performed surgically, the trachea being
opened through the second, third and fourth tracheal rings via
a small transverse skin incision, or percutaneously using a
guidewire and a series of dilators
• Tracheostomy has a mortality rate of up to 3%
• A life-threatening obstruction of the upper airway that cannot
be bypassed with an endotracheal tube should have a
cricothyroidotomy
Dangers of IPPV:
• Airway complications
• Disconnection, failure of gas or power supply, mechanical
faults
• CVS complications:
o The intermittent application of positive pressure
impedes venous return and distends alveoli, thereby
‘stretching’ the pulmonary capillaries and causing a rise
in pulmonary vascular resistance
o This produces a fall in cardiac output
• Respiratory complications:
o V/Q mismatching
o Collapse of peripheral alveoli
o Secondary pulmonary infection
• Barotrauma:
8
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Pneumothorax
o Pneumomediastinum
o Pneumoperitoneum
o Subcutaneous emphysema
• GI complications:
o Abdominal distension associated with an ileus
o Unknown cause
• Salt and water retention:
o Increases secretion of ADH
o Decreases secretion of ANP
o The fluid retention is often particularly noticeable in the
lungs
9
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Preoperative grading
10
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Definitions:
• Local anaesthesia:
o The use of a drug to produce anaesthesia by topical
application, infiltration or ring block
• Regional anaesthesia:
o Is a term reserved to describe major nerve blocks or
spinal/epidural techniques
o However, the terms are often used interchangeably
Advantages Disadvantages
Avoids adverse effects of general Toxicity of local anaesthetic
anaesthetic agents: drugs
• Respiratory depression
• CVS depression
• Nausea/vomiting
• ‘Hangover’
Avoids potential hazards of Often difficult techniques:
unconsciousness: • More risk of failure or
• Loss of airway partial success
• Aspiration • More discomfort while
• Damage to joints through performing block
malpositioning • May take longer to
establish
Minimises endocrine stress Greater co-operation needed
response to surgery from patient
Decreased postoperative pain Sets time limit for surgery
Earlier discharge from hospital Restricts flexibility of surgeon if
operation needs to be more
extensive
• Regional anaesthesia:
o Marked vasodilatation – fall in BP
11
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Major nerve compression – haematoma or abscess
formation
o Large doses may be needed – risk of overdosage
• Effects of overdose:
o CVS:
• Bradycardia
• Fall in cardiac contractility – hypotension
• Cardiac arrest
• NB: Cocaine and adrenaline-containing solutions cause
tachycardia and hypertension
o CNS:
• Paraesthesiae (especially around the mouth)
• Anxiety
• Tremors
• Fitting
• Coma
12
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Breast Surgery
13
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
The first follows the pattern of the menstrual cycle; the second is
random in timing
Cyclical pain:
• Most commonly affects women <35 years of age
• Onset is during the early phase of the cycle; intensity
gradually worsens to reach a peak just before menstruation,
easing with the start of the period
• In mild cases, the pain affects the upper outer quadrants of
the breasts
• In severe cases, the whole breast may feel engorged, tender
and heavy and physical contact can be unbearable
• Post-menopausal women on HRT can get cyclical breast pain
• Examination:
o Tenderness and a firm nodular feel in the upper outer
quadrants of the breast
14
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Bromocriptine:
• Gradually increasing doses up to a maximum of 5mg
daily po
• Blocks the pituitary drive to produce FSH and LH
o Bromocriptine and Danazol can cause menopausal-like
symptoms
Non-cyclical pain:
• May be intermittent or constant and is confined to localised
areas of one breast
• It can be caused by conditions both within and without the
breast, including:
o Mammary duct ectasia
o Periductal mastitis
o Trauma
o Tietze’s disorder – characterised by tenderness over
costochondral junctions
• It is often difficult to identify a specific cause of non-cyclical
pain
15
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Lumpiness:
• Can present on its own but is frequently associated with
cyclical breast pain
• It is a manifestation of the cyclical changes that go on in the
female breast during the menstrual years
• A variety of descriptive terms have been applied to it:
o Fibroadenosis
o Cystic mastopathy
o Fibrocystic disease
o Cystic mastitis
• All are merely descriptive of the changes seen to a varying
degree on histological examination and do not give any
insight into cause
16
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cysts
Clinical features:
• The history is of a palpable and occasionally tender lump
• Physical findings are of a tense, discrete, mobile lump
anywhere in the breast
17
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Duct papilloma
Clinical features:
• There is a serous or bloodstained discharge from a single
aspect of the nipple, although the patient may not realise that
the discharge is localised
• Other symptoms are rarely present
• The breast is normal, but there is either the spontaneous
appearance of discharge from one aspect of the nipple or
‘milking’ of a segment produces nipple discharge from the
duct draining that segment
Investigations:
• The main concern, particularly if the discharge is
bloodstained, is that occasionally there is an underlying
malignancy, although duct papilloma is benign
• Investigations are the same as for mammary duct ectasia
• In spite of negative cytological findings, it is nearly always
necessary (in a bloodstained single duct discharge) to excise
the involved system to establish that a papilloma is present
18
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Fibroadenoma
These tend to affect younger women and are infrequent after about
35-40 years of age
Pathological features:
• Many remain static
• A small proportion either regress or increase in size
• In developing countries, they may reach a mass larger than
the breast in which the growth occurs
Clinical features:
• Generally the patient discovers a painless lump
• Well-defined lump
• Consistency is rubbery to firm or hard
• There is much mobility (it may be difficult to find) – hence the
nickname ‘breast mouse’
19
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Fibroadenosis
History:
• Usually, the upper outer quadrants are affected but, as with
pain, one side alone may be involved
• Young
• Often in the early years after the menarche
Physical findings:
• May be single or multiple lumps in one or both breasts
• May be acutely tender (particularly premenstrually)
Investigations:
• Mammography:
o Is indicated in those >40 years of age
o In a lumpy breast, the appearances are those of dense
fibrosis with micro- or macrocystic change
• Ultrasound:
o Indicated in those <40 years of age
o May show cystic changes
• Fine needle aspiration cytology (FNAC):
o Suspicious areas are aspirated under image control
o Typical findings are of benign cells
Management:
• Reassurance that the changes are part of the normal
spectrum of the breast’s response to female sex hormones
• If there is associated pain in a large breast, firm support may
help
20
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Galactorrhoea
Management:
• Bromocriptine is used until the discharge subsides
• Prolactinomas should be considered in long persistent
discharge, but are rare
21
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
22
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Periductal mastitis:
• This condition affects young women in their 30s and is
associated with smoking
• Is characterised histologically by a low-grade inflammatory
response around the ducts adjacent to the nipple
• The bacteria involved are nearly always anaerobes
23
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
History:
• The discharge can range from milky to dirty green
• Is often (but not always) bilateral
• Occasionally it is associated with pain, usually cyclical
• Acute infection causes pain and swelling
Physical findings:
• The breast may have features of lumpiness
• Nipple retraction:
o Caused by the chronic inflammation often associated
with this condition
o Slit-like appearance
o May be confused with carcinoma
• In acute inflammation, an abscess forms which, if not treated
at am early stage, discharges at the areolar margin:
o A small sinus (mammary fistula) then results which can
be the focus of further attacks of inflammation
Abscess:
• An abscess in this condition is followed by a mammary fistula
• In consequence, after drainage there is not only often a
persistent discharge but also the risk of recurrence
• The involved duct and its drainage area should be excised
electively
24
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Nipple discharge
25
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Trauma to the breast is relatively rare, although sexual
encounters and love bites may be responsible for local injury
• A blunt impact can interfere with local blood supply and,
together with a haematoma, cause fat necrosis
• Another cause is the use of therapeutic anticoagulants in
patients with very large and pendulous breasts in which very
minor trauma may precipitate extensive haemorrhage which
may go on to necrosis
Clinical features:
• Fat necrosis causes a hard, painful lump, usually following a
story of minor local trauma
• A hard lump is often found, with some irregularity and
occasionally tethering to the overlying skin
• The appearances are suggestive of a carcinoma but the
condition can usually be distinguished because of the history
of trauma, associated bruising and resolution of the lump with
observation
26
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cancer Medicine
27
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute leukaemias
Clinical features:
• The symptoms of acute leukaemia are a consequence of bone
marrow failure:
o Symptoms of anaemia:
• Tiredness
• Weakness
• Exertional dyspnoea
o Repeated infections
• There may be few or no abnormal physical signs; but patients
often have:
o Signs of anaemia
o Bruises, petechial haemorrhages, purpura, fundal
haemorrhages
o Signs of infection
o Occasionally, lymph node enlargement and/or
hepatosplenomegaly
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Low Hb
o WCC (may be raised, normal or low)
o Thrombocytopenia
• Peripheral blood film:
o Shows characteristic leukaemic blast cells
• Bone marrow aspirate:
o Shows increased cellularity with abnormal lymphoid or
myeloid blast cells
28
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
may develop a ‘tumour lysis’ syndrome when
chemotherapy is given:
• Hypercalcaemia
• Hyperphosphataemia
• Hyperkalaemia
• All resulting from a high rate of cellular breakdown
• Is potentially life-threatening and difficult to treat
once it has occurred
Classification:
• Leukaemia can be divided on the basis of the speed of
evolution of the disease into acute or chronic
• Each of these is then further subdivided into myeloid or
lymphoid, according to the cell type involved. Hence the
terms:
o Acute myelogenous leukaemia (AML)
o Acute lymphoblastic leukaemia (ALL)
o Chronic myeloid leukaemia (CML)
o Chronic lymphocytic leukaemia (CLL)
29
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Predominantly a disease of children
• Is potentially curable
• 90% of children respond to treatment and 50-60% are cured
• The cure rate in adults is only about 30%
Treatment:
• The principles of initial treatment are the same as those for
AML
• Cyclical chemotherapy comprising:
o Vincristine
o Prednisolone
o L-asparaginase
o Doxorubicin
• The sequence of treatment, however, is different to AML
because ALL has a propensity for involvement of the CNS,
thus treatment includes prophylactic intrathecal drugs (e.g.
methotrexate)
• Most patients receive oral maintenance therapy for 2-3 years
Treatment at recurrence:
• A proportion of patients are cured with the initial therapy
• In the rest, the disease recurs and ultimately proves fatal
unless a second remission can be achieved (high-dose
treatment and some form of transplant procedure)
• With such treatment, a further 20-30% of patients will survive
long-term
30
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• AML is a potentially curable disease
• More common in older adults
• Is classified on the basis of the morphological appearance of
the bone marrow into 7 subtypes (M1-M7), which differ by
virtue of the predominant cell type involved
Treatment:
Treatment has traditionally been divided as being in 2 parts –
remission induction (complete remission, CR) and post-remission/
consolidation therapy
• The reason for the continuation of therapy post-remission is
as follows:
o At the point of CR (when there is no morphologically
detectable leukaemia) there are still 108 or109
leukaemic blast cells present.
o It is, therefore, not surprising that if no post-remission
therapy is given, the majority of patients develop
recurrent leukaemia
• Induction of remission is via chemotherapy:
o An anthracycline drug (e.g. doxorubicin) in conjunction
with cytarabine, with or without another drug (e.g.
etoposide)
o Patient needs to stay in hospital for 4 weeks in the first
instance owing to the risk of infection and bleeding
consequent upon neutropenia and thrombocytopenia
o Subsequent cycles of treatment are given on an
outpatient basis
• Options for post-remission therapy include:
o Further cycles of the same chemotherapy used to
induce remission
o Chemotherapy different from that given to induce
remission
o Myeloablative therapy with allogeneic/autologous bone
marrow transplantation (BMT)
Prognosis:
• Approx. 70% of patients <60 years of age will return to
normal health
• However, within 1-3 years the disease will recur in at least
60% (the remainder almost certainly having been cured
• In younger patients with a recurrence, cure is still possible for
a proportion, using myeloablative therapy with
31
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
allogeneic/autologous haemopoietic progenitor cell support
(HPCS)
32
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• Has a specific association with disseminated intravascular
coagulation (DIC)
• Patients may present with severe bleeding which worsens
when treatment is started as the leukaemic blast cells break
down, leading to further consumption of clotting factors and
platelets
Treatment:
• Regular, twice daily platelet transfusion and maintenance of
the fibrinogen level with FFP as the chemotherapy is given
• Provided that remission can be achieved, patients with APML
have a better overall prognosis than patients with other
subtypes of AML
• Oral ATRA (all-trans-retinoic acid) can lead to achievement of
CR in most patients with APML
• Unfortunately, these remissions are not durable and,
therefore, they must be consolidated with conventional
chemotherapy
33
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Breast cancer
Epidemiology:
• Most commonest form of cancer to affect women in the
Western world
• Directly responsible for 19% of all female cancer-related
deaths
• Incidence of 30 per 100,000 population
• It is estimated that 1 in 9 women will develop the disease
Aetiology:
• The risk factors include:
o Age:
• Rare <35 years of age
• Incidence increases with age
o Country of birth:
• High risk = northern Europe and north America
o Genetic factors:
• Hereditary and familial breast cancer can be
described using the Lynch system of classification
(see below)
o Early menarche/late menopause
o Nulliparity/late childbirth
o Obesity
o Exogenous hormones:
• High-dose OCP
• HRT
o Previous cancer
o Irradiation
o Previous benign disease (see below)
34
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• No risk:
• Apocrine change
• Ductal ectasia
• Mild hyperplasia (no atypia)
• Slight risk:
• Moderate or florid hyperplasia (no atypia)
• Sclerosing adenosis
• Papilloma
• Moderate risk:
• Atypical ductal or lobular hyperplasia
Histology:
Are usually adenocarcinomas and are divided into 2
•
types:
o Ductal
o Lobular
• There are 3 degrees of differentiation:
o Grade I – well differentiated
o Grade II – moderately differentiated
o Grade III – poorly differentiated
Carcinoma in situ:
This term refers to the period during which normal epithelial cells
undergo apparent malignant transformation but do not invade
through the basement membrane
• There are 2 forms:
35
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Lobular (LCIS)
o Ductal (DCIS). DCIS represents all types of in situ
carcinoma that are not identified as lobular. It can be
further subdivided into:
• Comedo (a particularly menacing type of Tis)
• Solid
• Cribiform
• Micropapillary
• The ratio of DCIS to LCIS is approximately 3:1 with 10-37%
of those with LCIS and 30-50% of those with DCIS going on
to develop invasive carcinoma
Symptoms:
Lump 76%
Pain 5%
Nipple retraction 4%
Nipple discharge 2%
Skin retraction 1%
Axillary mass 1%
Paget’s disease:
• This condition presents clinically as a chronic, eczematoid
eruption of the nipple
• The diagnosis may be confused with eczema
• It constitutes ~2% of the histological types
• Is almost always associated with an underlying intraductal or
invasive carcinoma
36
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Characterised by:
o Erythema
o Peau d’orange
o Skin ridging
o May/may not be a palpable mass
• The commonest presenting feature is pain (unlike other breast
cancers)
• The characteristic appearance of a diffusely enlarged breast is
consequent upon the dissemination of tumour cells through
the lymphatics of the dermis
Physical examination:
• The patient must be undressed to the waist and should sit
facing the examiner
• The breast is initially examined from the front with the arms
first at the side, then raised above the head and finally placed
on the hips
• The patient is asked to point out the supposed area of
abnormality and this is examined first
• The following must always be assessed:
o Asymmetry
o Visible lumps
o Erythema
o Peau d’orange (cutaneous oedema)
o Contour flattening
o Skin tethering (as identified by puckering, particularly
when the arms are raised)
o Abnormal fixation
o Retraction and altered axis of the nipples
• After this, the patient is asked to lean forward, once again
looking for skin retraction
• The supraclavicular, infraclavicular and axillary lymph nodes
should be examined
• Further palpation of the breast is best performed in the supine
position
• Should a mass be felt, one must assess its:
o Size
o Shape
37
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Location
o Fixation
o Consistency
Mammography:
• Mammography is not useful in women <35 years of age:
o Dense breasts which may mask an underlying tumour
o Interpretation very difficult
o However, should be done if there is clinical suspicion of
a malignancy
• Mammographic abnormalities that warrant further
investigation include:
o Radiological masses undetected on clinical examination
o Microcalcifications
o Stellate densities
o Architectural distortion
o Change from a previous mammogram
• Mammography has a false-negative rate of 10-15%
Ultrasound:
• Very good at discriminating between solid and cystic masses
• Useful for guiding biopsy
• In younger women, ultrasound may reveal more information
than mammography and most surgeons would perform this
test first in women <35 years of age
• Masses in fatty breasts are difficult to assess
Aspiration cytology:
• Needle aspiration of a breast lump is dine with a 21-gauge
needle
• The contents of the needle are expressed on to a slide,
smeared and fixed (often in both air and alcohol) for
cytological examination
• Is a false-negative rate of 1%
38
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Incision biopsy:
o Similar to excision biopsy, except that only a part of the
lump is removed
o It is generally felt that this is not good surgical practice
and is, therefore, restricted to larger tumours
o Has largely been superseded by wide-bore core needle
biopsy
Nipple biopsy:
• Conditions affecting the nipple (especially an eczema-like
appearance) often warrant biopsy
• A wedge of nipple-areolar complex can be excised under local
anaesthetic with minimal cosmetic disruption to confirm or
refute a diagnosis such as that if Paget’s disease
Complications of surgery:
• Haemorrhage/haematoma formation
• Infection
Complications of radiotherapy:
39
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Cutaneous inflammation
• Photosensitisation
• Fibrosis and distortion of breast shape
• Shoulder stiffness
• Brachial plexus damage
• Lymphoedema of the arm
Adjuvant therapy:
• This encompasses both cytotoxic and hormonal therapy
• Cytotoxic therapy:
o Are 2 main regimens:
• CMF (cyclophosphamide, methotrexate and 5-
fluorouracil)
• CAF (cyclophosphamide, adriamycin and 5-
fluorouracil)
o Chemotherapy is given to all patients at a high risk of
recurrence
• Hormonal therapy:
o ~30% of all breast tumours respond to an anti-
oestrogen such as tamoxifen 20mg od, this rises to 60%
of oestrogen-receptor positive tumours
o Some tumours are resistant to tamoxifen and even
respond unfavourably, therefore, alternative hormonal
therapies are available:
• Aromatase inhibitors (prevent the conversion of
androgens to oestrogen) such as formestane and
Anastrozole
• Surgical oophorectomy
• Chemical oophorectomy (using Gn-RH agonists)
40
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cancer genetics
Overview:
• The development of cancer is associated with a fundamental
genetic change with the cell
• Evidence for the genetic origin of cancer is based on the
following:
o Some cancers show a familial predisposition
o Most known carcinogens induce mutations
o Susceptibility to some carcinogens depends on the
ability of cellular enzymes to convert them to a
mutagenic form
o Genetically determined traits associated with a
deficiency in the enzymes required for DNA repair are
associated with an increased risk of cancer
o Some cancers are associated with chromosome
‘instability’
o Malignant tumours represent clonal proliferations of
neoplastic cells
o Some tumours contain mutated oncogenes
• Mutations may occur in the germline and can, therefore, be
present in every single cell in the body, or they may occur in
a single somatic cell and be present only in the tumour
following clonal proliferation
41
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
DNA repair:
• Some autosomal recessive diseases associated with
abnormalities of DNA repair predispose to the development of
cancer:
o Xeroderma pigmentosa (XP):
• Inability to repair DNA damaged by UV light and
some chemicals, therefore leading to a high
incidence of skin cancer
o Ataxia telangectasia (AT):
• These patients have a high sensitivity to ionising
radiation and have an increased incidence of
lymphoid tumours
o Bloom’s syndrome (BS):
• Increased incidence of lymphoid tumours
o Fanconi’s anaemia (FA):
• Increased incidence of lymphoid tumours
Inherited cancers:
• The following are examples of cancer syndromes that exert
dominant inheritance:
o Retinoblastoma:
• An eye tumour found in young children
• May be inherited (40%) or acquired (60%)
• Those with the inherited form have a germline
mutation of the long arm of chromosome 13
o Breast and ovarian cancer:
• 2 genes have been identified – BRCA1 and BRCA2
• These mutations account for most cases of familial
breast cancer and 50% of ovarian cancers
o Wilm’s tumour
o Familial adenomatous polyposis (FAP)
o Neurofibromatosis
o Multiple-endocrine-adenomatosis syndromes (MENS)
Oncogenes:
• Normal cells contain genes known as proto-oncogenes,
activation of which (for example by a mutation or carcinogen
to produce an oncogene) would result in malignant
transformation
• It has been demonstrated that specific proto-oncogenes are
associated with specific cancers
42
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
GI symptoms:
• The most frequent symptoms are:
o Anorexia
o Malaise
o Weakness
• Current research suggests that endogenously produced
cytokines (e.g. TNF and ILs) are mediators of the
anorexia/cachexia syndrome
• Nausea and vomiting:
o Occurs in up to 2/3 of cancer patients in the last 6
weeks of life
o In order to ensure adequate absorption of the
antiemetic, parenteral administration (preferably SC)
may be helpful for the first 24-48 hours
• Antiemetics are classified according to their affinities for NT
receptor sites:
o A prokinetic DA antagonist (e.g. metoclopramide 10mg
tds) would be helpful in vomiting due to upper GI stasis
or liver metastases
o Prokinetics should be avoided in cases of intestinal
obstruction, as they increase peristalsis in the upper
bowel
o Centrally acting anticholinergics (e.g. cyclizine 50mg
tds) or centrally acting DA antagonists (e.g. haloperidol
1.5mg tds) are the drugs of choice in vomiting caused
by drugs or metabolic disturbance
o As with the prescription of analgesics, antiemetics will
be most effective if prescribed on a regular, rather than
‘as required’ basis
Bowel obstruction:
• May present acutely or in a more chronic manner
• The cause is often multifactorial
• A small number of patients may benefit from surgical
intervention
• Most patients will not be suitable for surgery and can be
managed medically
• The active medical management of malignant bowel
obstruction includes:
o The relief of intestinal colic using an antispasmodic (e.g.
hyoscine butylbromide 60-80mg daily)
o Treating continuous pain with adequate analgesia (e.g.
diamorphine)
43
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Treating vomiting if nausea is a problem with a centrally
acting antiemetic (e.g. cyclizine 150mg daily or
haloperidol 5-10mg daily)
• It will be necessary to administer all of the above medications
parenterally (the SC route is most appropriate)
• Patients may be allowed to drink and eat low-residue diets
which are mostly absorbed in the proximal GI tract
Respiratory symptoms:
• In particular, dyspnoea
• Management is based on accurate diagnosis of the cause and
active treatment of all potentially reversible situations:
o Treat infections
o Drain pleural/pericardial effusions
o Transfuse symptomatic anaemia patients
• The sensation of dyspnoea and a cycle of respiratory panic
may be partially relieved by the prescription of regular
benzodiazepines
• Regular doses of short-acting opioids (5-20mg qqh) are also
helpful
44
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Aetiology:
• Tobacco:
o Latent period of 10-30 years
o The primary determinants are:
• Number of cigarettes consumed
• Age of onset of smoking (those under 16 years
of age at start have irreversible damage to
their bronchial genetic makeup
• Length of time of smoking
• Type of tobacco (cigarettes or pipe, filter or
non-filter)
• Passive exposure to tobacco smoke
o Asbestos exposure
o Irradiation
o Toxic metals
o Certain chemicals
Adenocarcinoma:
• 15% of lung tumours
• Has a tendency to be more peripheral, arising in the small
bronchial glands
• Most common in women
• Is the type seen in non-smokers
45
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Alveolar cell carcinoma:
• 5% of lung tumours
• Arises in the distal airways
• Often diffuse, multifocal and bilateral
• Resistant to radio-/chemotherapy
• Very poor prognosis
Symptoms:
• Cough (50%)
• Haemoptysis (on at least one occasion is frequent but rarely
persistent)
• Chest pain (usually a diffuse chest wall heaviness)
• Upper limb pain/numbness (brachial plexus invasion)
• SOB (is the consequence of loss of lung volume from
consolidation distal to an occluded bronchus)
• Hoarseness (involvement of a recurrent laryngeal nerve)
• Dysphagia (oesophageal involvement)
• General features of malignancy:
o Weight loss
o Malaise
o Fatigue
Signs:
• General:
o Clubbing (30%)
o Hypertrophic pulmonary osteoarthropathy (3%) – with
painful swelling of the wrists and ankles
o Raised JVP and distended veins over the upper arms
and chest (with SVC obstruction)
• Signs of metastases are:
o Tender areas in bones
o Palpable supraclavicular lymph nodes
o An enlarged, irregular liver
o Anaemia
Investigations:
• CXR:
o Defines the lobar position of any mass
o May show:
• Pleural effusions
• Elevation of the hemidiaphragm (indication of
phrenic nerve involvement)
• Rib erosion
• Thoracic CT or MRI:
o Excellent for accurate localisation
o In particular, CT defines:
• Additional small lung lesions
46
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Involvement of the pericardium, diaphragm, chest
wall and oesophagus (all of which may indicate
inoperability)
• Enlarged mediastinal glands (suggests malignant
involvement if >1cm)
• The anatomy of the liver and adrenals (both are
frequent sites of secondary spread)
• Mediastinoscopy:
o The aim is to obtain tissue from the mediastinal lymph
nodes around the lower trachea
o Is the most important staging procedure for
inoperability (N2 disease)
• Bone scan:
o Ca bronchus frequently metastasizes to bone
o Should be carried out if there is any clinical suggestion
of bone involvement:
• Bone pain
• Tenderness over the spine and other bony areas
• Raised ALP or serum calcium
o Multiple bone secondaries are an absolute
contraindication to surgery
• Liver ultrasound
• Brian isotope scan:
o Is indicated if neurological abnormalities are found:
• Severe persistent headache
• Syncope
• Ataxia or falls
• Stroke
• Behavioural change
Surgery:
• Thoracotomy and lung resection are performed whenever the
tumour is assessed as operable
47
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Early ligation of the pulmonary vein may help to prevent
metastatic spread from tumour manipulation
• Surgical mortality depends on patient-related risk factors and
the extent of the resection; with pneumonectomy average
mortality is 6-12% and for lobectomy 3-6%
• Specific risk factors are:
o Age
o Extent of resection
o Chronic lung disease
o Coronary artery disease/previous MI
o Concomitant disease of the:
• Liver
• Kidney
• Diabetes
48
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathological features:
• The tumour is an adenocarcinoma usually arising in the
periphery of the prostate and confined within the Prostatic
capsule
• Its spread is:
o Local in the periprostatic and perirectal soft tissues and
upwards into the pelvis
o Lymphatic to the iliac and para-aortic nodes
o Blood-borne, principally to bone
Symptoms:
• Bladder outflow obstruction
• Metastatic disease:
o Bone pain
o Leg swelling form lymphatic obstruction
• Renal failure from bilateral ureteric obstruction
Signs:
• A nodule in a palpably benign gland
• Hard, irregular prostate in rectal examination sometimes with
perirectal and periprostatic thickening
• Ankle/leg oedema
• Other signs of metastases
Investigation:
• A histological/cytological diagnosis must be made and can be
achieved by:
o Transrectal or transperineal biopsy, preferably US
guided
o Aspiration cytology
o Transurethral resection
• Serum prostate-specific antigen (PSA):
o PSA is secreted in the serum by both benign and
malignant prostatic tissue
o Its level correlates with the volume of prostatic tissue
o Not useful for screening but is useful for monitoring the
progression of the disease and response to treatment
49
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Abdominal ultrasonography:
o May identify unilateral or bilateral hydronephrosis
because of ureteric involvement
• Renal function tests
• Serum ALP:
o Will be elevated in patients with bony metastases
• Bone scanning:
o Radioisotope bone scans can detect areas of increased
bone activity, irrespective of their cause
Staging:
T1a Incidental finding of tumour with low biological potential for
aggressive behaviour in a prostate removed for clinically
benign disease
T1b Incidental finding of tumour with potentially biological
aggressive behaviour in a prostate removed for clinically
benign disease
T1c Tumour identified because of elevated serum PSA
T2a Tumour involving half a lobe or less
T2b More than half a lobe but not both
T2c Both lobes
T3 Tumour extends through capsule and may involve seminal
vesicle
T4 Tumour fixed to invasive adjacent structures other than
seminal
vesicle
Management options:
• No treatment with assessment of progress
• Endocrine therapy
• Radiotherapy
• Surgery
Endocrine therapy:
• Most of the proliferating cells of the prostate are dependent
on testosterone
• 60-80% of patients with symptomatic prostate cancer
respond to androgen suppression or ablation therapy
• The mean duration of response is 2 years
• Once the tumour is no longer hormone-sensitive, the mean
survival is 6 months
• Androgen suppression:
o LHRH analogues initially stimulate the pituitary but after
~7 days the pituitary receptors become blocked and
down-regulation occurs
o Serum testosterone levels fall to castrate levels
50
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o These drugs are long-acting and are administered sc
every 1 or 3 months
o Due to the initial stimulation of the pituitary, an anti-
androgen should be given for 7-14 days before the
LHRH analogue is given to prevent disease progression
• Androgen ablation:
o Is by bilateral subcapsular orchidectomy, which can be
done under local anaesthesia as an outpatient
o There is no difference in response between
orchidectomy and LHRH analogue therapy and the
choice of treatment should lie with the patient
Radiotherapy:
• Is effective in controlling the pain of bony metastases
• It is also useful for the treatment of the primary if it is
thought that the tumour is confined to the prostate
Surgical treatment:
• Transurethral resection:
o Is used in patients who present with symptoms of
outflow obstruction or acute retention
• Radical prostatectomy:
o Controversial
o Only useful if the tumour is entirely confined to the
prostate
o Mortality of ~1%
• Morbidity includes:
o Incontinence
o Erectile dysfunction
o Anastomotic strictures
Prognosis:
• In men with prostate cancer confined within the capsule who
undergo radical prostatectomy, approximately 55% survive
10 years
• In comparison with those who have metastatic disease at
presentation, of whom only 25% can be expected to survive 5
years
51
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chemotherapy
Overview:
• IV administration of anticancer agents enables therapy to
potentially reach metastatic disease in any part of the body
• However, the toxicity of chemotherapy determines that the
drugs can only be given intermittently and that time has to be
allowed for normal tissues to recover between each
administration of new cytotoxic drugs
• It is also known that tumours rapidly develop resistance to
single agents given on their own
• For this reason, the principle of intermittent combination
chemotherapy has developed:
o Several drugs are combined together
o Chosen on the basis of their differing mechanisms of
action and non-overlapping toxicities
• It has become apparent that normal tissue repairs much more
rapidly than cancerous tissue. This makes it possible to
continually deplete the tumour whilst allowing the restoration
of normal tissues between chemotherapy cycles
Drug resistance:
• This is one of the major obstacles to curing cancer with
chemotherapy
• Some tumours have an intolerably low-level of resistance to
currently available treatment and are often cured:
o Testicular teratomas
o HD
o Childhood acute leukaemia
• Solid tumours (such as small-cell lung cancer) initially appear
to be chemosensitive, with the majority of patients
responding, but most patients eventually relapse with
resistant disease
• In other tumours (e.g. melanoma) the disease is largely
chemoresistant from the start
52
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Adjuvant therapy:
• When a patient first presents with a tumour, it is possible that
small amounts of tumour tissue have already spread to the
lungs, liver, bone marrow and other sites
• This micrometastatic disease consists of relatively few cells
with a good blood supply and might be particularly amenable
to the action of anticancer drugs
• Therefore, if the primary tumour is removed and the tumour
has a great likelihood of relapse, chemotherapy can be given
to destroy the residual micrometastatic disease
• Adjuvant therapy is very useful in childhood cancers
• In adults, adjuvant therapy has been shown to be of use in
breast and colon cancer
53
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Is an incurable disease of older people
• Is characterised by an uncontrolled proliferation and
accumulation of mature B-cells (although T-cell CLL does
occur)
• A proportion of patients remain asymptomatic, dying of an
unrelated cause
• In the remainder, the disease can usually be kept under
control for 9-10 years, infection being the predominant cause
of death
Clinical features:
In asymptomatic patients, the diagnosis is often a chance finding on
the basis of a blood count done for a quite different reason
• Symptoms:
o Recurrent infections (resulting from neutropenia and
reduced Ig levels)
o Symptoms of anaemia:
• May develop rapidly in the context of haemolysis
(usually precipitated by infection)
o Painless lymph node enlargement
• Signs:
o Signs of anaemia
o Lymph node enlargement
o Enlarged liver and/or spleen
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Hb low or normal
o Raised WCC (of which at least 40% are lymphocytes)
o Platelets low or normal
• Serum Igs:
o Low or normal
• Coomb’s test:
o Positive if haemolysis is occurring
Treatment:
• The disease may remain stable for several years
• There is no advantage in starting treatment before there is a
clinical indication:
o Anaemia
o Recurrent infections
o Bleeding
o ‘Bulky’ lymphadenopathy
54
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Increasing Splenomegaly
• Chlorambucil is most often used, with or without Prednisolone
• Treatment is given intermittently, as and when necessary
55
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• The majority of patients with this disease are older and die
within 5 years of diagnosis
• Has a chronic phase (of 3-4 years duration) and an acute (or
blastic) phase
• The blastic phase of CML is characterised by the development
of acute leukaemia which may be:
o Myeloid (60%)
o Lymphoid (30%)
o Erythroid (10%), in origin
• The blastic phase is generally refractory to treatment, the
median survival being <6 months
Clinical features:
• Symptoms:
o Anaemia
o Night sweats
o Fever
o Weight loss
o Abdominal discomfort owing to splenic enlargement
• Signs:
o Those of anaemia
o Splenomegaly
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Hb normal or low
o Raised WCC (characteristically with the whole spectrum
of myeloid precursors)
o Platelets normal, low or raised
• Bone marrow aspirate:
o Shows a hypercellular marrow with an increase in
myeloid precursors
o The Philadelphia (Ph) chromosome is present in most
patients
Treatment:
• Interferon (IFN) therapy:
o Induces haematological remission in most patients
o Induces cytogenetic remission in ~10% of patients
o Problems:
• Has to be given subcutaneously
• Side-effects can be intolerable (mainly fatigue)
56
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Myeloablative therapy supported by allogeneic BMT:
o May be curative
o Limited by donor availability and the morbidity/mortality
associated with the treatment itself
57
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• HCL is a clonal proliferation of abnormal B (or very rarely T)
cells which, as in CLL, accumulate in the bone marrow and
spleen
• Is a rare disease of late middle age
• The bizarre name relates to the appearance of the cells on a
blood film:
o They have an irregular outline owing to the presence of
filament-like cytoplasmic projections
Clinical features:
• Symptoms:
o Those of anaemia
o Recurrent infections
o Abdominal discomfort owing to splenic enlargement
• Signs:
o Those of anaemia
o A palpable spleen
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Pancytopenia
• Bone marrow aspirate:
o Shows increased cellularity with characteristic
infiltration by ‘hairy’ cells
Treatment:
• 2-chloroadenosine (2-CDA) has been shown to have specific
activity in this illness, complete remission often being
achieved with just 1 cycle of treatment
• The remissions sometimes last for several years and patients
can be re-treated
58
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Is one of 2 groups of lymphoma (HD and non-Hodgkin’s
lymphoma)
• Represents abnormal proliferation of B or T cells
• Is now curable in the majority of patients
• All stages are subclassified as A (asymptomatic) or B
Clinical features:
• Symptoms:
o Lymph node enlargement (most often of the cervical
nodes)
o ‘B’ symptoms:
• Fever
• Drenching night sweats
• Weight loss of >10% of bodyweight
o Other constitutional symptoms:
• Pruritus
• Fatigue
• Anorexia
• Alcohol-induced pain at the site of enlarged lymph
nodes
• Symptoms due to involvement of other organs (e.g. bone,
lungs, liver)
• Signs:
o Peripheral lymph node enlargement
o Hepatosplenomegaly
59
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Secondary malignancies:
o Nasopharyngeal
o Thyroid
o Lung
o Breast
o Stomach
Investigations:
• FBC:
o May be a normocytic normochromic anaemia
• ESR:
o Usually raised
• LFTs:
o Abnormal if the liver is involved
• CXR:
o May show mediastinal widening, with or without lung
involvement
• CT scans:
o May show involvement of intrathoracic, abdominal or
pelvic lymph nodes
• Bone marrow aspirate:
o May show involvement in patients with advanced
disease
• Lymph node biopsy:
o Is required for definitive diagnosis
o Classically, Sternberg-Reed cells are present
Treatment:
• Treatment is nearly always given with curative intent
• Consists of chemotherapy, radiotherapy or both
• Treatment for HD can usually be given on an outpatient basis
and most people are able to lead a reasonably normal life
whilst having treatment
Prognosis at recurrence:
• Failure to achieve an initial or almost complete response, and
recurrence within 1 year, are both associated with a very poor
prognosis
• Similarly, patients who develop recurrent HD more than once
will almost certainly die of HD
60
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• High-doses of chemotherapy and radiotherapy kill dividing
cells indiscriminately, so that both normal and malignant cells
are killed
• Since the bone marrow is a highly dividing tissue,
myelosuppression is the main dose-limiting toxicity
• Thus, without a ‘transplant’ as a source of haemopoietic
progenitor cells, the person would die of bone marrow failure
• High-dose treatment may be given using one of the following
as a source of haemopoietic progenitor cells:
o Allogeneic bone marrow transplantation
(BMT)/peripheral blood progenitor cells (PBPCs)
o Autologous BMT/PBPCs
61
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
BM appear to exert an immunologically-mediated ‘graft-
versus-leukaemia’ effect
• The use of allogeneic BMT is primarily limited by donor
availability
• Allogeneic PBPCs are currently being evaluated:
o Granulocyte-colony stimulating factor (G-CSF) is given
to the donor and haemopoietic progenitor cells are
collected from a vein
o Large volumes of blood are phoresed (centrifuged)
o The PBPCs are separated and collected and the RBCs,
granulocytes, platelets and plasma are then returned to
the donor through another vein
• Advantages include:
o Donor does not require a GA
o Donor does not have the discomfort associated with
collecting BM from the pelvic bones
o Incidence and severity of GVHD seems to be lower
62
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Myeloma
Overview:
• Is part of a spectrum of diseases
• Characterised by the presence of a paraprotein in the serum:
o Is produced by abnormal, proliferating plasma cells that
produce (most often) IgG or IgA (and rarely IgD)
• The paraproteinaemia may be associated with the excretion of
light chains in the urine (known as Bence-Jones protein)
Clinical features:
• Is a disease of the elderly (median age at presentation being
60 years)
• It is a complex illness which represents the inter-relationship
between:
o Bone destruction:
• Vertebral collapse (which can cause spinal cord
compression)
• Fractures
• Hypercalcaemia
o Bone marrow infiltration:
• Pancytopenia
• Production of paraprotein which may (rarely)
result in symptoms of hyperviscosity
o Renal impairment owing to a combination of:
• Deposition of light chains
• Hypercalcaemia
• Hyperuricaemia
Symptoms:
• Bone pain
• Symptoms of anaemia
• Recurrent infections
• Symptoms of renal failure (e.g. pruritus, anorexia, lethargy)
• Symptoms of hypercalcaemia
Investigations:
• FBC:
o All values are normal or low
• ESR:
o Raised
• Blood film:
o May be rouleaux formation as a consequence of the
paraprotein
• U&Es:
o May be evidence of renal failure
63
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Serum Ca2+:
o Normal or raised
• Serum ALP:
o Usually normal
• Total protein:
o Normal or raised
• Serum albumin:
o Normal or low
• Protein electrophoresis:
o Characteristically shows a monoclonal band
(paraprotein)
• Uric acid:
o Normal or raised
• Skeletal survey:
o May show characteristic lytic lesions, most easily seen in
the skull
• Skeletal survey:
o To assess light-chain excretion
• Bone marrow aspirate:
o Shows characteristic infiltration by plasma cells
General treatment:
• Anaemia corrected
• Infection treated
• Bone pain can be helped most quickly by radiotherapy
• Pathological fractures can be prevented by prompt
orthopaedic surgery with pinning of lytic bone lesions seen on
the skeletal survey
• Renal failure needs to be assessed and may need long-term
dialysis
• Patients with spinal cord compression due to Myeloma are
treated with dexamethasone, followed by radiotherapy to the
lesion delineated by an MRI scan
Specific treatment:
• The use of alkylating agents (e.g. melphalan,
cyclophosphamide) in conjunction with prednisolone has
improved the median survival from 7 months to 2 years
Prognosis:
• Patients presenting with anaemia and renal failure have a
very poor prognosis, with 50% dying within 9 months
• Patients without these 2 features at presentation survive for
about 2 years
64
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Classification:
• The Kiel classification (reflects the rate at which the cells are
dividing):
o High-grade
o Low-grade
• Ironically, high-grade lymphomas are potentially curable,
whereas low-grade lymphomas are generally considered to be
incurable with conventional therapy
• A further subdivision is made in the basis of B- or T-cell
origin:
o Most NHLs are of B-cell phenotype (although T-cell
tumours are increasingly being recognised)
Clinical features:
• Peripheral lymph node enlargement
• With or without systemic symptoms
Low-grade High-grade
Middle-aged/older people Any age group
Bone marrow infiltration common Bone marrow
infiltration unusual
Incurable with conventional therapy Potentially curable
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Pancytopenia (suggests bone marrow infiltration)
• U&Es:
o Patients may have renal impairment as a consequence
of ureteric obstruction secondary to intra-abdominal or
pelvic lymph node enlargement
• CXR
• LFTs
• CT scans
• Bone marrow aspirate
• Lymph node biopsy
Low-grade lymphomas:
• Are 4 subtypes:
o Follicular lymphoma (median survival is 9 years)
o Lymphoplasmacytoid (LPC) lymphoma (median survival
is 5 years)
o Mantle cell lymphoma (centrocytic lymphoma) (median
survival is 4 years)
o Low-grade T-cell lymphoma
65
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
High-grade lymphomas:
• May be of B- or T-cell origin
• Chemotherapy is given with curative intent
• 60-70% of patients respond to treatment
• About 40% are cured
• Recurrent high-grade lymphoma has a grave prognosis
66
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• The symptom most feared by cancer patients is pain,
although only 2/3 of patients suffer significant pain
throughout the course of their disease
• Cancer is directly responsible for ~70% of the pain, the
remainder being due to:
o Rapid weight loss
o Pressure sores
o Arthritis, etc
67
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o There are now both 12-hour and 24-hour release
preparations available
o The appropriate dose may be calculated by simple
addition:
20mg morphine elixir qqh
= 120mg morphine per day
= 60mg bds of a 12-hour preparation or 120mg daily of a 24-hour
preparation
68
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o In cases of constant burning dysaesthesia, the TCAs are
helpful (e.g. amitriptyline 10mg at night, increasing
incrementally to 75-100mg is usually sufficient)
o Anticonvulsant drugs are useful in the management of
lancinating, neuropathic pains:
• Carbamazepine, starting at a dose of 100mg bds is
most commonly used
69
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Staging of cancer
Before a decision about treatment can be made, not only the type
of tumour but also its extent and distribution needs to be
established. Various ‘staging investigations’ are therefore performed
before a treatment decision is made. The staging systems vary
according to the type of tumour
Presence of metastases:
M0 Not present
M1 Present
Tumour markers:
• There are a number of specific tumour markers which are
found in serum and are useful in diagnosis:
o α-fetoprotein:
• Hepatocellular carcinoma
• Germ-cell testicular tumours
o β-human chorionic gonadotrophin (β-HCG):
• Choriocarcinoma
o Prostate-specific antigen (PSA):
• Prostate carcinoma
• There are a number of other tumour markers available, but
these are of little use in diagnosis
• Examples include:
o Carcinoma embryonic antigen (CEA) – e.g. colon cancer
o Ca-125 – e.g. ovarian, gut, pancreatic cancer
70
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Ca-19-9 – e.g. gut, pancreatic cancer
• These markers are non-specific and should only be used to
monitor response to treatment
71
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cardiology
72
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Angina pectoris
Overview:
• Diagnosis is largely based on the clinical history
• The chest pain is typically described as ‘heavy’, ‘tight’ or
‘gripping’
• Typically, the pain is central/retrosternal and may radiate to
the jaw and/or arms
• Angina can range from a mild ache to a most severe pain that
provokes sweating and fear
• May be associated breathlessness
Types of angina:
• Classical (exertional) angina
• Decubitus angina
• Variant (Prinzmetal’s) angina
• Cardiac syndrome X
• Unstable angina
Exertional angina:
• The pain is provoked by physical exertion, especially after
meals and in cold, windy weather
• Is commonly aggravated by either anger or excitement
• Pain fades within minutes of resting
• May, occasionally, disappear with continued exertion (‘walking
through the pain’)
Decubitus angina:
• Occurs when the patient is lying down
• Usually occurs in association with impaired LV function, as a
result of severe coronary artery disease
Prinzmetal’s angina:
• Refers to an angina that occurs without provocation, usually
at rest, as a result of coronary artery spasm
• Occurs more frequently in women
• Arrhythmias (both VT and heart block) can occur during the
ischaemic episode
73
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cardiac syndrome X:
• Refers to those patients with a good history of angina, a
positive exercise test and angiographically normal coronary
arteries
• This forms a heterogeneous group in whom there may be
functional abnormalities of the coronary microcirculation
• Much more common in women than in men
• Good prognosis but are difficult to treat#
Unstable angina:
• Refers to angina of recent onset (less than 1 month),
worsening angina or angina at rest
Examination:
• Usually no abnormal findings
• Occasionally a fourth heart sound may be heard
• Signs that should be sought include:
o Anaemia
o Thyrotoxicosis
o Hyperlipidaemia (e.g. lipid arcus, xanthelasma, tendon
xanthoma)
• It is essential to exclude aortic stenosis as this can present
with angina-like symptoms:
o Slow-rising carotid impulse
o Ejection systolic murmur radiating to the neck
• It is also important to measure the BP to identify coexistent
HT
General management:
• Inform patients of their condition
• Reassure them that the prognosis is good (<2% mortality
per year)
• Manage coexistent diseases (e.g. DM, HT)
• Minimise risk factors:
o Smoking
o Obesity
o Hyperlipidaemia
74
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Encourage regular exercise
Invasive therapies:
• Coronary artery bypass grafting (CABG)
• Percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty (PTCA)
• Risks:
o Mortality (1%)
75
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o MI (2%)
o Need for an urgent CABG (2%)
76
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Symptoms:
• Significant symptoms do not develop until LV failure occurs
• A common symptom is ‘pounding of the heart’ because of the
increased LV size and its vigorous pulsation
• Dyspnoea
Signs:
Pulse: Sinus rhythm, large volume, collapsing
Blood pressure: Wide pulse pressure
Apex: Displaced, diffuse, heaving
Murmur: (1) High pitched early diastolic at LSE
(2) Ejection systolic at base and into neck
(3) Mid-diastolic rumble at apex (Austin-
Flint)
Investigations:
• CXR:
o LV enlargement
o Ascending aortic wall ,ay be calcified in syphilis
• ECG:
o Left ventricular hypertrophy
o Usually sinus rhythm
• Echocardiogram
77
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Treatment:
• Treat the underlying cause (e.g. IE, syphilis) if possible
• Treatment usually requires aortic valve replacement but the
timing of surgery is important:
o Because symptoms do not develop until the
myocardium fails and because the myocardium does not
recover fully after surgery, it is important to operate
before significant symptoms occur
o The timing of the operation is best determined
according to haemodynamic, echocardiographic or
nuclear angiographic criteria
• Antibiotic prophylaxis against IE is necessary, even if a
prosthetic valve replacement has been performed
78
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Aetiology:
• There are 3 causes of AS:
o Congenital AS (develops progressively due to turbulent
flow through a congenitally abnormal (usually bicuspid)
aortic valve)
o Rheumatic fever
o Arteriosclerotic degeneration and calcification (through
wear and tear)
Symptoms:
• Asymptomatic until AS is moderately severe (when the aortic
orifice is reduced to 1/3 of its normal size
• Exercise induced:
o Syncope
o Angina
o Dyspnoea
o Sudden death
• When symptoms appear, the prognosis is poor – death occurs
within 2-3 years without surgical intervention
Signs:
Pulse: Sinus rhythm, low volume, slow rising
Aortic area: Systolic thrill
Apex: Not displaced
Sounds: Ejection click, soft A2, S4
Murmur: Ejection systolic, radiates to the carotids
Investigations:
• CXR:
o Relatively small heart
o Prominent, dilated ascending aorta
• ECG:
o Left ventricular hypertrophy (left axis deviation)
o Usually sinus rhythm, but ventricular rhythms may
occur
• Echocardiography
Treatment:
• Pts should not over-exert themselves or take part in
strenuous physical games
• Angina is best treated with ß-blockade (as GTN aggravates
the exertional syncope)
• Antibiotic prophylaxis against IE is essential
• When severe, aortic valve replacement is recommended
79
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Atrial tachycardias
Atrial flutter:
• Atrial rate varies between 280-350 per minute
• Most often, every second flutter beat conducts, giving a
ventricular rate of 150bpm
• Occasionally, every beat conducts, producing a HR of 300bpm
• Regular, sawtooth-like atrial flutter waves (F waves) between
QRST complexes
• If they are not clearly visible, AV conduction may be
transiently impaired by carotid sinus massage or by the
administration of AV nodal blocking drugs (e.g. verapamil)
• Treatment:
o DC cardioversion (50J, 100J and then 360J)
o Class III drugs are often effective (e.g, amiodarone)
o AV nodal blocking drugs (class II or IV or digitalis) may
be used to control the ventricular rate if the arrhythmia
persists
o Treatment of choice is now radiofrequency catheter
ablation
Atrial fibrillation:
• Common (occurs in 5-10% of patients >65 years of age)
• Atrial fibrillation is continuous, rapid (400 per minute)
activation of the atria by meandering wavelets
• Aetiology:
o Thyrotoxicosis
o Alcohol toxicity
o Chest infection
o Raised atrial pressure
o Increased atrial muscle mass
o Atrial fibrosis
o Inflammation/infiltration of the atrium
• Symptoms and signs:
o May be asymptomatic
o May lead to acute cardiac decompensation
o Patient has an irregularly irregular pulse that is
maintained, even during exercise
o The ECG shows fine oscillations of the baseline and no
clear P waves
o The QRS rhythm is rapid and irregular
o Untreated, the ventricular rate is usually 120-180bpm
80
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• If this does not correct the AF, consider at least 1 go at DC
cardioversion (this requires a GA or heavy sedation)
• Warfarinize for 3 weeks before DC shock (100-200J) and for 4
weeks after
• If DC cardioversion fails, treat as chronic AF
• Chronic AF:
o The aim is control of ventricular rate, not sinus rhythm
o Digitalize (loading dose 0.5mg PO x 3 doses in 2 days,
maintenance of 0.25mg PO OD)
• If rate still to fast, check serum levels and cautiously increase
the dose ± low dose ß-blockers (e.g. propranolol 10-20mg PO
TDS)
• Discuss the risks and benefits of anticoagulation with the
patient
• In general, expect to use warfarin, aiming for an INR of 2.5-
3.5
• However, if the patient is reluctant or the risk of emboli is
small (e.g. lone AF with normal echo and no past emboli or
TIA) or the risk of bleeding is high ± use of warfarin is
contraindicated (e.g. on NSAIDs or past peptic ulcer) aspirin
300mg with food may be acceptable
81
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Causes of RBBB:
• Congenital:
o ASD
o VSD
• Pulmonary disease:
o Cor pulmonale
o PE
• Myocardial disease:
o Acute MI
o Cardiomyopathy
• Drugs/electrolytes:
o Hyperkalaemia
o Class Ia antiarrhythimics
Causes of LBBB:
• LV outflow obstruction:
o Aortic stenosis
o HT
• Coronary artery disease:
o Acute MI
o Severe coronary artery disease
• Cardiomyopathy
82
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Causes:
• Rapidly reversible:
o Arrhythmias
o Cardiac tamponade
o Tension pneumothorax
• Others:
o MI
o Myocardial depression (drugs, sepsis, hypoxia, acidosis)
o Valve destruction (e.g. endocarditis)
o PE
o Aortic dissection
Management:
• Give O2, with the patient placed in the most comfortable
position
• Give diamorphine 2.5-5mg IV for pain and anxiety
• Monitor:
o ECG
o Urine output
o Blood gases
o U&Es
o CVP
• Perform a 12-lead ECG every hour until the diagnosis is made
• Correct:
o Arrhythmias
o U&E imbalances
o Acid-base balance
• Give positive inotropes (e.g. dobutamine2.5-10µg/hk/min IVI)
adjusted to keep systolic BP >80mmHg
• Increase renal perfusion by low-dose dopamine (2-
5µg/kg/min IVI)
• Look for and treat any reversible cause (e.g. PE, MI) –
consider thrombolysis
Cardiac tamponade:
83
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Pericardial fluid accumulates, intra-pericardial pressure rises,
the heart cannot fill and pumping stops
• Major causes:
o Trauma
o Lung/breast cancer
o Pericarditis
o MI
o Bacteria (e.g. TB)
84
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
85
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Displaced apex
o Left ventricular 3rd or 4th heart sound that, with a
tachycardia, is described as a gallop rhythm
o Functional mitral regurgitation (caused by dilatation of
the mitral annulus)
o Bi-basal lung crackles with possible pulmonary oedema
General/diagnostic investigations:
• CXR
• Echocardiography
• Blood tests:
o FBC
o LFTs
o U&Es
o TFTs
• Cardiac catheterisation
Functional/prognostic investigations:
• Cardiopulmonary exercise testing
• Resting and stress radionucleotide angiography
• Ambulatory ECG monitoring for 24-28 hours (if an arrhythmia
is suspected)
• Serum ANP levels (a measure of left ventricular systolic
dysfunction)
General treatment:
• Moderate physical exercise
• Weight loss (if appropriate)
• Salt restriction
• Alcohol abstinence (as alcohol has a negatively inotropic
effect)
Drug management:
• Relies on the following categories of drugs:
o Diuretics
o Vasodilators
o Positive inotropic agents
86
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Digitalis glycosides
o Anti-arrhythmic agents
Diuretics:
• All act by promoting the renal excretion of salt and water
• The resulting loss of fluid reduces preload and produces
consistent haemodynamic and symptomatic benefits in
patients with HF and rapidly removes dyspnoea and peripheral
oedema
• Loop diuretics:
o E.g. frusemide, bumetanide
o Act by reducing sodium and chloride reabsorption in the
ascending limb of the loop of Henle
o Cause a brisk and short-lived diuresis
o Produce marked K+ loss and hyperuricaemia
• Thiazide diuretics:
o E.g. bendrofluazide
o Effect the distal convoluted tubule, reducing sodium
reabsorption
o Mild diuretic action
o Less effective in patients with a reduced GFR
o Again, promote K+ loss
o Metolazone is a powerful thiazide diuretic, producing a
profound diuresis acting synergistically with loop
diuretics
• Potassium-sparing diuretics:
o Spironolactone:
• Competitive aldosterone antagonist
• Weak diuretic
• Has a potassium-sparing action (since aldosterone
promotes the excretion of potassium)
o Amiloride, triamterene:
• Act at the distal tubule, preventing potassium
secretion in exchange for sodium
• Weak diuretics
• Should be avoided in patients with renal failure
and those taking ACEIs (as both lead to potassium
retention)
Vasodilator therapy:
• Arteriolar vasodilators:
o α-adrenoreceptor antagonists (e.g. prazosin)
o Direct smooth muscle relaxants (e.g. hydralazine)
o Calcium-channel blockers (e.g. amlodipine)
• Venodilators:
87
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Short-acting nitrates (e.g. GTN)
o Long-acting nitrates (e.g. isosorbide mononitrate)
o With chronic use, tolerance develops
ß-blockers:
• E.g. metoprolol
Anticoagulants:
• HF is associated with a 4x risk of stroke
• Oral anticoagulants are recommended in patients with:
o Atrial fibrillation
o A previous history of thromboembolism
Treatment summary:
• All patients with clinical HF should receive treatment with
diuretics and an ACEI
88
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Patients in AF should be digitalized but patients in sinus
rhythm may also be improved by the addition of digoxin or a
ß-blocker
89
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• IE is an infection of the endocardium or vascular endothelium
• The disease may occasionally occur as a fulminating or acute
infection, but more commonly runs an insidious course and is
known as subacute (bacterial) endocarditis (SBE)
• Annual incidence is 6-7 per 100,000 in the UK
• Occurs most commonly on rheumatic or congenitally
abnormal valves (as well as in mitral valve prolapse and
calcified aortic valve disease)
• It also occurs in association with congenital lesions (e.g. VSD)
Aetiology:
• Many organisms cause IE. Currently, the 3 most common
organisms are:
o Streptococcus viridans (50% of cases)
o Enterococcus faecalis
o Staphlococcus aureus (50% of acute cases)
Presentations:
• Subacute endocarditis:
o Fever
o Night sweats
o Weight loss
o Weakness
o Symptoms due to cardiac failure or embolism
o Another important presentation is a combination of
renal failure and a heart murmur
90
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Acute endocarditis:
o In IVDUs or following an acute suppurative illness (e.g.
meningitis or pneumonia) the development of acute IE
is suggested by the:
• Persistence of fever
• Development of heart murmurs
• Vasculitis (with petechial haemorrhage)
• Embolism
Investigations:
• Blood:
o Normochromic normocytic anaemia is usual
o Raised ESR and CRP
o Raised WCC
• LFTs:
o Mild disturbances
o Raised ALP
• Immunoglobulins and complement:
o Serum Igs are increased
o Total complement and C3 complement are decreased
(owing to immune complex formation)
• Urine:
o Microscopic haematuria is nearly always present
o Proteinuria may occur
• Blood cultures:
o Are positive in ~75% of cases
• Echocardiography:
o Useful for identifying vegetations
o Useful for documenting valvular dysfunction and to
identify patients in need of urgent surgery
• CXR:
o May show evidence of HF
o Evidence of emboli in right-sided endocarditis
Drug treatment:
• Treat any underlying infection (e.g. drainage of a dental
abscess)
• Treatment is with an appropriate antibiotic to which the
bacteria is susceptible to for 4-6 weeks
• The first 2 weeks will be IV therapy, followed by 2-4 weeks of
oral therapy
Surgical treatment:
• There are several situations in which surgery is necessary:
o Extensive damage to a valve
o Early infection of prosthetic material
o Worsening renal failure
o Persistent infection but failure to culture an organism
91
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Embolization
o Large vegetations
o Progressive cardiac failure
• The timing of surgery is important. On the one hand, the
infection should, if possible, be eradicated before surgery is
undertaken, but on the other hand the heart should not be
left in a badly compromised haemodynamic state. In general,
early surgery is preferable
Prognosis:
• The prognosis is worse when:
o The organism cannot be isolated
o Cardiac failure is present
o Infection occurs on a prosthetic valve
o The micro-organisms found are resistant to therapy
• In general, 70% of those affected are treated effectively
92
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Aetiology:
• Rheumatic fever (50% of cases)
• Prolapsed mitral valve
• Any disease that causes LV dilatation;
o Aortic valve disease
o Myocarditis
o Dilated cardiomyopathy
o Hypertensive heart disease
o IHD
• IE
• Connective tissue disorders (e.g. SLE)
• Marfan’s syndrome
Symptoms:
• Asymptomatic for many years
• Palpitations (due to the increased SV)
• Dyspnoea/orthopnoea owing to pulmonary HT
• Fatigue/lethargy due to the reduced cardiac output
• In the late stages of the disease, the symptoms of right-heart
failure also occur, culminating in congestive cardiac failure
• Cardiac cachexia may develop
• Subacute IE is quite common
Signs:
Pulse: Sinus rhythm or AF
Apex: Thrusting, displaced, systolic thrill
Sound: Soft S1, S3
Murmur: Pansystolic
Investigations:
• CXR:
o Left atrial/ventricle enlargement
o Cardiomegaly
• ECG:
o P mitrale (left atrial delay)
o Left ventricular hypertrophy:
• Left axis deviation
o AF may be present
• Echocardiography
Treatment:
• Asymptomatic, mild MR can be managed conservatively by
following the pt with serial echocardiograms
93
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Antibiotic prophylaxis against IE is required
• Any evidence of progressive cardiac enlargement generally
warrants early surgical intervention, by either mitral valve repair
or replacement
• For those patients who are not considered appropriate for
surgical intervention, or in whom surgery will be considered at a
later date:
o ACEIs
o Diuretics
o Anticoagulants (possibly)
94
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Aetiology:
• Rheumatic fever (almost all cases are due to this)
• Lutembacher’s syndrome (combination of acquired MS and an
ADS)
• Calcification and fibrosis of the valve, valve ring and chordae
tendineae (elderly)
• Congenital mitral stenosis (rare)
Complications of MS:
• Atrial fibrillation
• Systemic embolization
• Pulmonary HT
• Pulmonary infarction
• Chest infections
• Tricuspid regurgitation
• Right ventricular failure
• IE (rare)
Symptoms:
• Asymptomatic until valve orifice is reduced from 5cm2 to 2cm2
• Progressively severe dyspnoea (due to pulmonary HT and
recurrent bronchitis)
• A cough productive of blood-tinged, frothy sputum is quite
common
• Frank haemoptysis may occur
• Symptoms of right-heart failure (fatigue, weakness,
abdominal/lower limb swelling)
• Palpitations (due to AF)
• AF may result in systemic embolization, commonly to the
cerebral vessels
Signs:
Pulse: AF (irregularly irregular)
RV: Heaving
Apex: Tapping, non-displaced
Sound: Loud S1, loud P2, opening snap
Murmur: Mid-diastolic rumble at apex, best heard with pt
on
left-side
Investigations:
• CXR:
95
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Small heart
o Enlarged left atrium
o Signs of pulmonary oedema may be apparent when the
disease is severe
• ECG:
o In sinus rhythm, the ECG shows a bifid P wave (P
mitrale) due to delayed left atrial activation
o AF is frequently present
o As the disease progresses, there features of right
ventricular hypertrophy may develop:
• Right axis deviation
• Echocardiography
Treatment:
• Mild MS may need no treatment other than prompt therapy of
attacks of bronchitis
• Antibiotic therapy is advised to prevent IE (although rare)
• Early symptoms of MS (e.g. mild dyspnoea) can be treated
with diuretics
• The onset of AF requires treatment with digoxin and
anticoagulation
• If pulmonary HT develops, surgical relief of the MS is advised
• There are 4 operative measures:
o Trans-septal balloon valvotomy
o Closed valvotomy
o Open valvotomy
o Mitral valve replacement
96
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Commonest cause of death in the UK
• Incidence of 5/1000 per year
• 50% survive the acute event. Of these, a further 10% die in
hospital and up to 20% more die in the first 2 years
• 50% of initial survivors are alive at 10 years
Clinical features:
• Severe central chest pain, often described as crushing in
nature
• Pain may radiate to the jaw and left arm
• Onset is usually sudden and persists fairly constantly for
several hours (often until diamorphine is given)
• Up to 20% of patients experience no pain – so called ‘silent
MI’. This is commonly seen in diabetics and the elderly
• Other symptoms/signs:
o Sweating
o Breathlessness
o Nausea/vomiting
o Pallor
Diagnosis:
• Requires at least 2 of the following:
o A history of ischaemic-type chest pain
o Evolving ECG changes
o A rise and fall in cardiac enzymes
Investigations – ECG:
• Abnormal Q waves (usually permanent)
• Inverted T waves
• Elevated ST segments
97
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Cardiac-specific troponins:
o Troponin T and I have a very high specificity for cardiac
injury
o Released early (2-4 hours) and can persist for up to 7
days
• Lactate dehydrogenase (LDH):
o Non-specific
o Rarely used
Thrombolysis:
• Streptokinase (1.5 million U over 1 hour) is the agent used
most commonly
98
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Tissue plasminogen activator (t-PA) achieves higher
reperfusion rates but is more expensive and is associated with
a higher risk of stroke
• t-PA tends to be given in preference to patients:
o under 50 years of age with anterior MIs
o with a low BP (systolic <100mmHg)
o who have previously received streptokinase
• t-PA must be followed by IV heparin
• Risks of thrombolysis:
o 1% risk of stroke
o 0.7% risk of a major haemorrhage
o 2% risk of an allergic reaction with streptokinase
Follow-up:
• Most will be fully recovered at 2 months and will be able to
return to work
• Most patients should be reviewed as outpatients at 6-8 weeks
• Aspirin should be continued indefinitely
• Lipid-lowering therapy should be considered if the fasting lipid
profile is unfavourable
• ACEIs should be continued indefinitely in those with persistent
impairment of LV function (i.e. an ejection fraction of <40%)
Complications:
• Acute (2-3 days post-infarct):
o Cardiac arrhythmias
o Cardiac failure
o Pericarditis
• Late:
o Recurrent infarction
o Angina
o Thromboembolism
o Ventricular aneurysm
o Mitral valve regurgitation
99
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Ventricular extrasystoles:
• Commonly occur after MI
• May precede the development of VF, particularly if they are:
o Frequent (>5 per minute)
o Multiform (different shapes)
o R-on-T
Ventricular tachycardia:
• May degenerate into VF
• May itself produce serious haemodynamic consequences
• Can be treated with:
o IV lignocaine
o Synchronised cardioversion (initially 200J)
Ventricular fibrillation:
• May occur in the first few hours or days following an MI
• Treated with prompt defibrillation (200-360J)
• Recurrences of VF can be treated with lignocaine infusion or,
in cases of poor LV function, amiodarone
• When VF occurs in the setting of HF, shock or aneurysm (so-
called ‘secondary VF’), the prognosis is very poor unless the
underlying haemodynamic or mechanical cause can be
corrected
• It is prudent to ensure the serum K+ is above 4.5mmol/L
Atrial fibrillation:
• Occurs in ~10% of patients with MI
• May be managed with IV digoxin or IV amiodarone and by
treatment of the underlying pathology
• It is not usually a long-standing problem
Sinus bradycardia:
• Especially associated with acute inferior wall MI
• When symptomatic, treatment consists of:
o Elevating the foot of the bed
o IV atropine 600µg
Prognosis:
• Variable
• Approximately 25% of patients surviving the initial heart
attack die in the first 2 years
• 5-year mortality approaches 30%
100
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pulmonary oedema
Clinical features:
• Patients with alveolar oedema are:
o Acutely breathless
o Wheezing
o Anxious
o Perspiring profusely
o Cough, productive of frothy, blood-tinged (pink)
sputum, which can be copious
o Tachypnoea
o Peripheral circulatory shutdown
o Tachycardia
o Raised JVP
o Gallop rhythm
o Crackles and wheeze are heard throughout the chest
• CXR shows:
o Diffuse haziness
o Kerley B lines (of interstitial oedema)
Treatment:
• Sit the patient up
• Give 60% O2 (unless there is coexisting chronic hypercapnia
due to longstanding respiratory failure)
• IV diuretic therapy with frusemide or bumetanide is given
• Morphine (10-20mg IV) together with an antiemetic (e.g.
metoclopramide 10mg IV or cyclizine 50mg IV) is given:
o This sedates the patient and causes systemic
vasodilatation – it must be avoided if the systolic BP is
<90mmHg
• Venodilators (e.g. GTN) may produce prompt relief by
reducing preload
• Aminophylline (250-500mg or 5mg/kg IV) is infused over 10
minutes:
o Is a PDE inhibitor that causes bronchodilation,
vasodilatation and increased cardiac contractility
o It must be GIVEN SLOWLY due to the risk of
precipitating ventricular arrhythmias
o It is now only used when bronchospasm is present
Sinus arrhythmias
101
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
PR interval 200ms (5 small squares)
QRS complex duration 120ms (3 small squares)
QT interval 400ms (2 large squares)
Sinus arrhythmia:
• A normal variation
• During inspiration, parasympathetic tone decreases and the
heart rate increases
• On expiration, the heart rate falls
Sinus bradycardia:
• A sinus rate of <60bpm during the day or <50bpm during the
night
• Normal in athletes and the elderly
• Causes include:
o Hypothermia
o Hypothyroidism
o Cholestatic jaundice
o Raised ICP
o Drugs (e.g. digitalis, ß-blockers)
o Acute ischaemia/infarction of the sinus node
• Treatment:
o IV atropine 600µg
o Pacemaker if unsuccessful
Sinus tachycardia:
• Sinus rate acceleration to >100bpm
• Causes include:
o Fever
o Exercise
o Emotion
o Pregnancy
o Anaemia
o Thyrotoxicosis
o Catecholamine excess
• Treatment:
o Treat underlying cause
o ß-blockers can be used
102
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Unstable angina
Overview:
• Is a medical emergency which, untreated, will progress to an
MI in over 10% of cases
• Standard therapy (see below) reduces this rate to less than
5%
• However, death within 1 year still occurs in 5-15%
Immediate treatment:
• Heparin 5000U IV bolus then IVI to maintain APPT 1.5-2.5
• Diltiazem 60mg PO TDS
• Atenolol 50-100mg PO OD
• Isosorbide dinitrate 2-20mg/h IVI
• Aspirin 75mg PO OD
• Monitor closely on CCU and exclude (and prevent impeding)
MI
Subsequent management:
• Those at high risk:
o Should proceed promptly to angiography, with a view to
proceeding to revascularisation, where appropriate,
during that admission
• Those at low risk:
o Discharged and assessed electively as outpatients
103
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Ventricular tachyarrhythmias
Types:
• There are 4 main types of ventricular tachyarrhythmias:
o Ventricular premature beats
o Ventricular tachycardia (VT)
o Ventricular fibrillation (VF)
o Torsades de pointes (twisting of points)
Ventricular tachycardia:
• Defined as 3 or more ventricular beats occurring at a rate of
>120bpm
• Often the patient will be hypotensive and ill (but some VTs
are well tolerated)
• ECG shows:
104
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Rapid ventricular rhythm with broad (often >0.14s)
abnormal QRS complexes
o Dissociated P wave activity may be seen
• Treatment:
o May be urgent depending on the haemodynamic
situation
o If the cardiac output and the BP are very depressed,
emergency DC cardioversion must be considered
o On the other hand, if the BP and CO are well
maintained, IV therapy with class I drugs is usually
advised
• First-line treatment consists of:
o Lidocaine (50-100mg IV over 5 minutes)
o Followed by a lidocaine infusion (2-4mg IV per minute)
Ventricular fibrillation:
• This is very rapid and irregular ventricular activation with no
mechanical effect
• The patient is pulseless and becomes rapidly unconscious and
respiration ceases
• ECG shows:
o Shapeless, rapid oscillations and there is no hint of
organized complexes
o It is usually provoked by a ventricular ectopic beat
(especially in acute MI), VT or torsades de pointes
o Rarely reverses spontaneously
• Treatment:
o The only effective treatment is electrical defibrillation or
(on rare occasions) IV bretylium (5-10mg/kg over 5
minutes)
o Basic and advanced life support is needed
Torsades de pointes:
• This arrhythmia is usually short in duration and spontaneously
reverts to sinus rhythm
• It does, however, give rise to presyncope or syncope and
occasionally converts to VF, and sudden death may occur
• ECG shows:
o Rapid, irregular sharp complexes that continuously
change from an upright to an inverted position
o Between spells of tachycardia, the ECG shows a
prolonged QT interval
• Treatment:
o Correction of any electrolyte disturbance
o Cessation of any causative drugs
o Maintenance of the HR with atrial or ventricular pacing
105
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o IV isoprenaline may be effective when QT prolongation
is acquired
o ß-blockade or left stellectomy is advised if QT
prolongation is congenital (isoprenaline is
contraindicated for congenital long-QT syndrome)
106
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• This is a congenital condition caused by an abnormal
myocardial connection between atrium and ventricle (via the
bundle of Kent)
• During sinus rhythm, the electrical impulse can conduct
quickly over this abnormal connection to depolarise part of
the ventricles abnormally
The ECG:
• There is a characteristic ECG pattern of WPW syndrome:
o Short PR interval
o Wide QRS complex
o Slurred upstroke (δ wave) to the QRS complex
• About 50% of those with WPW pattern on the ECG have
tachycardias
• The tachycardias are of 2 sorts:
o Atrioventricular re-entry:
• This is a circus movement tachycardia in which a
depolarisation wave travels from the atrium to the
ventricle (usually through the AV node) and from
the ventricle to the atrium through the abnormal
pathway
• IV adenosine will terminate most of these
tachycardias
o Atrial fibrillation
107
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dermatology
108
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Bullous disease
Overview:
• Primary blistering diseases of the skin are rare
• A variety of skin proteins are important in holding the skin
together
• Inherited abnormalities or immune damage of these proteins
causes abnormal cell separation, inflammation, fluid
accumulation and blistering
• Skin biopsy for light and electron microscopy, together with
immunofluorescence (IMF) studies, is paramount in diagnosis
• One must remember that the most common causes of skin
blistering are:
o Chickenpox
o Herpes
o Impetigo
o Insect bite reactions
Pemphigus vulgaris
Overview:
• Is a potentially fatal blistering disease occurring in all races,
but it is more common in Ashkenazi Jews
• Onset is in middle age
• Males = females
• Is caused by the development of autoantibodies against
desmosomal proteins (dsg3)
Clinical features:
• Mucosal involvement (especially oral ulceration) is common
and may be the presenting sign in up to 50% of cases
• Is then followed by the appearance of flaccid blisters,
particularly involving the trunk
• They tend to become rather itchy
• Blistering usually becomes widespread, but they rapidly
denude; thus pemphigus often presents with erythematous,
weeping erosions
Treatment:
• Very high-dose oral prednisolone (60-100mg daily) or pulsed
Methylprednisolone. This may need to be lifelong
• Other immunosuppressants (e.g. azathioprine,
cyclophosphamide or cyclosporine) are used as steroid-
sparing drugs
• IV immunoglobulin infusions can be useful in resistant cases
109
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Whilst treatment is normally effective, up to 20% of patients
may succumb to either:
o Side-effects of the disease
o Side-effects of the treatment (most common)
Bullous pemphigoid
Overview:
• More common than pemphigus vulgaris
• Presents in later life (usually over the age of 60 years)
• Mucosal involvement is rarer
• Is caused by autoantibodies against a hemidesmosomal
protein
Clinical features:
• Large tense bullae appear anywhere on the skin, but often
involve:
o Limbs
o Hands
o Feet
• They may be centred on an erythematous or urticated
background and they can be haemorrhagic
• Pemphigoid can be very itchy
Treatment:
• High-dose oral prednisolone (30-60mg daily) and steroid-
sparing agents such as azathioprine
• In general, disease control is easier than with pemphigus
vulgaris
• Often, treatment can be withdrawn after 2-3 years
Dermatitis herpetiformis
Overview:
• Is a rare blistering disorder associated with Coeliac disease
and, occasionally, other organ-specific autoimmune disorders
Clinical features:
• Is most common in males
• Can present at any age but is most likely to appear for the
first time in young adult life
• It presents with intensely itchy, small blisters of the skin
• Commonest sites are the:
o Elbows
o Extensor forearms
110
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Scalp
o Buttocks
• The tops of the blisters are usually scratched off; thus crusted
erosions are often seen at presentation
• Remissions and exacerbations are common
Treatment:
• Should always be with a gluten-free diet (GFD)
• Control of the skin disease can be obtained with oral dapsone
(50-200mg daily) or sulphonamides
• If a strict GFD is adhered to, oral medication can often be
withdrawn after 2 years
• The GFD will need to be lifelong – it protects against the rare
complication of small bowel lymphoma
• Use of dapsone:
o Frequently causes a mild dose-related haemolytic
anaemia (which is usually well-tolerated)
o The haemolysis can be devastating if there is G6PD
deficiency
o Liver damage, a polyneuropathy and aplastic anaemia
also occur rarely
o Regular monitoring of a blood count and liver
biochemistry is needed
111
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Types of eczema:
• Are many types
• The 3 main ones are listed below:
o Atopic dermatitis
o Contact dermatitis
o Seborrhoeic dermatitis
Atopic dermatitis
Aetiology:
• Unknown
• Strong familial tendency
• If one parent has atopic disease, the risk for a child of
developing eczema is about 20-30%
• If both parents have atopic eczema, the risk is >50%
Exacerbating factors:
• Exacerbating factors are not necessarily allergens
• Strong detergents, chemicals
• Woollen clothes
• Severe anxiety, stress
• Cat/dog fur (possibly by both allergic and irritant
mechanisms)
Investigations:
112
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Diagnosis is usually clinical
• Atopy is characterised by high serum IgE levels or high
specific IgE levels to certain ingested or inhaled antigens:
o Can be tested by radio-immunoabsorbent assay (RAST
tests) of blood
o Skin-prick testing
Prognosis:
• Vast majority of children with early-onset atopic eczema will
improve spontaneously and ‘clear’ before the teenage years,
50% being clear by the age of 6
• If the onset is late in childhood or in adulthood, the disorder
follows a more chronic remitting/relapsing course
Treatment:
• General measures:
o Avoid known irritants (especially soaps or furry animals)
o Not getting too hot
• Topical therapies:
o Are sufficient to control atopic eczema in most people
and the following ‘triple’ combination often helps:
• Topical steroid bds when needed
• Emollient frequently
• Bath oil (e.g. oilatum or balneum) and soap
substitute (e.g. aqueous cream)
• It should be noted that topical steroids can be safely
prescribed for long-term, intermittent, use
• Antibiotics:
o Are needed for bacterial infection
o Usually given orally for 7-10 days
o E.g. flucloxacillin (500mg tds) is effective against
Staphylococcus
o E.g. penicillin V (500mg tds) acts against Streptococcus
o Erythromycin (500mg tds) is useful if there is allergy to
penicillin
Overview:
113
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• One may suspect this if the eczema is in an unusual or
localised distribution, especially if there is no personal or
family history of atopic disease
• A history of an exacerbation of eczema at the workplace is
also suggestive
• This can happen by 2 mechanisms:
o Direct irritation
o Allergic reaction (type IV delayed hypersensitivity)
• A detailed history about occupation, hobbies, cosmetic
products and clothing and contact with chemicals is necessary
Irritant eczema:
• Can occur in any individual
• It often occurs on the hands after repeated exposures to
irritants such as detergents, soaps or bleach
• It is, therefore, common in housewives, cleaners,
hairdressers, mechanics and nurses
Contact eczema:
• Occurs after repeated exposure to a chemical substance but
only in those people who are susceptible to develop an allergic
reaction
• Common (up to 4% of the population)
• Most common culprits are:
o Nickel (costume jewellery, buckles)
o Latex
o Chromate (in cement)
Treatment:
• As for atopic eczema, as well as strict avoidance of any
causative agent
• This may involve the wearing of protective clothing (e.g.
gloves) or may involve a change of occupation or hobby
Seborrhoeic eczema
114
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• 3 age groups are affected:
• In childhood:
o Common
o Presents in the first few months of life as ‘cradle cap’ in
most babies
o May be, in part, due to the effect of maternal androgens
on infant sebaceous glands
o Yellowish, greasy, thick crusts are seen on the scalp
o A more widespread erythematous scaly rash can be
seen over the trunk, especially affecting the nappy area
o Unlike atopic eczema, the child is normally unbothered
as there is little associated pruritus
o Usually improves spontaneously after a few weeks
• In young adults:
o Males > females
o Occurs in 1-3% of the population
o Presents as an erythematous scaling:
• Along the sides of the nose
• In the eyebrows
• Around the eyes
• Extending into the scalp (giving rise to marked
dandruff)
• May affect the skin over the sternum and of the
glans penis
• In elderly people:
o Can be quite severe and progress to involve large areas
of the body
o May even cause erythroderma
Treatment:
• The treatment is suppressive rather than curative
• Combination of:
o Mild steroid ointment (e.g. 1% hydrocortisone bds)
o Topical antifungal cream (e.g. miconazole cream bds)
o Ketoconazole shampoo and arachis oil are useful for the
scalp
115
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dermatology terminology
Terminology:
Macule Flat, impalpable lesion
Papule Raised lesion that is <1cm across
Nodule Raised lesion that is >1cm across
Plaque Flat raised lesion usually formed by papules
fusing together
Vesicle Fluid-filled lesion <1cm across
Bulla Fluid-filled lesion >1cm across
Orthoketatosis Thick scale
Parakeratosis Silvery scaling
Crust Dried serous exudates
Erythema Red – blanches on diascopy (pressing with
piece of glass)
Purpura Red – does not blanch on diascopy
Hypopigmented Pale
Hyperpigmented Dark
Leukoderma White
116
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Lichen planus
Clinical features:
• Rash is characterised by small, purple, flat-topped polygonal
papules that are intensely pruritic
• It is common on the flexors of the wrists and the lower legs,
but can occur anywhere
• The lesions may fuse into plaques, especially on the lower
legs and in Africans
• Hyperpigmentation is common after resolution of lesions,
especially in patients with pigmented skin
• If lesions occur in the scalp, they may cause a scarring
alopecia
• Mucosal involvement is seen in 50% of cases:
o The mouth is the most commonly affected, but the
anogenital region can be involved
o It can present as lacy white streaks, white plaques or as
ulceration
o Prominent symptom is pain, rather than pruritus
Prognosis:
• The condition often clears within 2 years, but can recur at
intervals
• The hypertrophic and atrophic variants and mucosal disease
are more persistent, lasting years
• Ulcerative mucosal disease is pre-malignant
Treatment:
• Use of potent topical steroids (e.g. 0.05% clobetasol
proprionate)
• Occasional use of oral prednisolone (30mg od for 2-4 weeks)
• Resistant cases may respond to:
o UV therapy
o Oral retinoids (0.5mg/kg daily)
o Azathioprine (50-100mg daily)
117
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Most common malignant skin tumour
• Most relate to excessive sun exposure
• Common in later life on exposed sites – although are rare on
the ear
• They can present as a slow-growing papule or nodule which
may go on to ulcerate
• Telangiectasia over the tumour or a skin-coloured jelly-like
‘pearly edge’ may be seen
• A flat, diffuse superficial form exists (‘morphoeic’)
• The lesion will grow slowly and erode structures if untreated
• Almost never metastasizes
Treatment:
• Usually surgical excision
• Radiotherapy can be useful for large superficial forms
• Curettage is occasionally used in older patients, although not
for central facial lesions as they often recur
• Very superficial lesions may be treated with Cryotherapy
• Follow-up is advised
Overview:
• Is a somewhat more aggressive skin tumour which can
metastasise
• Most relate to sun exposure and they arise in pre-existing
solar keratoses or Bowen’s disease
• They can also arise as a result of chronic inflammation, such
as in lupus vulgaris
• Rarely, multiple tumours may arise owing to arsenic ingestion
in early life
• Multiple tumours also occur in people who have had prolonged
periods of immunosuppression
• They present clinically as fairly rapidly growing nodules which
often ulcerate
• Examination of regional lymph nodes is essential
• They are most common on sun-exposed sites in later life
• One should have a high index of suspicion for ulcerated
lesions on the lower lip or ear
118
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Treatment:
• Excision or radiotherapy
Malignant melanoma
Overview:
• Is the most serious form of skin cancer as metastasis can
occur early and it causes a number of deaths, even in young
people
• Risk factors include:
o Childhood sun exposure
o Sun burning
o Atypical mole syndrome
o Giant congenital melanocytic naevi
o Positive family history of malignant melanoma
• Is more common in later life but many young adults are also
affected
• It should always be suspected in rapidly growing or bleeding
pigmented lesions
• A halo of erythema or the appearance of satellite lesions
should also alert the examiner
• 4 clinical types exist:
o Lentigo maligna melanoma:
• Is where a patch of lentigo maligna develops a
papule or nodule, signalling invasive tumour
o Superficial spreading malignant melanoma:
• Is a large, flat, irregularly pigmented lesion which
grows laterally before vertical invasion develops
o Nodular malignant melanoma:
• Is the most aggressive type
• It presents as rapidly growing pigmented nodules
which bleed or ulcerate
o Acral lentiginous malignant melanoma:
• Arise as pigmented lesions on the palm, sole or
under the nail
• Usually present late
Treatment:
• Urgent wide local excision of the lesion
• Metastatic disease is best managed by an oncologist and can
involve surgery to lymph nodes, radiotherapy,
immunotherapy and chemotherapy
119
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pityriasis rosea
Overview:
• Self-limiting rash seen in adolescents and young adults
• Unknown cause but is thought to be a viral or post-viral rash
Clinical features:
• The rash consists of circular or oval pink macules with a
collarette of scale
• Is more prominent on the trunk than on the limbs
• The long axis of the oval lesions tends to run along
dermatomal lines, giving a ‘Christmas tree’ pattern on the
back
• The rash may be preceded by a large solitary patch with
peripheral scaling (‘herald patch’) and this is most commonly
found on the trunk
• Is usually asymptomatic
• Spontaneously resolves over 4-8 weeks
Treatment:
• Not normally required
• 0.5% menthol in aqueous cream may help relieve the itching
• In persistent cases, UVB may be helpful
120
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Bowen’s disease:
• This is a form of intra-epidermal carcinoma-in-situ which
rarely can become invasive
• It presents on exposed skin as an isolated scaly red patch or
plaque looking rather like psoriasis, although it has a rather
irregular edge
• The lesions do not clear, but slowly increase in size over the
years
• Treatment:
o Cryotherapy
o Topical 5-fluorouracil cream
o Curettage
121
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Psoriasis
Overview:
• Is a common papulo-squamous disorder affecting 2% of the
population
• Characterised by well demarcated, red scaly plaques
• The skin becomes inflamed and hyperproliferates to about 10x
the normal rate
• Males = females
• The age of onset occurs in 2 peaks:
o Early onset (16-22 years) – more common and is
associated with a +ve family history
o Late onset (55-60 years)
Pathology:
• Skin biopsy shows acanthosis and Parakeratosis, reflecting the
increase in skin turnover
• The granular layer is often absent
• Polymorphonuclear abscesses may be seen in the upper
epidermis
Types of psoriasis:
• Chronic plaque psoriasis
• Flexural psoriasis
• Guttate psoriasis
• Erythrodermic and pustular psoriasis
Flexural psoriasis:
• Tends to occur in later life
• Characterised by well demarcated red glazed plaques confined
to flexures such as the:
o Groin
o Natal cleft
o Sub-mammary area
122
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Rarely there is any scaling
• In the absence of psoriasis elsewhere, the rash is often
misdiagnosed as candida intertrigo
Guttate psoriasis:
• ‘Raindrop-like’ psoriasis is a variant most commonly seen in
children and young adults
• An explosive eruption of very small circular or oval plaques
appears over the trunk about 2 weeks after a Streptococcal
sore throat
• It usually resolves spontaneously over 1-2 months even
without treatment
Associated features:
• Nails:
o Up to 50% of patients develop nail changes and rarely
these can precede the onset of skin disease
o There are 5 types of nail change:
• Pitting of the nail-plate
• Distal separation of the nail-plate (onycholysis)
• Yellow-brown discolouration
• Subungual hyperkeratosis
• Rarely, a damaged nail matrix and lost nail-plate
o Treatment of nail dystrophy is very difficult
• Arthritis:
o Up to 5% of patients develop psoriatic arthritis and
most of these will have nail changes
o There are 5 patterns of psoriatic arthritis:
• Distal interphalangeal arthritis
• Peripheral mono- or oligoarthritis
• Symmetrical ‘rheumatoid arthritis pattern’ but
seronegative
123
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Spondylitis or sacro-iliitis (especially HLA-B27
+ve)
• (Rarely) arthritis mutilans – causing destruction
and resorption of bone leading to telescoping of
affected digits
Prognosis:
• Most individuals who develop chronic plaque psoriasis will
have the condition for life
• It fluctuates in severity and there are no available tests to
predict outcome
• Guttate psoriasis resolves spontaneously and in up to 30% of
individuals does not recur
• However, 70% will go on to get recurrent guttate attacks or
will progress to chronic plaque psoriasis
Treatment:
• This is concerned with control rather than cure
• Most patients can be improved with topical therapies:
o Mild-to-moderate topical steroids
o Calcipotriol (a synthetic vitamin D3 analogue)
o Purified coal tar
• Salicylic acid can be a useful adjunct
• All should be applied bds to palpable lesions
• Once lesions have flattened, therapy can be discontinued
• UV therapy is also useful
• Use of methotrexate:
o Normally given once weekly
o Some patients experience extreme nausea on the day
they take it
o Regular blood tests need to be done to monitor for bone
marrow suppression and liver damage
o Alcohol must be avoided as this increases the risk of
Hepatotoxicity
o Long-term users will need a liver biopsy every 2-3 years
to accurately monitor for hepatic damage
124
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidermis
Disorders of keratinisation:
• E.g. icthyoses
• Caused by inherited genetic defects of protein synthesis
• Produce scaly diseases
Abnormalities of pigmentation:
• Loss of melanocytes leads to depigmentation of the skin
• E.g. vitiligo:
o Common
o Sometimes disfiguring
o Can begin at any age
125
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Adnexal structures (hair shafts, sweat glands, etc)
Abnormalities of hair:
• Monilethrix – autosomal dominant and causes ‘beading’ of the
hair
• Alopecia areata – very common condition causing patchy hair
loss. It is probably an autoimmune-mediated attack in which
the hair follicle is surrounded by lymphocytes
• Androgenetic alopecia – is age-related baldness which affects
54% of males and 24% of females over the age of 30. It is
caused by a genetically-programmed alteration in metabolism
of androgens by hair follicles
Dermis
126
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Endocrinology
127
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acromegaly
Clinical features:
• Increased size of hands/feet
• Headaches
• Visual deterioration (especially loss of peripheral vision)
• Weight gain
• Amenorrhoea/oligomenorrhoea
• Galactorrhoea
• Impotence/poor libido
• Deep voice
• Excessive sweating
• Polyuria/polydipsia
• Prognathism
• HT
Investigations:
• GH levels:
o Raised
o In normal adults, GH is usually <1mU/L
• Glucose tolerance test:
o Is diagnostic
o Acromegalics fail to suppress GH below 1mU/L
o Some show a paradoxical rise in GH
o About 25% of acromegalics have a diabetic glucose
tolerance test
• IGF-1 level:
o Is almost always raided in acromegaly
o A single plasma level of IGF-1 reflects mean 24-hour GH
levels and is useful in diagnosis
• Visual field defects are common
• MRI scans of the pituitary:
o Will almost always reveal the pituitary adenoma
• Prolactin levels:
o Mild to moderate hyperprolactinaemia occurs in 30% of
patients
Treatment:
• Untreated, acromegaly results in markedly reduced survival
with deaths from:
o Heart failure
o Coronary artery disease
o Hypertension-related causes
128
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Surgery:
o Trans-sphenoidal surgery is generally agreed as the
appropriate first-line therapy
o Results in clinical remission in a majority of cases
(about 60%) with pituitary micro-adenoma, but only in
a minority of those with macro-adenoma
• External radiotherapy:
o Normally used after pituitary surgery fails to normalise
GH levels rather than as a primary therapy
• It is combined with medium-term treatment with octreotide (a
somatostatin analogue) or a dopamine agonist because of the
slow biochemical response to radiotherapy, which may take
10 years or more
129
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Addison’s disease
(primary hypoadrenalism)
Pathophysiology:
• In this uncommon condition
• Destruction of the entire adrenal cortex
• Glucocorticoid, mineralocorticoid and sex steroid synthesis
are, therefore, all reduced
• This differs from hypothalamic-pituitary disease, in which
mineralocorticoid secretion remains largely intact (being
predominantly stimulated by angiotensin II)
• In Addison’s disease, reduced cortisol levels lead (through a
feedback loop) to increased CRF (corticotrophin releasing
factor) and ACTH (adrenocorticotrophic hormone) production
• The increased ACTH production leads, directly, to
hyperpigmentation
• Women > men
Investigations:
• Once Addison’s is suspected, investigation is urgent
130
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• If the patient is severely ill or very hypotensive,
hydrocortisone 100mg should be given IM together with IV
saline
• Single cortisol measurements:
o Are of little value
o A random cortisol of <100nmol/L during the day is
highly suggestive
o A random cortisol of >550nmol/L makes the diagnosis
unlikely (but not impossible)
• The short ACTH stimulation test:
• An absent or impaired cortical response is seen,
confirmed if necessary by a long ACTH stimulation test
to exclude adrenal suppression by steroids
• A 0900hr plasma ACTH level:
o A high level (>80ng/L) with a low to normal cortisol
confirms primary hypoadrenalism
• Electrolytes and urea:
o Hyponatraemia
o Hyperkalaemia
• Blood glucose:
o May be low (with symptomatic hypoglycaemia)
• Adrenal antibodies:
o Present in many cases of autoimmune adrenalitis
• CXR/AXR:
o May show evidence of TB and/or calcified adrenals
• Serum aldosterone:
o Is reduced with high plasma renin activity
Treatment:
• Long-term treatment is with replacement glucocorticoids and
mineralocorticoids.
• TB must be treated if present or suspected
• Adequacy of glucocorticoid dose is judged by:
o Clinical well-being
131
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Normal cortisol levels during the day whilst on
replacement hydrocortisone
• Fludrocortisone replacement is assessed by:
o Restoration of serum electrolytes to normal
o BP response to posture (it should not fall >10mmHg
systolic after 2 minutes standing)
o Suppression of plasma renin activity to normal
Patient advice:
• All patients requiring replacement steroids should:
o Carry a steroid card
o Wear a medic-alert bracelet (which gives details of their
condition)
o Keep an up-to-date ampoule of hydrocortisone at home
in case oral therapy is impossible
Acute hypoadrenalism:
• The major deficiencies are of salt, steroid and glucose
• Assuming normal CVS function, the following procedures are
required:
o 100mg of IV hydrocortisone
o 1L normal saline given over 30-60mins
o Subsequent saline requirements may be for several
litres within 24 hours (assess with CVP line if necessary)
o Hydrocortisone 100mg IM 6-hourly, until the patient is
clinically stable
o Dextrose should be infused if there is hypoglycaemia
o Oral replacement medication is then started, initially
hydrocortisone 20,g 8-hourly, reducing to 20-30mg in
divided doses over a few days
o Fludrocortisone is unnecessary acutely as the high
cortisol doses provide sufficient mineralocorticoid
activity – it should be introduced later
132
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cushing’s syndrome
Clinical features:
• Centripetal obesity
• Amenorrhoea/oligomenorrhoea
• Thin skin/easy bruising
• Hair growth/acne
• Growth arrest in children
• Polyuria/polydipsia
• Moon face
• Buffalo hump (interscapular fat pad)
• HT
• Poor wound healing
• Osteoporosis
• Oedema poor libido
Diagnosis:
• There are 2 phases to the investigation:
1. Confirmation of the presence or absence of Cushing’s
syndrome
2. Differential diagnosis of its cause (e.g. pituitary, adrenal or
ectopic)
133
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• 48-hour low-dose dexamethasone test:
o Normal individuals suppress plasma cortisol to
<50nmol/L
o Patients with Cushing’s syndrome fail to show complete
suppression of plasma or urinary cortisol levels
• Circadian rhythm:
o After 48 hours in hospital, cortisol samples are taken at
0900h and 2400h (without warning the patient).
o Normal subjects show a pronounced circadian variation
o Those with Cushing’s syndrome have high midnight
cortisol levels (>100nmol/L), though the 0900h value
may be normal
134
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
135
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diabetes
Clinical presentation
Acute presentation:
• Young people may present with a 2-4 wk history and report
the classic triad of symptoms:
o Polyuria (due to osmotic diuresis)
o Thirst
o Weight loss (accelerated breakdown of muscle / fat
secondary to insulin deficiency)
• Ketoacidosis may be the presenting feature if these early
symptoms are not recognised and treated.
136
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Subacute presentation:
• Clinical onset may be over several months, particularly in
older patients
• Common features include:
o Polyuria
o Thirst
o Weight loss
• Medical attention is commonly sought for:
o Visual blurring
o Lack of energy
o Pruritis vulvae or balanitis that is due to Candida
infection.
Investigation of diabetes
Urine analysis:
• Glycosuria is measured using sensitive glucose-specific
dipstick methods
• Glycosuria is NOT diagnostic of diabetes but indicates the
need for further investigations
137
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Impaired glucose tolerance (IGT)
Overview:
• If an oral glucose test is administered at random to a large
population, 1-2% will be found to have unsuspected diabetes
• A much larger group (~5%) fall into an intermediate category
referred to as ‘impaired glucose tolerance’ (IGT)
• Follow-up shows that some 2-4% of those with IGT go on to
develop diabetes annually
• Obesity and lack of physical exercise increases risk of
progression to frank diabetes
Injections:
Insulin is delivered either via a plastic syringe or a pen-injection
device
• Injections are given to a pinch of skin on the:
o Thighs
o Abdomen
o Upper arm
• The injection site should be changed regularly to prevent
areas of lipohypertrophy
• Rate of insulin absorption depends on local subcutaneous
blood flow and is accelerated by:
o Exercise
o Local massage
138
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Warm environment
• Rate of absorption (fastest to slowest):
o Abdomen
o Upper arm
o Thigh
Soluble insulin:
• Forms a clear solution which is short-acting when injected.
Insulin analogues:
• These are modifications of the human insulin molecule which
allow the hormone a much more rapid effect than the short-
acting preparations
139
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Requirement s rise thereafter and a multiple injection regimen
is then appropriate for most younger patients
Multiple injections:
• If glycaemic control is inadequate with the standard approach,
the alternatives are:
o Multiple insulin injections
o Continuous subcutaneous insulin infusion (CSII)
• Multiple injection regimens and infusion devices have the
advantage of flexibility concerning mealtimes, which is of
great value to patients with busy jobs, shift workers and
those who travel regularly
Suphonylureas:
• e.g: Tolbutamide, Glibenclamide
• Their principle action is to increase insulin secretion in
response to glucose and other secretagogues
• Mechanism of action:
o Close ATP-sensitive potassium channels on the Β-cell
membrane
o The resulting depolarisation promotes calcium influx,
which is a signal for insulin release
140
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• When used?
o Are ineffective in patients without a functional Β-cell
mass
o Should be avoided in young ketotic patients (who
require early insulin therapy)
o Contraindicated in pregnancy
• Other points:
o Should be used with care in patients with liver disease
and only those primarily excreted by the liver should be
used in those patients with renal impairment.
o All encourage weight gain (therefore, are not the first
choice for obese patients)
• Drug interactions/side-effects:
o Bind to circulating albumin and, therefore, may be
displaced by other drugs
o Interact with warfarin
o Hypoglycaemia is the most common and dangerous
side-effect
Biguanides:
• e.g: Metformin
• Unclear mechanism, but:
o They reduce gluconeogenesis
o This suppresses hepatic glucose output
o Thereby, increasing insulin sensitivity
• Benefits:
o Rarely induces hypoglycaemia
o Doesn’t induce weight gain
• Side-effects:
o Anorexia
o Epigastric discomfort
o Diarrhoea
o Lactic acidosis in those with liver/renal impairment
α-glucosidase inhibitors:
e.g: Acarbose
• Mechanism of action:
o Inhibits the enzymes which are responsible for the
breakdown of CHOs in the intestine
o This results in poor absorption of dietary CHO and a
reduced postprandial rise in blood glucose
• Side-effects:
o Abdominal discomfort
o Flatulence
o Diarrhoea
141
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Complications of insulin therapy
Insulin resistance:
• The most common cause is obesity
• Are often associated behavioural problems
Weight gain:
• Patients who are non-compliant with their diet and
predisposed to weight gain may show progressive weight gain
on treatment
• Insulin makes you feel hungry!
Hypoglycaemia:
• Most common complication of insulin therapy
• Symptoms develop when blood [glucose] < 3mmol/L
• Symptoms typically develop over a few mins
• Common signs/symptoms:
o Sweating
o Tremor
o Palpitations
o Pallor
• Many patients with long-standing diabetes report
‘hyperglycaemia unawareness’
• These patients are at a greater risk of a more severe
hypoglycaemia, with signs including:
o Drowsiness
o Clumsiness
o Inappropriate behaviour
o Aggression
• Just beyond these symptoms, patients enter a hypoglycaemic
coma, often with convulsions
• 1 in 3 diabetics will enter a hypoglycaemic coma during their
lifetime
142
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Patients are most at risk of hypoglycaemia just before meals
and at night
• Irregular eating habits, unusual exertion or excessive alcohol
may precipitate episodes
Treatment of hypoglycaemia
Mild hypoglycaemia:
• Administer any form of rapidly absorbed CHO (e.g. glucose
sweets)
• Drowsy individuals should be able to take CHO in liquid form
(e.g. Lucozade)
• Beware of giving too much CHO, since this causes rebound
hyperglycaemia
Nocturnal hypoglycaemia:
• Basal insulin requirements fall during the night, but increase
from about 4am onwards, at a time when levels of injected
insulin are falling
• As a result, many patients awake with a high glucose level but
find that increasing the dose of insulin at night increases the
risk of hypoglycaemia in the early hours
• Can be minimised in 3 ways:
o Checking that a bedtime snack is taken regularly
o Taking intermediate insulin before bedtime (rather than
at supper)
o Reducing the dose of soluble insulin before supper,
since the effects of this persist well into the night
The diet for a diabetic is, in principle, no different from the diet
considered healthy for the population as a whole
143
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Carbohydrate:
• Unrefined rather than simple sugars
• CHO is absorbed slowly from fibre-rich foods, preventing the
rapid swings in circulating glucose seen when refined sugars
are consumed.
Calories:
• Should be tailored to the needs of the diabetic patient
• Composition:
o CHO 50-55%
o Fat 30-35%
o Protein 15%
• An overweight patient is started on a reducing diet of 1000-
1600 kcal daily
• A lean patient is put on an isocaloric diet
• Patients who are underweight (because of untreated diabetes)
require energy supplementation
144
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Atheroma and DM:
• Compared with non-diabetics, the symptoms are greater, the
lesions are more extensive and severe and hyperlipidaemia is
more common
• Onset:
o T1DM – from 10-15yrs after dx
o T2DM – not related to severity or duration of DM (may
be present at dx)
MI and DM:
• Mortality during the month following an infarct:
o 42% for diabetics
o 20% for non-diabetics
Syndrome X:
• Hyperinsulinaemia that is due to insulin resistance associated
with obesity is sometimes known as syndrome X
145
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Autonomic neuropathy
• Trauma
• Sensory neuropathy
• PVD
• Decreased resistance to infection
Types of DFD:
• There are 3 main variations:
o The neuropathic foot
o The ischaemic foot
o The neuroischaemic foot
Overview:
• There are 3 main microvascular complications of diabetes:
o Diabetic retinopathy
o Diabetic neuropathy
146
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Diabetic nephropathy
• The microvascular complications tend to manifest themselves
10-20yrs after diagnosis in young patients
• They present earlier in older patients, probably because these
have had unrecognized diabetes for months or even years
prior to diagnosis
Diabetic glomerulosclerosis:
• Manifests itself 15-25 yrs after dx
• Affects 25-35% of patients diagnosed before the age of 30 yrs
147
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Leading cause of premature death in young diabetics
• Pathophysiology:
o Initial structural lesion in the glomerulus is thickening of
the basement membrane
o We get a progressive leakage of large molecules
(particularly protein) into the urine
o Earliest evidence of protein in the urine is
‘microalbuminuria’ (amounts of urinary albumin so small
as to be undetectable by dipsticks)
o Microalbuminuria may progress to persistent proteinuria
• At the stage of persistent proteinuria:
o Plasma creatinine may be normal but the patient is 5-10
yrs from ESRF
o A rise in plasma creatinine is a late feature
o Patients typically have a normochromic normocytic
anaemia and hypertension
Diabetic neuropathy:
• There are two proposed mechanisms for the damage of
peripheral nerve tissue:
1. Vascular hypothesis:
• This postulates occlusion of the vasa nervorum
2. Metabolic hypothesis:
• Hyperglycaemia leads to increased formation of
sorbitol and fructose in Schwann cells, accumulation
of these disrupts function and structure
• There are 6 main types of diabetic neuropathy:
148
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Symmetrical (mainly sensory) polyneuropathy
o Acute painful neuropathy
o Mononeuropathy and mononeuritis multiplex:
• Cranial nerve lesions
• Isolated peripheral nerve lesions
o Radiculopathy
o Autonomic neuropathy
o Diabetic amyotrophy
149
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diabetic amyotrophy:
• Usually seen in older men with diabetes
• Presentation is with painful wasting (usually asymmetrical) of
the quadriceps muscles
• The wasting may be very marked
• Affected area is usually extremely tender
• Diabetic amyotrophy is usually associated with periods of poor
glycaemic control and may be present at dx
• It often resolves with time and careful control of blood glucose
150
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Primary or secondary gonadal failure
o Hypothyroidism
o Inadequate vascular supply owing to atheroma in the
pudendal arteries
Urine tests:
• Simple to perform using a dipstick and it can usually be
assumed that a patient with consistently negative tests and
no symptoms of hypoglycaemia is fairly well controlled
• It should be noted that the correlation between urine tests
and blood glucose is poor for 3 reasons:
1. Changes in urine glucose lag behind changes in blood
glucose
2. The mean renal threshold is ~10mmol/L but the range is
wide (it also increases with age)
3. Urine tests can give no clear guidance concerning blood
glucose levels below the renal threshold
151
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
These should be checked at least once a year:
• Biochemical assessment of metabolic control (e.g.
glycosylated Hb test)
• Measure bodyweight
• BP
• Plasma lipids
• Visual acuity
• Examine state of retina
• Renal function tests (e.g. creatinine, proteinuria)
• Check condition of feet, pulses and neurology
• Review CVS risk factors
• Review self-monitoring and injection techniques
• Review eating habits
152
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Typically associated with nausea/vomiting, leading to
further loss of fluid and electrolytes
o The excess ketones are excreted in the urine but also
appear on the breath, producing a distinctive smell
similar to that of acetone
o Respiratory compensation for the metabolic acidosis
leads to hyperventilation (described as ‘air hunger’)
• Untreated, severe DKA is invariably fatal
Clinical features:
• Acidosis
• Hyperventilation (Kussmaul respiration). This becomes less
marked in severe acidosis owing to respiratory depression
• Nausea
• Vomiting
• Abdominal pain (can be so severe as to be confused with an
acute abdomen)
• Severe dehydration
• Most patients are confused and in a stupor
• 5% present in a coma
Management:
• Replace fluid losses with normal saline
• Replace electrolyte losses:
o Potassium levels need to be monitored with great care
o Patients have a total body potassium deficit although
initial plasma levels may not be low
o Insulin therapy leads to uptake of potassium by the
cells with a consequent fall in plasma levels
o Potassium is, therefore, given as soon as insulin therapy
is started
• Restore the acid-base balance:
o A patient with healthy kidneys will rapidly compensate
for the metabolic acidosis once the circulating volume is
restored
o Only consider bicarbonate if the pH is < 7
• Administer insulin:
o Soluble insulin is given as an IV infusion where facilities
for adequate supervision exist, otherwise as hourly IM
injections
o Do not give subcutaneously as the peripheral
blood flow is reduced in a shocked patient
• Monitor blood glucose closely
• Replace the energy losses
• Seek the underlying cause (especially infection)
153
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Problems of management:
• Hypotension:
o This may lead to renal failure. Give plasma expanders or
whole blood if systolic BP < 80mmHg
• Coma:
o It is essential to pass a NG tube to prevent a drowsy
patient aspirating when vomiting
• Cerebral oedema:
o Rare and believed to be due to excessive rehydration.
High mortality
• Hypothermia:
o Monitor patient’s temperature rectally to avoid this
• Late complications (e.g. stasis pneumonia and DVT)
154
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• This is where severe hyperglycaemia develops without
significant ketosis. It is the metabolic emergency
characteristic of uncontrolled NIDDM
• Patients present in middle or later life, often with previously
undiagnosed diabetes
Clinical features:
• Dehydration
• Stupor
• Coma
• Impairment of consciousness is directly related to the level of
hyperosmolality
• Evidence of underlying illness may be present (e.g.
pneumonia or pyelonephritis) and the hyperosmolar state
may predispose to:
o CVA
o MI
o Lower limb arterial insufficiency
Treatment:
• Replace fluid with normal saline
• Administer insulin with care (as many patients will be
extremely sensitive to it). Start off infusing at a rate of 3U/hr
for the first 2-3 hrs, increasing to 6U/hr if glucose is falling
too slowly.
Prognosis:
• Reported mortality is as high as 20-30%, mainly because of
the advanced age of the patients and the frequency of
intercurrent illness
• Unlike DKA, non-ketotic hyperglycaemia is not an absolute
indication for subsequent insulin therapy, and survivors may
do well on diet and oral agents
155
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Goitre
Causes:
• Physiological:
o Puberty
o Pregnancy
• Autoimmune:
o Grave’s disease
o Hashimoto’s disease
• Thyroiditis:
o Acute (De Quervain’s thyroiditis)
o Chronic fibrotic (Reidel’s thyroiditis)
• Iodine deficiency (endemic goitre)
• Dyshormonogenesis
• Goitrogens (e.g. sulphonylureas)
Types:
• Simple
• Multiple nodular
• Solitary nodular
• Fibrotic
• Malignant:
o Adenoma
o Carcinoma
o Lymphoma
Simple goitre:
• In this instance, no clear cause is found for enlargement of
the thyroid, which is usually smooth and soft
• It may be associated with thyroid growth-stimulating
antibodies
156
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• These symptoms suggest the possibility of a thyroid
carcinoma
• However, the majority of such nodules are cystic or benign
and, indeed, may simply be the largest solitary nodule of a
multinodular goitre
• Risk factors for malignancy include:
o Previous irradiation
o Longstanding iodine deficiency
o Familial history
• Solitary toxic nodules (Plummer’s syndrome) are quite
uncommon and may be associated with T3 production
Investigations:
• Thyroid function tests (normal in brackets):
o TSH (0.5-5mU/L)
o T4 (70-140mmol/L)
o T3 (1.2-3nmol/L)
• Chest and thoracic inlet X-rays
• Fine needle aspiration (FNA):
o In patients with a solitary nodule or a dominant nodule
in a multinodular goitre, there is a 5% chance of
malignancy
o In view of this, a FNA is performed
• Ultrasound:
o Good for delineating nodules
o Can demonstrate whether the nodules are cystic or solid
• Thyroid scan:
o Uses either 125I or 131I
o Useful in distinguishing between functioning (hot) or
non-functioning (cold) nodules
o A hot nodule is rarely malignant
o A cold nodule is malignant in 10% of cases
Treatment:
• During puberty or pregnancy, a goitre associated with
euthyroidism rarely requires intervention
• If euthyroid, the patient should be reassured that
spontaneous resolution is likely
• In other situations, the patient should be rendered euthyroid
• Indications for surgical intervention are:
o The possibility of malignancy
157
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Pressure symptoms on the trachea (or, more rarely, the
oesophagus)
o Cosmetic reasons
158
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Causes of hyperuricaemia:
• Impaired excretion of uric acid:
o Chronic renal disease
o Drug therapy:
• Thiazide diuretics
• Low-dose aspirin
o Lead toxicity
• 1˚ hyperparathyroidism
• Hypothyroidism
• Increased production of uric acid:
o Myeloproliferative disorders (e.g. polycythaemia vera)
o Lymphoproliferative disorders (e.g. leukaemia)
o Carcinoma
o Severe psoriasis
Clinical features:
• Hyperuricaemia causes 4 clinical syndromes:
o Acute urate synovitis – gout
o Chronic polyarticular gout
o Chronic tophaceous gout
o Urate renal stone formation
Acute gout:
• Typically middle-aged men
• Sudden onset of agonising pain, swelling and redness of the
first MTP joint
• The attack occurs at any time but may be precipitated by:
o Too much food or alcohol
o Dehydration
o Commencement of a diuretic
• Untreated attacks last ~7 days
• In 25% of attacks, a joint other than the great toe is affected
159
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chronic tophaceous gout:
• Sodium urate forms smooth white deposits (tophi) in skin and
around joints
• They may occur on the:
o Ear lobe
o Fingers
o Achilles tendon
• Large deposits are unsightly and ulcerate
• There is chronic joint pain and sometimes superimposed acute
gouty attacks
Investigations:
• Joint fluid microscopy
• Serum urate:
o Is usually raised (>600µmol/L)
o If normal, re-check it several weeks after the attack as
the level falls immediately after an acute attack
• Serum urea and creatinine:
o For signs of renal impairment
Treatment:
• The use of NSAIDs in high doses rapidly reduces the pain and
swelling
• Initial doses (taken with food) are:
o Naproxen 750mg immediately, then 500mg 8-12 hourly
o Diclofenac 75-100mg immediately, then 50mg 6-8
hourly
o Indomethacin 75mg immediately, then 50mg 6-8 hourly
• After 24-48 hours, reduced doses are given for a further week
• In individuals with a history of peptic ulceration, alternative
treatments include:
o Colchicine 1mg immediately, then 0.5mg 6-12 hourly
(but this causes diarrhoea)
o Methylprednisolone IM or intra-articular depot
160
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Reduces serum urate levels rapidly and is relatively
non-toxic (but should be used in low doses (50-100mg)
in renal impairment
o Skin rashes are the most common side-effect
• Uricosuric agents:
o E.g. probenecid
o Increase urate excretion
o Used in individuals who are allergic to allopurinol
o Should NOT be used in renal failure or in patients with
urate stones
161
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hypercalcaemia
Primary hyperparathyroidism:
• Caused by single (>80%) parathyroid adenomas or by diffuse
hyperplasia of all the glands (15-20%)
• Multiple parathyroid adenomas are rare and parathyroid
carcinoma is even less common (<1%), although it usually
causes severe hypercalcaemia
Secondary hyperparathyroidism:
• Is physiological compensatory hypertrophy of all parathyroids
due to hypocalcaemia (such as occurs in vitamin D deficiency
or renal failure)
• PTH levels are raised but Ca2+ levels are low or normal
• PTH falls to normal after correction of the cause of
hypocalcaemia (if possible)
Tertiary hyperparathyroidism:
• Is the development of apparently autonomous parathyroid
hyperplasia after longstanding secondary hyperparathyroidism
(most often in renal failure)
• Plasma Ca2+ and PO43- are both raised, the latter often grossly
so
• Parathyroidectomy is necessary at this stage
Causes of hypercalcaemia:
• Excessive PTH secretion:
o Primary hyperparathyroidism (commonest by far)
o Tertiary hyperparathyroidism
o Ectopic PTH secretion (very rare)
• Excess action of vitamin D:
o Iatrogenic or self-administered excess
o Granulomatous diseases (e.g. sarcoidosis, TB)
o Lymphoma
• Excessive calcium intake:
o ‘Milk-alkali’ syndrome
• Malignant disease (second most common cause):
o Secondary deposits in bone
o Production of osteoclastic factors by tumours
o Myeloma
162
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Other endocrine disease (mild hypercalcaemia only):
o Thyrotoxicosis
o Addison’s disease
• Drugs:
o Thiazide diuretics
o Vitamin D analogues
o Lithium administration (chronic)
o Vitamin A
• Miscellaneous:
o Long-term immobility
o Familial hypocalciuric hypercalcaemia
Investigations:
• Biochemistry:
o Several fasting serum calcium/phosphate should be
taken. The hallmark of primary hyperparathyroidism is
hypercalcaemia and hypophosphataemia, with
detectable intact PTH levels during hypercalcaemia
o A mild hyperchloraemic acidosis
o Renal function is usually normal, but should be
measured as a baseline
o Protein electrophoresis (to exclude myeloma)
o Serum TSH and T3 (to exclude thyrotoxicosis)
• Imaging:
o Abdominal X-rays may show renal calculi or
nephrocalcinosis
163
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Should maintain a high fluid intake
• Avoid a high intake of calcium or vitamin D
• Encourage exercise
Complications of surgery:
• Postoperative hypocalcaemia:
o Most common in patients with significant bone disease
(the ‘hungry bone’ syndrome)
o A mild, transient hypoparathyroidism often continues for
1-2 weeks
• Other (rarer) complications – as for thyroid surgery:
o Laryngeal nerve palsy
o Haemorrhage
164
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Familial hypocalciuric hypercalcaemia:
• Uncommon, autosomal dominant
• Usually asymptomatic
• Demonstrates increased Ca2+ reabsorption, despite
hypercalcaemia
• PTH levels are normal or slightly raised
• Urinary Ca2+ is low
• Surgery is NOT indicated as the course appears benign
165
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hyperprolactinaemia
Causes of hyperprolactinaemia:
• Physiological:
o Sleep (REM phase)
o Pregnancy
o Suckling
o Stress
o Coitus
• Pathological:
o Neoplasm
o PCOS
o Primary hypothyroidism
o Renal failure
o Liver failure
o Idiopathic
• Pathological:
o Dopamine antagonists (e.g. metoclopramide and
phenothiazines)
o Oestrogens
o Opiates
o Cimetidine (H2-receptor antagonist)
o Methyldopa (α2-adrenoceptor agonist)
Clinical features:
• Galactorrhoea
• Oligomenorrhoea/amenorrhoea
• Decreased libido in both sexes
• Decreased potency in men
• Subfertility
• Symptoms and signs of oestrogen or androgen deficiency (in
the long-term, osteoporosis may result, especially in women)
Investigations:
• At least 3 prolactin levels should be measured
• The following tests are appropriate after physiological and
drug causes have been excluded:
o Visual fields should be checked
o Anterior pituitary function should be assessed
o MRI of the pituitary
Treatment:
• Drugs:
o Hyperprolactinaemia should be reduced with a
dopamine agonist
o Bromocriptine is the best established therapy
166
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Initial doses should be small (e.g. 1mg) and taken with
food, or at bedtime
o The dose should be gradually increased, usually to
2.5mg BID or TID, judged on clinical response and
prolactin levels
• Trans-sphenoidal surgery:
o Only really successful in patients with a microadenoma
(not macroadenoma)
• Radiotherapy:
o Slowly effective
o Can sometimes cause eventual hypopituitarism
167
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hyperthyroidism
(Thyrotoxicosis)
Epidemiology:
• Common. Affects ~2-5% of all females at some time
• Women 5x more than men
• Nearly all cases (>90%) are caused by intrinsic thyroid
disease; a pituitary cause is extremely rare
Symptoms of hyperthyroidism:
• Weight loss (despite increased appetite)
• Restlessness
• Tremor
• Palpitations
• Heat intolerance
• Diarrhoea
• Muscle weakness
• Oligomenorrhoea
• Loss of libido
Signs of hyperthyroidism:
• Tachycardia
• AF
• Warm, vasodilated peripheries
• Pretibial myxoedema
• Exophthalmus
• Lid lag
• Goitre
168
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Proximal myopathy
Grave’s disease:
• Most common cause of thyrotoxicosis and is due to an
autoimmune process
• Serum IgG antibodies bind to the thyroid TSH receptor and
stimulate thyroid hormone production (i.e. behaving like TSH)
• Yersinia enterocolitco and Escherichia coli contain TSH-binding
sites. It is believed that infection by these organisms may
invoke some form of ‘molecular mimicry’ in a genetically
susceptible individual and lead to the formation of
autoantibodies
• Is also associated with other autoimmune diseases, such as:
o Pernicious anaemia
o Myasthenia gravis
• Natural history is one of fluctuation with many patients
showing a pattern of alternating relapse and remission.
• ~40% of patients have a single episode
• Many patients eventually become hypothyroid
De Quervain’s thyroiditis:
• This is transient hyperthyroidism from an acute inflammatory
process (presumed to be viral in origin)
• Clinical features:
o Fever
o Malaise
o Pain in the neck
o Tachycardia
o Local thyroid tenderness
• On investigation:
o Initial hyperthyroidism
o Raised ESR
o Thyroid uptake scans show suppression of uptake in the
acute phase, although hypothyroidism (usually
transient) may then follow after a few weeks)
• Treatment of the acute phase is:
o Aspirin
o Short-term prednisolone (in severely symptomatic
cases)
169
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Investigating hyperthyroidism:
• Serum TSH:
o Is suppressed in thyrotoxicosis (< 0.1mU/L)
o There are, however, rare instances of TSH
hypersecretion leading to thyrotoxicosis
• Most physicians also like to measure serum T3 and T4 levels.
They will be elevated
• TSH receptor antibodies:
o Not measured routinely but are commonly present
o TSI 80% positive
o TBII 60-90% in Grave’s disease
Treatment:
• There are 3 main options:
o Antithyroid drugs
o Surgery
o Radioiodine
• Most patients (90%) with thyrotoxicosis have a diffuse goitre
• Those with large single or multinodular goitres are unlikely to
remit after a course of antithyroid drugs
• Severe biochemical hyperthyroidism is, also, less likely to
respond
Antithyroid drugs:
• Most commonly used antithyroid drug in the UK is
carbimazole.
• Occasionally, propylthiouracil is also used
• The main action of these drugs is to inhibit the formation of
thyroid hormones
• They are also, to a lesser extent, immunosuppressants
• Although thyroid hormone synthesis is reduced very quickly,
the long half-life of T4 (~7 days) means that clinical benefit is
not apparent for 10-20 days
• As many of the manifestations of hyperthyroidism are
mediated via the SymNS, β-blockers may be used to provide
rapid, partial symptomatic control
• β-blockers should not be used on their own to treat
hyperthyroidism, except when the condition is self-limiting, as
in subacute thyroiditis
• Approximately 50% of patients will relapse after withdrawal of
the antithyroid medication
170
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Drug Usual Side-effects Remarks
starting
dose
Carbimazole 10-20mg Rash Active metabolite is
8-hourly Nausea methimazole
Vomiting Mild
Arthralgia immunosuppressive
Agranulocytosis activity
(0.1%)
Jaundice
Propylthiouracil 100- As above (but As above but also
200mg 8- with no blocks conversion
hourly jaundice) of T3 to T4
Propranolol 40-80mg Avoid in asthma
6-8 hourly Use with care in
HF
171
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Requires immediate removal of all clips/sutures to allow
escape of the blood/haematoma
• Laryngeal nerve palsy:
o Occurs in 1% of cases
o Vocal chord movement should be checked
preoperatively
o Mild hoarseness is more common and thyroidectomy is
best avoided in professional singers!
• Transient hypocalcaemia:
o Occurs in up to 10% of cases
o Fewer than 1% of cases have permanent
hypoparathyroidism
• Recurrent hyperthyroidism:
o Occurs in 1-3% within one year, then 1% per year
• Hypothyroidism:
o Occurs in ~10% of patients within one year, and the
percentage increase over time
o It is likeliest if microsomal antibodies are positive
Radioactive iodine:
• 131I in an empirical dose (usually 200-500MBq) accumulates in
the thyroid and destroys the gland by local radiation
• Takes several months to be fully effective
• Patients must be rendered euthyroid before treatment,
although they must stop treatment at least 4 days before
radioiodine, and not recommence until 3 days after
radioiodine
Contraindicated in:
• Children
• Pregnancy
• Whilst breast-feeding
• Early discomfort in the neck and immediate worsening of
hyperthyroidism are sometimes seen:
o If this occurs, the patient should NOT receive
carbimazole for 2-3 days after radioiodine, as it will
prevent radioiodine uptake by the gland
o They should receive propranolol until carbimazole can
be restarted as necessary
o Euthyroidism usually returns in 2-3 months
o Apart from the immediate problems, as outlined above,
a major complication is the progressive incidence of
subsequent hypothyroidism affecting the majority of
subjects over the following 20 years
172
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hypocalcaemia
Pathophysiology:
Hypocalcaemia may be due to:
• Deficiencies of calcium homeostatic mechanisms
• Secondary to high phosphate levels
Causes of hypocalcaemia:
• Increased phosphate levels:
o Chronic renal failure (common)
o Phosphate therapy
• Hypoparathyroidism:
o Post-surgical
o DiGeorge syndrome (congenital condition where the
hypoparathyroidism is associated with intellectual
impairment, cataracts and calcified basal ganglia)
o Idiopathic hypoparathyroidism (rare)
o Severe hypomagnesaemia
• Vitamin D deficiency:
o Osteomalacia
o Vitamin D resistance
• Resistance to PTH:
o Pseudohypoparathyroidism
• Drugs:
o Calcitonin
o Bisphosphonates
• Miscellaneous:
o Acute pancreatitis (quite common)
o Citrated blood in massive transfusion
Symptoms of hypocalcaemia:
• At first there is:
o Paraesthesiae
o Circumoral numbness
o Cramps
o Anxiety
o Tetany
• Followed by:
o Convulsions
o Laryngeal stridor
o Dystonia
o Psychosis
Signs of hypocalcaemia:
• Chvostek’s sign:
173
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Gentle tapping over the facial nerves causes twitching of
the facial muscles
• Trousseau’s sign:
o Inflation of the sphygmomanometer cuff above systolic
pressure for 3 minutes induces titanic spasm of the
fingers and wrist
Investigations:
• Serum calcium
• Serum and urine creatinine (for renal disease)
• PTH levels (absent or inappropriately low)
• Parathyroid antibodies (present in idiopathic
hypoparathyroidism)
• Serum 25-hydroxy vitamin D level (low in vitamin D
deficiency)
• X-rays of the metacarpals:
o Showing short fourth metacarpals in
pseudohypoparathyroidism
Treatment:
• Urgency of treatment depends on the severity of the
symptoms and the degree of hypocalcaemia
• If severe with Tetany:
o IV calcium is given (10mL initially, then 10-40mL of
10% calcium gluconate in 1L of 0.9% saline over 4-8
hours
174
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hypopituitarism
Pathophysiology:
• Deficiency of hypothalamic releasing hormones or of pituitary
trophic hormones are either selective or multiple
• Multiple deficiencies usually result from tumour growth or
other destructive lesions
• With the latter, there is generally a progressive loss of
anterior pituitary function (GH and gonadotrophins, LH before
FSH, are usually first affected
• Rather than prolactin deficiency, hyperprolactinaemia occurs
relatively early because of tonic inhibitory control by
dopamine
• TSH and ACTH are usually last to be affected
• Panhypopituitarism refers to a deficiency of all anterior
pituitary hormones. It is most commonly caused by:
o Pituitary tumours
o Surgery
o Radiotherapy
Causes:
• Congenital:
o Isolated deficiency of pituitary hormones (Kallmann’s
syndrome)
• Infective:
o Basal meningitis
o Encephalitis
o Syphilis
• Vascular:
o Pituitary apoplexy
175
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Sheehan’s syndrome (post-partum necrosis)
o Carotid artery aneurysms
• Immunological:
o Pituitary antibodies
• Neoplastic:
o Pituitary or hypothalamic tumours
o Craniopharyngioma
o Meningiomas
o Gliomas
o Metastases (especially from breast)
o Lymphoma
• Traumatic:
o Skull fracture through base
o Surgery (especially transfrontal)
• Infiltrations:
o Sarcoidosis
o Hereditary haemochromatosis
• Others:
o Radiation damage
o Fibrosis
o Chemotherapy
• ‘Functional’:
o Anorexia nervosa
o Starvation
o Emotional deprivation
176
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hypothyroidism
Pathophysiology:
• Underactivity of the thyroid gland may be:
o Primary (due to disease of the thyroid)
o Secondary (due to hypothalamic-pituitary disease)
• Is one of the commonest endocrine disorders in the UK:
o 1.4% of women
o < 0.1% of men
177
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Symptoms:
• Tiredness/malaise
• Weight gain (despite reduced appetite)
• Cold intolerance
• Depression
• Reduced libido
• Constipation
• Deepening of voice
• Dry, brittle, unmanageable hair
• Poor memory
• Goitre
• Deafness
• Myalgia
Signs:
• Bradycardia
• Psychosis/dementia
• Ataxia
• Poverty of movement
• Hypertension
• Hypothermia
• Oedema
• Dry skin
• Anaemia
• Proximal myopathy
• Large tongue
178
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Treatment:
• Replacement therapy with T4 is given for life:
o In the young and fit - 100µg daily
o In the small, old or frail – 50µg daily
• Patients with severe IHD - 25µg daily to begin with, including
serial ECGs. The dose would then be increased at 3-4 week
intervals if angina does not occur/worsen and the ECG does
not deteriorate
• Adequacy of replacement should be assessed clinically and by
thyroid function tests (TSH and, possibly, T4) after at least 6
weeks on a steady dose – the aim being to restore TSH to
well within the normal range
• If TSH remains high, the dose of T4 should be increased in 25-
50µg increments and the tests repeated six weeks later
• Clinical improvement on T4 may not begin for two weeks or
more and full resolution of symptoms may take up to six
weeks
• During pregnancy, about a 50µg increase in T4 dosage is often
needed to maintain normal TSH levels (probably because of
the increased TBG levels)
179
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Myxoedema coma
‘Myxoedema madness’:
• Depression is common in hypothyroidism but occasionally
(with severe hypothyroidism in the elderly) the patient may
become frankly demented or psychotic, sometimes with
striking delusions
• This may also occur shortly after starting T4 replacement
180
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Osteoporosis
Definition:
• ‘A disease characterised by low bone mass and micro-
architectural deterioration of bone tissue, leading to enhanced
bone fragility and susceptibility to fracture’
• The bone that is present is normally mineralised but is
deficient in quantity, quality and structural integrity
• The WHO defines osteoporosis as a bone density > 2.5 SDs
below the young adult mean value for individuals matched for
sex and race. Values between 1 and 2.5 are termed
‘osteopenia’
Incidence:
• Over 1.3 million osteoporotic fractures in the USA each year,
approximately:
o 50% vertebral
o 25% hip
o 25% Colles’ fractures
Pathogenesis:
• Bone mass increases rapidly up to the age of puberty, rises
slightly in the 20s and 30s and then begins to decline around
age 40
• In men there is a gradual decline, reaching moderate levels of
fracture risk in the 70s and 80s, but a subset of women show
a very accelerated loss in the 10 years following the
menopause
• Osteoporosis arises as the end-result of many years of
mismatch between the rates of bone resorption and bone
formation during the remodelling process
• This can arise from ‘high turnover’ osteoporosis (from such
conditions as the postmenopausal state, hyperparathyroidism
and hyperthyroidism) while others may be due to ‘low
turnover’ osteoporosis (e.g. as in anorexia nervosa and liver
disease)
Risk factors:
• Age
• Gender (women more susceptible)
• White race
• Late menarche/early menopause
• Smoking
• Low calcium intake
• Low BMI
181
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Signs and symptoms of osteoporosis:
• Asymptomatic (most commonly)
• Fractures (e.g. vertebrae, hip and wrist)
• Bone pain
• Loss of height
• Kyphosis (excessive outward curvature of the spine – causes
a hunched back)
Causes of osteoporosis:
• Endocrine:
o Postmenopausal (especially premature menopause)
o Cushing’s syndrome
o Hyperthyroidism
o Male hypogonadism
• Drugs:
o Corticosteroid osteoporosis
o Heparin osteopenia
• Miscellaneous:
o Simple osteoporosis of ageing
o Immobilisation
o Dietary deficiency of Ca2+, protein or vitamin C
o Malabsorption syndrome
o Idiopathic juvenile osteoporosis
o Idiopathic adult osteoporosis
Fracture investigations:
• X-rays:
o May show the fracture and/or earlier, unrecognised,
fractures
o X-rays showing pedicle destruction are suggestive of
malignant destruction
o Osteopenia is used to describe a non-specific
generalised or regional rarefaction of the skeleton on X-
ray
• Bone scans:
o Are sometimes useful to demonstrate fractures
o An osteoporotic fracture can be distinguished from a
Metastatic lesion, as the latter is often associated with
multiple lesions elsewhere
• X-rays are of limited value in evaluating bone density because
up to 30-40% of the bone mineral content has to be lost
before any change in radiological bone density is detectable
182
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Other investigations:
• Iliac crest bone biopsy
• Serum Ca2+, PO43- and ALP (will be normal in osteoporosis as
no disorder of calcium metabolism is involved)
• Biochemical markers of bone resorption:
o Urinary hydroxyproline (not very sensitive)
o Urinary pyridinoline
o Urinary collagen cross-links
183
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Lesser used agents:
• Calcitriol:
o This is the active metabolite of vitamin D
o Produces some small improvement in bone density, but
not as much as HRT or bisphosphonates
• Calcitonin:
o Can administer human calcitonin nasally or (the more
potent) salmon calcitonin subcutaneously
o Good for patients who experience vertebral fracture
pain
• Fluoride:
o Has been shown to increase bone density
o Is current concern about the quality of the bone formed
o Not currently recommended
184
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Paget’s disease
(Osteitis deformans)
Definition:
• Is a disorder of bone remodelling
• There is excessive resorption with a subsequent
compensatory increase in new bone formation
• The new bone is structurally abnormal and therefore weak,
with secondary phenomenon like:
o Increased local bone blood flow
o Fibrous tissue in adjacent bone marrow
Epidemiology:
• Most often seen in Europe (and particularly northern England)
• Affects both men and women over age 40 years
• Up to 10% of adults are radiologically affected by the age of
90
Clinical features:
• 60-80% of patients with radiological evidence of Paget’s are
asymptomatic
• The disease may be monostotic or polyostotic
• Most common sites of involvement are:
o Femur
o Pelvis
o Tibia
o Skull
o Lumbosacral spine
• When symptomatic, features can include:
o Bone pain (most often in the spine or pelvis)
o Apparent joint pain (when an affected bone is close to a
joint, leading to cartilage damage and osteoarthritis)
o Deformities (especially, bowed tibia and skull changes)
185
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Complications from:
o Nerve compression (most commonly CN VIII)
o Increased bone blood flow (cardiac hypertrophy, high-
output cardiac failure)
o Weakness of the abnormal bone
• Osteogenic sarcoma (rare, <1%)
Investigations:
• X-rays:
o Bone enlargement/expansion
o Osteolytic lesions
o Sclerosis and thickening of bone trabeculae in long
bones and vertebrae
• Bone scans
• Biochemistry:
o Increased serum ALP (a marker of bone formation)
o NORMAL serum Ca2+ and PO43-
• Measurements of bone resorption:
o Increased 24-hour urinary hydroxyproline excretion
Treatment:
• Oral bisphosphonates:
o E.g. Alendronate 10-40mg daily for 6 months
o Responses to bisphosphonates are long-lasting, with 50-
70% reduction in serum ALP. The new bone formed is
lamellar, not woven
• Other bisphosphonates:
o IV pamidronate has been used widely as a single or
multiple infusion
• Calcitonin:
o Inhibit bone resorption and turnover but are extremely
expensive
o Side-effects include:
• Flushing
• Nausea
o Nasally administered calcitonin has fewer side-effects
• Surgery:
o Joint replacement or osteotomy are sometimes
necessary
o Neurosurgery where there is spinal disease
186
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Pituitary tumours are the most common cause of pituitary
disease. Problems may be caused by:
o Excess hormone secretion
o Local effects of the tumour
o The result of inadequate production of hormone by the
remaining normal pituitary (hypopituitarism)
• The great majority of pituitary tumours are benign pituitary
adenomas
Investigations:
• The investigation of a possible or proven tumour follows three
lines:
1. Is there a tumour?
2. Is there hormonal excess?
3. Is there a deficiency of any hormone?
Is there a tumour?
• Pituitary and hypothalamic space-occupying lesions can cause
symptoms by infiltration of or pressure on, the:
o Visual pathways
o Cavernous sinus (with III, IV and VI cranial nerve
lesions)
o Bony structures and meninges surrounding the fossa
(causing headache)
o Hypothalamic centres (can cause altered appetite,
thirst, somnolence/wakefulness or precocious puberty
o Ventricles (causing interruption of CSF flow, leading to
hydrocephalus)
• The principle investigations when looking for a pituitary
tumour are:
o Lateral skull X-ray
o Tests of the visual fields
o MRI of the pituitary
187
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Is there a deficiency of any hormone?
• Clinical examination may give clues, thus:
o Short stature in a child with a pituitary tumour is likely
to be due to GH deficiency
o A slow, lethargic adult with pale skin is likely to be
deficient in TSH and/or ACTH
Treatment:
• In general, treatment of a pituitary space-occupying lesion
has 3 aims:
1. Removal/control of tumour
2. Reduction of excess hormone production
3. Replacement of hormone deficiencies
188
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Actions of PTH:
• On the kidneys:
o Increases Ca2+ reabsorption
o Increases PO4- excretion
o Stimulates 1-α-hydroxylase activity (which increases
1,25 (OH)2 vitamin D3 synthesis)
• On bone:
o Stimulates osteoclasts
o Inhibits osteoblasts
• On the small intestine:
o Indirect action (by increasing the synthesis of 1,25
(OH)2 vitamin D3)
• Increases Ca2+ absorption
• Increases PO4- absorption
Actions of calcitonin:
• On the kidneys:
o Increases excretion of Ca2+, Na+ and PO43
-
189
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• On bone:
o Inhibits osteoclasts
190
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Gastroenterology
191
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute gastritis
Aetiology:
Gastritis can commonly be caused by:
• Drugs such as Aspirin and other NSAIDs
• Infections (e.g. CMV and HSV), particularly in the
immunocompromised
• Alcohol in high concentrations damages the gastric mucosal
barrier
• Severe stress
• Secondary to:
o Burns (Curling ulcers)
o Trauma
o Shock
o Renal disease
o Liver disease
Pathology:
• There is an acute inflammatory infiltrate in the superficial
gastric mucosa predominantly with neutrophils
• This is sometimes accompanied by mucosal erosions
• Multiple small erosions (often with an oedematous mucosa)
are described as acute erosive gastritis
• Acute gastric ulceration occurs in the same setting as erosions
but ulcers are larger and less superficial
Clinical features:
• The correlation between the pathological changes and
symptoms is poor
• The commonest symptoms are:
o Indigestion
o Vomiting
• GI haemorrhage can occur (usually from NSAIDs)
192
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute hepatitis
Pathology:
• Most of the parenchymal changes that occur are essentially
similar whatever the cause
• Hepatocytes:
o Show degenerative changes (swelling, cytoplasmic
granularity, vacuolation)
o Undergo necrosis (becoming shrunken, eosinophilic
Councilman bodies)
o Are rapidly removed
• The distribution of these changes varies somewhat with the
aetiological agent, but necrosis is usually maximal in zone 3
• The extent of the damage ranges from spotty or focal necrosis
to massive hepatic necrosis (resulting in fulminant hepatic
failure)
193
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Viral structure:
• The complete infective virion is a 42nm particle comprising
an:
o Inner core (or nucleocapsid)
o Outer envelope of surface protein (HBsAg)
• The surface protein is produced in excess by infected
hepatocytes and can exist separately from the whole virion in
serum and body fluid.
• The nucleocapsid is formed of core protein (HBcAg)
• HBeAg is a protein secreted separately by the cell
• The HBV is not directly cytopathic and the liver damage
produced is by the cellular immune response of the host
• Specific failure of T-cells to recognise HBV Antigens leads to
viral persistence
Epidemiology:
• Worldwide distribution
• Has infected > 2 billion people
• Estimated 300 million carriers
• The UK and USA have a low carrier rate (~0.5%) but it rises
to 10-15% in parts of Africa, the Middle and the Far East
• Spread is:
o Intravenously (e.g. IVDUs, blood transfusions)
o Close bodily contact (e.g. sexual intercourse,
particularly amongst homosexual men)
o Vertical transmission (from mother to child during
parturition) is the most important means of
transmission worldwide
Clinical features:
• In many cases, the infection is sub-clinical
• The clinical picture is the same as that for HAV infection,
although the illness may be more severe
Investigations:
• These are generally as for HAV
• Acute infection:
o HBsAg appears in the blood from about 6-12 weeks
after an acute infection and then disappears
o HBeAg rises early and usually declines rapidly
o Antibodies:
• Anti-HBs appears late and indicates immunity
• Anti-HBc is the first Antibody to appear and high
titres of IgM anti-HBc suggests acute and
194
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
continuing viral replication. It persists for many
months
• Anti-HBe appears after the anti-HBc and its
appearance relates to a decreased infectivity (i.e.
a low risk)
• Acute infection leading to chronic infection:
o HBsAg persists and indicates a chronic infection (or
carrier state)
o HBeAg persists and correlates with increased severity
and infectivity and the development of chronic liver
disease
Course:
• Majority of pts recover completely
• Fulminant hepatitis occurs in ~1%
• Some pts go on to develop chronic hepatitis and
hepatocellular carcinoma (HCC) or become asymptomatic
carriers
Treatment:
• Only symptomatic
195
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Identified in 1988 and
• Was found to be responsible for 70-90% of post-transfusion
hepatitis in all countries where blood was tested for HBV
markers
• Is believed that ~80% of haemophiliacs and 90% of IVDUs in
the UK are infected
• Limited transmission sexually
• Vertical transmission from mother to child can occur
Clinical features:
• Most infections are asymptomatic
• 10% of pts experience:
o A mild ‘flu-like illness
o Jaundice
o Rise in serum transferases
• Most pts will not be dx until they present, years later, with
evidence of chronic liver disease
Diagnosis:
• HCV RNA can be detected 1-2 weeks after infection
• Anti-HCV antibodies take ~12 weeks to develop, by which
time the pt has usually recovered
Treatment:
• Interferon (IFN) has been used in some acute cases with
some success
Course:
• > 50% of pts go on to develop chronic liver disease
• Cirrhosis develops in ~20-30% within 5-30 years (and of
these, 15% will develop an HCC)
• The course is adversely affected by alcohol consumption,
which should be discouraged
196
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Structure:
• Is an incomplete RNA particle enclosed in a shell of HBsAg
• It is unable to replicate by itself, but is activated by the
presence of HBV
Super-infection:
• Results in an acute flare-up of previously quiescent chronic
HBV infection
• A rise in serum AST or ALT may be the only indication of
infection
• Diagnosis is confirmed by finding:
o Serum IgM anti-δ + IgG anti-HBc
197
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute pancreatitis
Pathogenesis:
• Autodigestion of the pancreas by proteolytic enzymes
released in the pancreas (rather than in the interstitial lumen)
may also be involved
• Active enzymes could digest cell membranes, leading to:
o Proteolysis
o Pancreatic/peripancreatic oedema
o Vascular damage
o Pancreatic necrosis
• Mildest and most common form (oedematous pancreatitis –
75%):
o Interstitial oedema
o Inflammatory exudate
o Some fat necrosis
• Most severe form:
o Extensive pancreatic and peripancreatic necrosis
o Haemorrhage
Clinical features:
• Epigastric pain radiating to the back (between the scapulae)
• Pain varies from mild discomfort to excruciating pain
• Nausea
• Vomiting
• On examination:
o Tenderness, guarding and rigidity of the abdomen
o Body wall ecchymoses can occur:
• Umbilical (Cullen’s sign)
• In the flanks (Grey Turner’s sign)
•
Investigations
• Serum amylase:
o If the serum amylase is 5x greater than normal, acute
pancreatitis is very likely
198
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Ultrasound:
o Used to detect gallstones in the biliary tree
o Shows pancreatic swelling, necrosis and the presence or
absence of peripancreatic fluid collections
• Contrast-enhanced dynamic CT scanning:
o Is the most valuable technique as it detects:
• Swelling of the pancreas
• Pancreatic necrosis
• Peripancreatic fluid collections
• Diffuse inflammatory changes in the
retroperitoneum
• If there is any doubt in diagnosis, an exploratory
laparotomy must be performed in all but the
mildest cases to exclude a potentially fatal, but
treatable, non-pancreatic lesion
Treatment:
• In all cases:
o NBM
o Nasogastric suction (to reduce vomiting and abdominal
distension)
o IV Fluids
o Electrolyte replacement
o Opiate analgesia (other than morphine)
• In severe cases:
o Parenteral nutrition
o ITU (if shocked and/or in respiratory failure)
Complications:
• Acute fluid collection
• Pancreatic necrosis
• Pseudocysts
• Pancreatic abscesses
• Pancreatic ascites (indicates a poor prognosis)
199
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Prognosis:
• Mortality varies from 1% (mild cases) to 50% (severe cases)
• With multiple complications and the presence of all the bad
prognostic signs, the mortality is nearer 100%
200
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Ascites
Aetiopathogenesis:
• Ascites is the presence of fluid within the peritoneal cavity and
is a common complication of cirrhosis. There are several
factors involved in the formation of ascites:
o Sodium and water retention:
• Occur as a result of peripheral arterial
vasodilatation and consequent reduction in blood
volume
• Portal hypertension:
o Exerts a local hydrostatic pressure and leads to
increased hepatic and splanchnic production of lymph
and transudation of fluid into the peritoneal cavity
• Low serum albumin:
o Is a consequence of poor synthetic liver function
o May further contribute by a reduction in plasma oncotic
pressure
Clinical features:
• The abdominal swelling may accumulate over many weeks or
as rapidly as a few days
• Precipitating factors include:
o High sodium diet
o Development of a HCC
• Mild, generalised abdominal pain and discomfort
• Respiratory distress may accompany tense ascites
• The presence of fluid is confirmed by the demonstration of
shifting dullness and a fluid thrill
Investigations:
• Cell count:
o A neutrophil count > 250 cells/mm3 is indicative of an
underlying (usually spontaneous) bacterial peritonitis
• Gram stain and culture
• Protein
• Cytology:
o For malignant cells
• Amylase:
o To exclude pancreatic ascites
Management:
• Diuretic therapy:
o The aim is to both reduce sodium intake and to increase
renal excretion of sodium and by doing so, produce a
201
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
net reabsorption of fluid from the ascites back into the
circulating volume.
o The maximum rate at which ascites can be mobilised is
500-700ml/24 hours
o The diuretic of choice is spironolactone 200mg daily.
Chronic administration of spironolactone results in
Gynaecomastia, so amiloride 10-15mg daily is then
substituted
• Paracentesis:
o This is used to relieve symptomatic tense ascites
o It is also used as a means of rapid therapy in pts with
ascites and peripheral oedema, thus avoiding a
prolonged hospital stay
o The main danger of this approach is the production of
hypovolaemia as the ascites reaccumulates at the
expense of the circulating volume
o This can be somewhat overcome by the administration
of albumin or a plasma expander
o In practice, up to 20L can be removed over 4-6 hours
• This procedure should not be performed in end-stage cirrhosis
or if the pt has renal failure
202
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Autoimmune hepatitis
Pathogenesis:
• The cause is unknown
• It is proposed, in a genetically predisposed person, that an
environmental agent causes an autoimmune process to
develop against liver antigens, producing a necroinflammatory
process which results in fibrosis and cirrhosis
Clinical features:
• Women >> men
• May be asymptomatic
• 25% of pts present as an acute hepatitis with jaundice and
very high aminotransferases
• Examination can reveal:
o Hepatosplenomegaly
o Cutaneous striae
o Acne
o Hirsuites
o Bruises
o Ascites (sometimes)
• An ill pt can also have features of an autoimmune disease
with:
o Fever
o Migratory polyarthritis
o Glomerulonephritis
o Pleurisy
o Pulmonary infiltration
o Fibrosing alveolitis
Investigations:
• LFTs:
o Raised aminotransferases
o Lesser elevations in ALP and bilirubin
o Raised serum γ-globulins (frequently 2x normal)
• Haematology:
o Mild normochromic normocytic anaemia
o Thrombocytopenia
o Leucopenia
o Prolonged PT
• Autoantibodies:
o Two types of autoimmune hepatitis have been
recognised:
• Type I, with antibodies:
• Antinuclear, or
• Anti-smooth muscle, or
203
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Antimitochondrial
• Type II, with antibodies:
• Anti-liver/kidney microsomal
• Anti-liver cytosol
• Type II occurs most frequently in girls and young
women
Treatment:
• Prednisolone 30mg daily for two weeks
• Maintenance dose of prednisolone of 10-15mg daily
• Azathioprine 1-2mg/kg daily
204
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Bacterial overgrowth
Aetiology:
• The upper part of the small intestine is almost sterile,
containing only a few organisms derived from the mouth.
• Gastric acid kills most organisms and intestinal motility keeps
the jejunum empty
• The normal terminal ileum contains faecal-type organisms
(mainly E. coli and anaerobes)
• Bacterial overgrowth is normally only found associated with a
structural abnormality of the small intestine (although it can
occur occasionally in the elderly)
Clinical features:
• Steatorrhoea (the bacteria deconjugate and dehydroxylate
bile salts)
• Diarrhoea
• B12 deficiency (as the bacteria metabolize it and interfere
with it’s binding to IF)
Treatment:
• If possible, the underlying lesion should be corrected (e.g. a
stricture should be resected)
• Where it is not possible to correct the underlying lesion,
rotating courses of antibiotics may be needed (such as,
metronidazole and tetracycline or ciprofloxacin)
205
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cholestatic jaundice
Pathology:
• This may be divided into extra-hepatic and intra-hepatic
cholestasis
• Extra-hepatic cholestasis:
o Is due to large duct obstruction of bile flow at any
point in the biliary tree distal to the bile canaliculi
• Intra-hepatic cholestasis:
o Due to failure of bile secretion
Clinical features:
• Jaundice
• Pale stools
• Dark urine
• Raised serum conjugated bilirubin
206
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chronic gastritis
Aetiology:
• H. pylori is the chief cause of chronic active gastritis affecting
the antrum and body of the stomach
• Autoimmune gastritis affects the fundus and body of the
stomach (pangastritis) and is the cause of pernicious
anaemia. AutoAbs to gastric parietal cells and Ifs are found in
the serum
• Chronic ingestion of NSAIDs or Aspirin produces gastritis
• Biliary reflux (possibly)
Pathology:
• Chronic active gastritis consists of an infiltration of the lamina
propria with lymphocytes and plasma cells
• This can lead to the development of atrophic changes in the
mucosa, including loss of parietal and chief cells and
subsequent intestinal metaplasia
Clinical features:
• Most chronic gastritis is asymptomatic and requires no rx
207
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chronic hepatitis
Pathology:
• Chronic inflammatory cell infiltrates comprising lymphocytes
and plasma cells are usually present in the portal tracts
• The amount of inflammation varies from mild to severe
• In addition, there may be:
o Periportal or periseptal interface hepatitis
o Lobular change, focal lytic necrosis, apoptosis and focal
inflammation
o Confluent necrosis
o Fibrosis which may be mild, bridging (across portal
tracts) or severe
o Cirrhosis
• The overall severity of the hepatitis is judged by the degree of
necrosis and inflammation and the severity of the fibrosis or
cirrhosis.
208
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Scratch marks
• Testicular atrophy
• Purpura
• Oedema
• Caput medusae
• Ascites
• Jaundice
• Fever
• Loss of body hair
• Fetor hepaticus
• Hepatic flap
• Disorientation
• Drowsiness
209
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathogenesis:
• Cytotoxic T-cells recognise the viral Ag via HLA-1 molecules
on the infected hepatocyte
• This mechanism may be defective leading to viral persistence
• Chronic HBV goes through a replicative and an integrated
phase
• Replicative phase:
o There is active viral replication with hepatic
inflammation
o HBeAg (+ve)
o HBV DNA (+ve)
• Integrated phase:
o At some stage, the viral genome becomes integrated
into the host DNA and the viral genes are then
transcribed along with those of the host
o HBeAg (-ve)
o Anti-HBe Ab (+ve)
o The transferases are slightly elevated
o Liver histology shows little inflammation, often with
cirrhosis
o HCC develops in pts with this late-stage disease, but the
mechanism is still unclear
Clinical features:
• Chronic hepatitis occurs mainly in men and is often not
preceded by an acute attack
• The condition may be asymptomatic or may present as a
mild, slowly progressive hepatitis
• 50% of pts present with established chronic liver disease
Investigations:
• LFTs:
o Raised aminotransferases (ALT, AST)
o Slightly raised ALP
o Normal serum bilirubin (often)
• Markers:
o HBsAg (+ve)
o HBV DNA (+ve)
o HBeAg (+ve)
Treatment:
• The main aim of treatment is the disappearance of the HBeAg
and HBV DNA from the serum with consequent reduction in
inflammatory necrosis of the hepatocyte.
210
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• This seroconversion occurs spontaneously at a rate of 10-15%
per year
• In pts in whom HBeAg disappears, remission is usually
sustained. The pt remains a carrier with HBsAg present,
although many will eventually become HBsAg (-ve)
Prognosis:
• The progression of the disease is slow and remission may
occur
• Established cirrhosis is associated with a poor prognosis
• Primary liver cell carcinoma is a frequent association and is
one of the most common carcinomas in HBV endemic areas,
such as the Far East
211
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diagnosis:
• This is made by finding anti-HCV Ab in the serum
• Liver biopsy is indicated if active treatment is being
considered
Treatment:
• Is appropriate for pts with chronic hepatitis on liver histology
who have:
o HCV DNA in their serum, and
o Raised serum aminotransferases for more than six
months
• The presence of cirrhosis is NOT a contraindication
• The aim of treatment is to eliminate the HCV DNA from the
serum in order to:
o Stop the progression of active liver disease
o Prevent the development of HCC
γ-interferon:
• Is given as a dose of 3M units three times a week for 12
months
• Side-effects are less than when used to treat HBV infection,
because of the lower dose
• After six months of therapy:
o 40-50% of pts will have normal aminotransferases
o 20-25% of pts, however, will relapse after cessation of
treatment
o The remaining 15-25% will have a sustained response
212
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diagnosis:
• Is a relatively infrequent chronic hepatitis
• Spontaneous resolution is rare
• The diagnosis is made by finding:
o Anti-HDV Abs in a pt with chronic liver disease and who
is HBsAg (+ve)
Treatment:
• γ-interferon
• given in the high dose of 10M three times a week for 12
months
Prognosis:
• 15-25% of pts will show disappearance of HBsAg from the
serum
213
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chronic pancreatitis
Pathogenesis:
• Earliest change is deposition of protein plugs with the
pancreatic ducts
• These then lead to ductular dilatation followed by acinar
atrophy
• Eventually, only a few acinar and islet cells remain
• Intraluminal calcification of the protein plugs occurs, leading
to stone formation
Clinical features:
• Epigastric pain radiating to the back, between the scapulae
• The pain can be severe (sometimes comparable to acute
pancreatitis)
• Continuing episodes of pain may occur, sometimes mild and
brief, sometimes there is chronic pain interspersed with acute
episodes (relapsing pancreatitis)
214
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Steatorrhoea (occurs when secretion of pancreatic lipase is
reduced by 90%)
Investigations:
• ERCP
• Endoscopic ultrasound
• CT
Differential diagnosis:
• Carcinoma of the pancreas (especially when the history is
short)
Treatment:
• In alcoholic pancreatitis, the patient must be made to stop
drinking
• Analgesia (often with narcotics – there is a frequent problem
with addiction)
• Surgery (for the treatment of intractable pain)
• Steatorrhoea is treated with:
o Low-fat diet
o Pancreatic supplements (e.g. pancreatin 2-4g with each
meal)
• Diabetes mellitus is treated with:
o Oral hypoglycaemics
o Insulin (if required)
Complications:
• Pancreatic pseudocyst (most common)
• Pancreatic ascites (usually in alcoholic ascites)
215
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cirrhosis
Pathogenesis:
• Cirrhosis results from the necrosis of liver cells followed by
fibrosis and nodule formation
• The liver architecture is diffusely abnormal and this interferes
with liver blood flow and function
• This derangement produces the clinical features of portal
hypertension and impaired liver cell function
Causes of cirrhosis:
• Alcohol (most common cause in the West)
• Hepatitis B ± D (most common cause worldwide)
• Hepatitis C
• Biliary cirrhosis
• Autoimmune hepatitis
• Hereditary haemochromatosis
• Budd-Chiari syndrome (hepatic vein obstruction)
• Wilson’s disease
• Drugs (e.g. Methotrexate)
• α1-Antitrypsin deficiency
• Cystic fibrosis
• Intestinal bypass operations for obesity
• Galactosaemia
• Glycogen storage disorders
Pathology:
• The characteristic features of cirrhosis are regenerating
nodules separated by fibrous septa and loss of the normal
lobular architecture within the nodules
• Two types of cirrhosis have been described:
o Micronodular cirrhosis:
• Regenerating nodules are usually < 3mm in size and
liver is involved uniformly
• Often caused by ongoing alcohol damage or biliary
tract disease
o Macronodular cirrhosis:
• The nodules are of variable size and normal acini
may be seen within the larger nodules
• Often seen following previous hepatitis, such as HBV
infection
216
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Serum copper and α1-Antitrypsin deficiency (should always be
done in young cirrhotics)
• Serum iron, total iron-binding capacity (TIBC) and ferritin (to
exclude hereditary haemochromatosis)
Imaging:
• Ultrasound:
o Can demonstrate changes in size and shape of the liver
o Fatty change and fibrosis produce a diffuse increased
echogenicity
o In established cirrhosis, there may be marginal
nodularity of the liver surface and distortion of the
arterial vascular architecture
o It is useful in detecting HCC
• CT scan
• Barium swallow:
o Can detect varices
Liver biopsy:
• This is necessary to confirm the severity and type of liver
disease
Management:
• Mx is that of the complications seen in decompensated
cirrhosis
• Pts should have six-monthly alpha-fetoprotein measurements
to detect the development of a HCC as early as possible
217
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• There is no treatment that will arrest or reverse the cirrhotic
changes
• Alcohol should be avoided, although if the cirrhosis is not due
to alcohol, small amounts are probably not harmful
218
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Coeliac disease
(Gluten-sensitive enteropathy)
Incidence:
• Worldwide distribution
• In the UK ~ 1 in 1500
• In Ireland ~ 1 in 300
• Rare in Black Africans
• There is an increased risk to first-degree relatives, with 10-
15% affected
Aetiology:
• Gluten is a high molecular weight heterogeneous compound
that can be fractionated to produce α, β and γ-gliadin peptides
• α-gliadin is injurious to the small intestinal mucosa although
there is some disagreement about the toxicity of the other
compounds
Pathology:
• The mucosa of the proximal small bowel is predominantly
affected, the mucosal damage decreasing in severity towards
the ileum as the gluten is digested into smaller, non-toxic,
fragments
• Is an absence of villi, making the mucosal surface flat
• The crypts are elongated, with chronic inflammatory cells in
the lamina propria
• The lesion is described as subtotal villus atrophy
Clinical features:
• Can present at any age:
o In infancy it presents after weaning on to gluten-
containing foods
o Peak incidence in adults is in the 3rd and 4th decades
o Females >> males
• Tiredness
• Malaise
• Diarrhoea/steatorrhoea
• Abdominal discomfort/pain
• Weight loss
• Intermittent mouth ulcers/angular stomatitis
Investigations:
• Endomysial Antibodies (IgA):
o Ix of first choice
o These Abs have a high sensitivity and specificity for the
dx of untreated Coeliac disease
219
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Anti-reticulin antibodies:
o Very sensitive but not particularly specific
o Are seen in other GI conditions also (e.g. Crohn’s
disease)
• Jejunal biopsy:
o The mucosal appearance of a jejunal biopsy specimen is
diagnostic
• Haematology:
o 50% of pts have a mild or moderate anaemia
o Folate deficiency is almost always present – gives rise
to a high MCV
o Fe deficiency is common
o B12 deficiency is rare
• Small bowel follow-through:
o May show dilatation of the small bowel with a change in
fold pattern
o Folds become thicker and (in the severer forms) total
effacement is seen
Complications:
• Unresponsive ‘Coeliac disease’:
o Often no cause for this is found but, occasionally, the
following may be the cause:
• Intestinal lymphoma
• Ulcerative jejunitis
• Carcinoma
• Risk of malignancies:
o T-cell lymphoma is increased in Coeliac disease
o Carcinoma of the small bowel and oesophagus as well as
extra-GI cancers are also seen
220
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dubin-Johnson syndrome:
• Autosomal recessive
• Caused by a defect in the cMOAT transporter gene
• Defect in the handling of bilirubin by the liver
• Good prognosis
• The liver is black, owing to melanin deposition
221
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Constipation
Causes of constipation:
• Simple (low fibre diet)
• Intestinal obstruction
• Colonic disease (e.g. carcinoma)
• Painful anal conditions (e.g. fissure)
• Drugs (many!):
o Opiates
o Aluminium antacids
o Antidepressants
o Codeine
o Iron
• Hypothyroidism
• Hypercalcaemia
• Depression
• Immobility
• Hirschsprung’s disease
Treatment:
• Laxatives should be avoided if at all possible
• Encourage the patient to eat a high-fibre diet
• Glycerol suppositories (which can be used by the patient) are
often useful
• The types of laxatives available are shown below. Bulking
agent should be tried first.
• Stimulant laxatives often cause cramp and their long-term
use should be avoided as they cause an atonic, non-
functioning colon
• Magnesium is very useful in severe constipation
Laxatives:
• Bulking agents:
o Dietary fibre
o Bran
o Ispaghula husks
o Sterculia
o Methylcellulose
• Stimulant laxatives:
o Anthraquinones (e.g. Senna)
o Dioctyl sodium sulphosuccinate
o Danthron (for the elderly or for opiate-induced
constipation in the terminally ill)
o Bisacodyl
• Osmotic laxatives:
o Magnesium (sulphate or hydroxide)
222
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Lactulose
• Suppositories:
o Bisacodyl
o Glycerol
• Enemas:
o Phosphate
o Sodium citrate
223
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dermatitis herpetiformis
The skin condition responds to Dapsone but both the gut and the
skin will improve on a gluten-free diet
224
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diarrhoea
Definition:
• With true diarrhoea, there is an increase in stool weight to >
300g per day.
• This is usually accompanied by increased stool frequency
Osmotic diarrhoea:
The gut mucosa acts as a semi-permeable membrane and fluid
enters the bowel if there are large quantities of non-absorbed
hypertonic substances in the lumen
• This may occur because:
o The patient has ingested a non-absorbable substance
(e.g. a purgative such as magnesium sulphate or
magnesium-containing antacid)
o The patient has generalized malabsorption so that high
concentrations of solute (e.g. glucose) remain in the
lumen
o The patient specific absorptive defect (e.g.
disaccharidase deficiency or glucose-galactose
malabsorption)
• The volume of diarrhoea produced by this mechanism is
reduced by the absorption of fluid by the ileum and colon
• The diarrhoea stops when the patient stops eating or the
malabsorptive substance is discontinued
Secretory diarrhoea:
• There is both active intestinal secretion of fluid and
electrolytes as well as decreased absorption
• Common causes of secretory diarrhoea are:
o Enterotoxins (e.g. Cholera and E. coli)
o Hormones (e.g. VIP in the Verner-Morrison syndrome)
o Bile salts in the colon (following ileal-resection)
o Fatty acids in the colon (following ileal resection)
o Some laxatives (e.g. dioctyl sodium sulphosuccinate)
• With secretory diarrhoea, the stool volumes may be very
high. Food does not affect the diarrhoea and it, therefore,
continues during fasting
225
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Inflammatory diarrhoea (mucosal destruction):
• Diarrhoea occurs because of damage to the intestinal mucosal
cells, so that there is a net loss of fluid and blood
• In addition, there is defective absorption of fluid and
electrolytes
• Common causes are:
o Infective (e.g. dysentery due to Shigella)
o Inflammatory conditions (e.g. ulcerative colitis)
Abnormal motility:
• Is the cause of the diarrhoea seen in the following conditions:
o Diabetes
o Post-vagotomy
o Hyperthyroidism
• It is due to abnormal motility of the upper gut
• In many of these cases, the weight of the stool is not all that
high, but frequency of defaecation occurs; this, therefore, is
not true diarrhoea
226
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dysphagia
Causes of dysphagia:
• Disease of the mouth and tongue (e.g. tonsillitis)
• Neuromuscular disorders:
o Pharyngeal disorders
o Bulbar palsy (e.g. MND)
o Myasthenia gravis
• Oesophageal motility disorders:
o Achalasia
o Scleroderma
o Diffuse oesophageal spasm
o Presbyoesophagus
o Diabetes mellitus
o Chaga’s disease
• Extrinsic pressure:
o Mediastinal glands
o Goitre
o Enlarged left atrium
• Intrinsic lesion:
o Foreign body
o Stricture:
• Benign – peptic
• Corrosive
• Malignant – carcinoma
• Lower oesophageal rings:
o Oesophageal web
• Pharyngeal pouch
227
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathology:
• Severe hepatic failure in which encephalopathy develops in
under two weeks in a pt with a previously normal liver
• Cases that develop at a slower pace (2-12 weeks) are called
subacute or subfulminant hepatic failure
• FHF is a rare but often life-threatening syndrome that is due
to acute hepatitis from any cause
• Histologically, there is multiacinar necrosis involving a
substantial part of the liver
Clinical features:
• Jaundice
• Small liver
• Signs of hepatic encephalopathy
• The mental state varies from:
o Drowsiness, confusion and disorientation (grades I-II)
to
o Unresponsive coma (grade IV)
• Fetor hepaticus
• Fever
• Vomiting
• Hypotension
• Hypoglycaemia
• Cerebral oedema – leads to intracranial hypertension and
brain herniation (the most common cause of death)
Investigations:
• Hyperbilirubinaemia
• High serum aminotransferases
• Low levels of coagulation factors
• EEG to grade the encephalopathy
Treatment:
• When ICP is raised, 20% mannitol (1g/kg bodyweight) should
be infused IV
• Hypoglycaemia, hypokalaemia and hypocalcaemia should be
anticipated and corrected
• Coagulopathy is managed with IV vitamin K, platelets, blood
or FFP
• H2-receptor antagonists to prevent GI bleeding
• Infection should be treated with appropriate antibiotics
• Flumazenil (a BDZ antagonist) may give a transient
improvement in encephalopathy
• Liver transplantation
228
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
229
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Anti-reflux mechanisms:
• The most important mechanism is provided by the lower
oesophageal sphincter (LOS):
o Formed by the distal 4cm of oesophageal smooth
muscle
o Rapidly regains its normal tone (following relaxation to
allow a bolus to enter the stomach) and thereby prevent
reflux
o Is capable of increasing tone in response to rises in
intra-abdominal and intra-gastric pressures
• The oesophagus is normally rapidly cleared of any reflux
contents by secondary peristalsis
Clinical features:
• Heartburn:
o The pain is mainly due to direct stimulation of the
hypersensitive oesophageal mucosa, but is also partly
due to spasm of the distal oesophageal muscle
o The burning is aggravated by bending, stooping or lying
down
o Pain is often relieved by antacids
o Pain seldom radiates to the arms
• Nocturnal cough
230
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Is used to show and confirm the presence of
Oesophagitis, with a red friable mucosa and in more
severe cases, linear ulceration
o The mucosa can be normal in GORD
• Barium swallow:
o Less sensitive than endoscopy in demonstrating
Oesophagitis
o May show a hiatus hernia (which, by itself, is of no
diagnostic significance)
• Radiolabelled Technetium:
o Can be used to demonstrate reflux
• 24-hour pH monitoring:
o Most accurate test available
o Reasonable correlation between frequency of reflux and
symptoms
o It is often combined with manometry
o The no. of reflux episodes below pH4 occurring over
24hrs is noted
Management:
• Approx. 50% of pts can be treated successfully with:
o Simple antacids
o Loss of weight
o Raising the head of the bed at night
Precipitating factors should be avoided, with a reduction in alcohol
intake and cessation of smoking
• Magnesium trisilicate:
o Antacid
o Causes diarrhoea
• Aluminium hydroxide:
o Antacid
o Causes constipation
• Alginate-containing antacids:
o Most frequently prescribed agents for GORD
o They form a gel or ‘foam-raft’ with gastric contents and
thereby reduce reflux
• H2-receptor antagonists:
o E.g. Ranitidine
o Are widely available OTC
• Proton-pump inhibitors:
o E.g. Omeprazole, Lansoprazole, Pantoprazole
o Inhibit gastric hydrogen-potassium ATPase
o They produce almost complete reduction of gastric acid
secretion and are the drugs of choice for all but the
mildest of cases
231
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Prokinetic agents:
o E.g. Metoclopramide, Cisapride
o These speed gastric emptying
Surgery:
• Surgery should never be performed for a hiatus hernia alone.
• The properly selected case with severe reflux confirmed by pH
manometry and Oesophagitis responds well to surgery
• Repair of the hernia and some sort of additional anti-reflux
surgery is performed laparoscopically
• Results show an improvement in symptoms in up to 80% of
cases
Complications:
• Peptic stricture:
o Usually occurs in pts > 60yrs
o The symptoms are those of intermittent dysphagia over
a long period
• Barrett’s oesophagus:
o > 3cm of specialized columnar epithelium extending
upwards into the lower oesophageal mucosa
o Is due to long-standing reflux
o Is seen in up to 20% of pts undergoing endoscopy for
GORD
o Most common in middle-aged men
o Is pre-malignant for adenocarcinoma
232
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Most common type of viral hepatitis occurring worldwide,
often in epidemics
• The disease is commonly seen in the autumn and affects
children and young adults
• Spread of infection is faeco-oral and arises from the ingestion
of contaminated food or water (e.g. shellfish)
• In the UK, it is a notifiable disease
Clinical features:
• Non-specific features:
o Malaise
o Anorexia
o Distaste for cigarettes
• Many recover at this stage and remain anicteric
o After 1-2 weeks, some pts become jaundiced and
symptoms often improve
o As the jaundice deepens, the urine becomes dark and
the stools pale (owing to intra-hepatic cholestasis)
o There is organomegaly in ~10% of pts
• Thereafter, the jaundice lessens and (in the majority of cases)
the illness is over within 3-6 weeks
• Extra-hepatic complications are rare include:
o Arthritis
o Vasculitis
o Myocarditis
o Renal failure
Investigations:
• LFTs:
o In the prodromal stage:
• Normal serum bilirubin
• Bilirubinuria
• Increased urinary urobilinogen
• Raised serum AST or ALT (sometimes very high)
precedes the jaundice
o In the icteric stage:
• The serum bilirubin reflects the level of jaundice
• Serum AST reaches a maximum 1-2 days after the
appearance of jaundice (may rise > 500IU/L)
• Serum ALP is usually < 300IU/L
o Post-icteric stage:
233
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• The aminotransferases may remain elevated for
some weeks after and, occasionally, for up to six
months
Haematology:
o Raised ESR
o Raised PT (in severe cases)
o Viral markers:
• An anti-HAV IgM = acute infection
234
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Intestinal resection
Ileal resection:
• The ileum has specific receptors for the absorption of bile
salts and vitamin B12
• Therefore, relatively small resections will lead to
malabsorption of these substances
• Removal of the ileocaecal valve increases the incidence of
diarrhoea
• The following occur in ileal resection:
o Bile salts and fatty acids enter the colon and interfere
with water and electrolyte absorption, causing diarrhoea
o Increased bile salt synthesis can compensate for loss of
~1/3 of the bile salts in the faeces. Greater loss than
this results in decreased micellar formation and
steatorrhoea
o Increased oxalate absorption is caused by the presence
of bile salts in the colon. This gives rise to renal oxalate
stones
o There is a low serum B12 and macrocytosis
Jejunal resection:
• The ileum can take over the jejunal absorptive function
• Jejunal resection may lead to gastric hypersecretion with high
gastrin levels (unclear mechanism)
• Intestinal adaptation takes place, with an increase in the
absorption per unit length of bowel
235
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Parenteral nutrition (sometimes long-term) is necessary
• With intestinal adaptation most will eventually recover,
although they continue to have diarrhoea and little functional
reserve should another GI problem occur
236
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Jaundice
(icterus)
237
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Liver abscess
Clinical features:
• The signs of acute and chronic liver disease should be looked
for
• Certain additional signs may be helpful:
o Hepatomegaly:
• A smooth tender liver is seen in hepatitis and with
extra-hepatic obstruction
• A knobbly liver irregular liver suggests metastases
• Splenomegaly:
• This indicates portal hypertension in pts when signs of
chronic liver disease are present
• Ascites:
• This is found in cirrhosis, but can also be due to
carcinoma (particularly ovarian) and many other
causes
• Palpable gallbladder:
• Can suggest a carcinoma of the pancreas obstructing
the bile duct
Investigations:
• Viral markers
• Ultrasound examination can demonstrate:
o The size of the bile ducts (which are dilated in extra-
hepatic obstruction)
o The level of the obstruction
o The cause of the obstruction in virtually all pts with
tumours and 75% of pts with gallstones
• LFTs:
o Hepatitis:
• Serum AST or ALT tends to be high early in the
disease
• Only a small rise in the serum ALP
o Extra-hepatic obstruction:
• ALP is high
• Small rise in the aminotransferases
o Long-standing liver disease:
• The Prothrombin time (PT) is often prolonged
• Serum albumin is low
• Haematological tests:
o A leucocytosis may indicate infection (e.g. cholangitis)
o A leucopenia often occurs in viral hepatitis
o Abnormal mononuclear cells suggests infective
mononucleosis
238
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Alpha fetoprotein:
o Raised in hepatocellular carcinoma
Haemolytic jaundice:
• Leads to an unconjugated hyperbilirubinaemia
• The increased breakdown of RBCs leads to an increase in the
production of bilirubin
• The resulting jaundice is usually mild (serum bilirubin of 68-
102mmol/L) as normal liver function can easily handle the
increased bilirubin derived from excess haemolysis
• Causes of haemolytic jaundice:
o Inherited:
• Red cell membrane defect (hereditary spherocytosis/
elliptocytosis)
• Hb abnormalities (Thalassaemia, sickle cell disease)
• Metabolic defects (G6PDH deficiency, pyruvate
kinase deficiency)
o Acquired:
• Autoimmune
• Alloimmune (haemolytic transfusion reactions,
haemolytic disease of the newborn)
• Drug induced
• Mechanical (microangiopathic haemolytic anaemia,
valve prosthesis)
• Renal/liver failure
• Malaria
• Hypersplenism
• Burns
• Evidence for haemolysis:
o Elevated serum bilirubin (unconjugated)
o Raised LDH
o Reticulocytosis
o Normal serum ALP, transferases and albumin
Gilbert’s syndrome:
• Common familial hyperbilirubinaemia
• Affects 2-7% of the population
• Asymptomatic – usually detected as an incidental finding of a
slightly raised bilirubin (17-102mmol/L) on a routine blood
test
• NO signs of liver disease are seen
• Family history of jaundice in 5-15% of pts
239
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Most pts have reduced levels of UDP-glucuronosyl transferase
activity
Crigler-Najjar syndrome:
• Very rare
• Two types:
o Type I (autosomal recessive, absence of glucuronosyl
transferase)
o Type II (autosomal dominant, decreased glucuronosyl
transferase activity)
• Only those with type II can survive into adult life
• Transplantation is the only effective treatment
240
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Malabsorption
241
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Aetiology:
• Carriers of HBV and HCV
• Aflatoxin
• Androgenic steroids
• Is an association with the OCP
Pathology:
• The tumour may be single or multiple
• Can metastasize via the hepatic or portal veins to:
o Lymph nodes
o Bones
o Lungs
Clinical features:
• Usually present before the age of 50 years
• Weight loss
• Anorexia
• Fever
• Ache in the right hypochondrium
• Ascites
• Enlarged, irregular, tender liver may be palpable
Investigations:
• Raised serum α-fetoprotein
• Liver biopsy (for diagnosis)
242
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Survival is less than 6 months
243
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Duodenal ulcer (DU) >> gastric ulcer GU (3 : 1)
• Approx. 15% of the population will suffer from a DU
Aetiology:
• One factor in the formation of a peptic ulcer is an imbalance
between acid and pepsin against the mucosal defences
(mucus, bicarbonate, PGs)
• Another major factor is infection by Helicobacter pylori. DU
pts with H. pylori infection secrete more acid after stimulation
by gastrin and have more parietal cells in the stomach than
healthy people with H. pylori.
• NSAIDs certainly contribute to the formation of GUs but NOT
DUs
• Peptic ulceration is more common in pts with blood group O
Pathology:
• GUs are found in any part of the stomach but are most
common on the lesser curve
• Most DUs are found in the duodenal cap; the surrounding
mucosa appears inflamed, haemorrhagic or friable
(duodenitis)
• Histologically there is:
o A break in the superficial epithelial cells penetrating down
to the muscularis mucosa at the site of the ulcer
o A fibrous base
o An increase in inflammatory cells
o H. pylori may be found scattered on the surface of the
gastric mucosa or in the ectopic gastric mucosa in the
duodenum
o Associated active gastritis
Clinical features:
• Very well localised epigastric pain
• Pain is relieved by antacids
• The pain of a DU classically occurs at night (as well as in the
day) and is worse when the pt is hungry
• Nausea may accompany the pain
• Vomiting is infrequent but often relieves the pain
• Anorexia/weight loss, particularly with GUs
• Back pain suggests a penetrating posterior DU
• Pts can present for the first time with haematemesis or
malaena or a perforation
244
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Investigations:
• Serology or breath test to confirm H. pylori status. Further ix
is only indicated in pts with persistent dyspepsia following
successful eradication therapy, or in symptomatic pts who are
H. pylori negative
• Endoscopy:
o To exclude GORD or cancer
o All gastric ulcers should be biopsied
• Barium meal (double contrast):
o Less commonly used than endoscopy in this situation
245
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Surgical management:
• Since the introduction in the 1970s of H2-receptor
antagonists, surgery for peptic ulceration is rarely necessary
and is reserved only for the complications:
o Recurrent uncontrolled haemorrhage – ligation of the
bleeding vessel
o Perforation – oversown
246
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Portal hypertension
Anatomy/physiology:
• The portal vein is formed by the union of the superior
mesenteric vein and the splenic vein
• The pressure within it is usually 5-8mmHg, with only a small
gradient across the liver to the hepatic vein, in which blood is
returned to the IVC
• Portal hypertension can be classified according to the site of
obstruction:
• Prehepatic:
o Due to blockage of the portal vein before the liver
• Intrahepatic:
o Due to distortion of the liver architecture, which can be
either:
• Pre-sinusoidal (e.g. in schistosomiasis), or
• Post-sinusoidal (e.g. in cirrhosis)
• Posthepatic:
o Due to venous blockage outside the liver (rare)
• As portal pressure rises > 10-12mmHg, the compliant venous
system dilates and collaterals occur with the systemic venous
system
• The main sites of the collaterals are the:
o Gastro-oesophageal junction
o Rectum
o Left renal vein
o Diaphragm
o Retroperitoneum
o Anterior abdominal wall (via the umbilical vein)
• The collaterals at the gastro-oesophageal junction (varices)
are superficial in position and tend to rupture
Common causes:
• Prehepatic:
o Portal vein thrombosis
• Intrahepatic:
o Cirrhosis
o Schistosomiasis
o Congenital hepatic fibrosis
• Posthepatic:
o Budd-Chiari syndrome
o Veno-occlusive disease
o Right heart failure (rare)
o Constrictive pericarditis
247
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• Pts with portal hypertension are often asymptomatic and the
only clinical evidence is splenomegaly
• Clinical features of chronic liver disease are usually present
• Presenting features may include:
o Haematemesis/malaena from rupture of gastro-
oesophageal varices
o Ascites
o Encephalopathy
248
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Radiation enteritis
Aetiopathogenesis:
• Radiation of > 50Gy will damage the intestine
• The ileum and rectum are the areas most commonly involved
(as pelvic irradiation is the common cause)
• Radiation enteritis produces:
o Muscle fibre atrophy
o Ulcerative changes due to ischaemia
o Obstruction due to strictures produced by radiation-
induced fibrosis
Clinical features:
• At the time of irradiation there may be:
o Diarrhoea
o Abdominal pain
• The above symptoms usually resolve within six weeks after
completion of therapy
• Chronic radiation enteritis is diagnosed if symptoms persist
for more than three months
Treatment:
• Symptomatic (although often unsuccessful in chronic
enteritis)
• Surgery should be avoided if at all possible, being reserved
for life-threatening situations such as:
o Complete obstruction
o Perforation (occasionally)
249
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Tropical sprue
Aetiology:
• Unknown
• Likely to be infective because the disease occurs in epidemics
and pts improve on antibiotics
Clinical features:
Vary in intensity but include the following:
• Diarrhoea
• Anorexia
• Abdominal distension
• Weight loss
• The onset can sometimes be acute (occurring within a few
days) or may occur several years after being in the tropics
• The disease can also be insidious, with chronic diarrhoea and
evidence of nutritional deficiency
Diagnosis:
• Acute infective causes of diarrhoea must be excluded
(particularly Giardia)
• Malabsorption should be demonstrated (particularly of fat and
B12)
250
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Vomiting
Definition:
• Vomiting is the forceful ejection of gastric contents through
the mouth
• There are three phases:
1. Nausea – A feeling of wanting to vomit often associated
with autonomic effects (including hypersalivation, pallor
and sweating)
2. Retching – A strong involuntary effort to vomit
3. Vomiting – The expulsion of gastric contents through the
mouth
Control of vomiting:
• The vomiting centres are located in the lateral reticular
formation of the medulla and are stimulated by the
chemoreceptor trigger zones (CTZs) in the floor of the fourth
ventricle, and also by afferents from the gut
• The zones are directly stimulated by:
o Drugs
o Motion
o Metabolic causes
Aetiology:
• There are many causes of vomiting (see below) but nausea
and vomiting without pain are frequently non-GI in origin.
• Large volumes of vomit suggest intestinal obstruction
• Faeculent vomit suggests low intestinal obstruction from a
gastrocolic fistula
• Projectile vomiting is associated with pyloric stenosis
• Chronic nausea and vomiting with no other abdominal
symptoms usually have psychological causes.
• Early morning vomiting is seen in:
o Pregnancy
o Alcohol dependence
o Some metabolic disturbances (e.g. uraemia)
Causes of vomiting:
• Any GI disease
• Acute infections:
o Influenza
o Pertussis
• CNS disease:
o Raised ICP
o Meningitis
251
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Vestibular disturbances
o Migraine
• Metabolic causes:
o Uraemia
o Diabetes (ketoacidosis or gastroparesis)
o Hypercalcaemia
• Drugs (many!):
o Digitalis toxicity
o Opiates
o Cytotoxics
• Reflex:
o Severe pain
o Infarction
• Psychogenesis
• Pregnancy
• Alcohol excess
252
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Whipple’s disease
Incidence:
• Rare disease
• Usually affects males
Pathology:
• Histologically, the villi are stunted and contain diagnostic
periodic acid-Schiff (PAS) positive macrophages
• On EM, bacilli can be seen ‘within’ the macrophages
• The organism is similar to actinomycetes and has been given
the name Tropheryma whippeii.
Clinical features:
• Commonest presenting features:
o Steatorrhoea
o Abdominal pain
o Fever
o Weight loss
Less common presenting features can include:
• Peripheral lymphadenopathy
• Arthritis
• Involvement of the:
o Heart
o Lung
o Brain
Treatment:
• An antibiotic that crosses the blood-brain barrier (e.g.
Chloramphenicol)
253
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
General Medicine
254
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathogenesis:
• The central nucleus pulposus may extrude into a fissure in the
surrounding annulus fibrosis and cause acute pain and muscle
spasm
• These events are usually self-limiting
• A disc prolapse occurs when the extrusion extends beyond the
limits of the fibrous annulus fibrosis
• The weakest part of the annulus is posterolaterally – where
the disc may impinge on emerging spinal nerve roots in the
root canal
Clinical features:
• The episode starts dramatically during lifting, twisting or
bending
• Produces a typical combination of:
o Lower back pain
o Muscle spasm
o Severe lancinating pains, paraesthesia, numbness and
neurological signs in one leg (rarely both)
• The back pain is:
o Diffuse
o Usually unilateral
o Radiates into the buttock
• The muscle spasm leads to a scoliosis, which reduces when
lying down
Treatment:
• Advise bedrest:
o Lying flat for a lower disc
o Semi-reclining for a high lumbar disc
• Analgesia
• Muscle relaxants
• Physiotherapy
• If the neurological signs are severe and the pain persists and
is severe for >6-10 weeks:
o Microdiscectomy
o Hemilaminectomy
255
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Definitions:
• A potentially reversible loss of excretory renal function
• Develops over hours or days
Aetiology:
Can be divided into 3 main areas:
• Pre-renal
• Intrinsic renal
• Post-renal
Pre-renal uraemia:
• Caused by impaired perfusion of the kidneys with blood
• The initial physiological response to kidney hypoperfusion is
Na+/H2O retention:
o Leads to oliguria (<0.5ml/kg/hour)
• If hypoperfusion is not quickly corrected:
o Acute tubular necrosis (ATN) develops
256
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Signs of raised JVP or of pulmonary oedema should be sought
frequently
Post-renal uraemia:
• Uraemia results from obstruction of the urinary tract at any
point from the calyces to the external urethral orifice
• Important to diagnose as they are readily treatable
• The urinary tract is usually dilated above the level of the
obstruction
• Must affect both kidneys, or a single functioning kidney (or be
below the level of the bladder) to cause renal failure
• May cause complete anuria
Obstructions:
Are 3 types of obstructing lesion:
• Intraluminal (e.g. calculi)
• Intramural (e.g. stricture, tumour)
• Extramural (e.g. tumour, retroperitoneal fibrosis)
257
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Urine output in ATN:
• Preceding renal hypoperfusion causes physiological oliguria
(which is often the first clue to the problem)
• Once ATN is established, the patient often remains oliguric
(but this is not invariable)
• Urea and creatinine may continue to rise despite the
production of urine (‘non-oliguric ARF’)
• ATN has an overall mortality of ~50%
Exacerbators of ATN:
• Aminoglycosides (e.g. gentamycin)
• Myoglobin (from muscle breakdown, e.g. crush injury)
• Paracetamol (in overdose)
Investigations:
Urine:
• Dipstick
• Microscopy (RBCs, red cell casts)
• Culture
Serum:
• Urea
• Creatinine
• Calcium
• Phosphate
258
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Albumin
• ALP
FBC
Blood cultures
Blood levels of nephrotoxic drugs (if appropriate)
Hyperkalaemia:
This is a life-threatening complication owing to the risk of cardiac
dysrhythmias, particularly ventricular fibrillation
On the ECG:
• Tall, tented, T waves
• Widened QRS complexes
• Loss of P waves
Management:
• 10mls 10% calcium gluconate IV (stabilises the myocardium)
• 100mls 50% dextrose IV plus 10U Actrapid IV (drives K+ into
cells)
In many cases, hyperkalaemia will be controlled only by dialysis or
haemofiltration
Pulmonary oedema:
Fluid overload causes a rise in left atrial pressure and leakage of
fluid into the alveolar space
Clinical features:
• Dyspnoea
• Orthopnoea
• Frothy sputum
• Hypoxia
Management:
• Sit patient up
• Give high flow O2
• IV diuretics (e.g. frusemide – note higher doses needed in
renal failure)
• Vasodilators (e.g. IV nitrates)
• If the diuretics do not induce a diuresis, dialysis or
haemofiltration is necessary
259
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Alcohol abuse
260
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• High-risk occupations include:
o Company directors
o Salesmen
o Doctors
o Journalists
o Publicans
o Seamen
• There may be associated physical and mental conditions (e.g.
depression)
Delirium tremens:
• This is the most serious withdrawal state and occurs 1-5 days
after alcohol (or barbiturate) withdrawal
• Patients experience:
o Disorientation
o Agitation
o Marked tremor
o Visual hallucinations (e.g. pink elephants)
• Signs include:
o Sweating
261
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Tachycardia
o Tachypnoea
o Pyrexia
o Dehydration
o Wernicke-Korsakoff syndrome
• If delirium tremens is not treated promptly, death can occur
Outcome:
• Whereas in the case of non-dependent heavy drinkers the
goal of normal drinking within safe limits can be a very
reasonable one, the alcohol-dependent drinker must be
persuaded to abstain
• Research suggests that up to 40-50% of alcohol-dependent
drinkers are abstinent or drinking very much less up to 2
years following intervention
262
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathology:
• Unclear
• There is decreased release of Fe from the bone marrow to
developing erythroblasts
• Inadequate EPO response to the anaemia
• Decreased RBC survival
Treatment:
• Involves treating the underlying disease
263
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Anxiety disorder
Aetiology:
• Genetic factors:
o Anxiety neurosis occurs in 15% of relatives of affected
patients (compared to 3% of the general population)
• Psychodynamic theory:
o Suggests that anxiety neurosis reflects overwhelming
stress, anxiety and difficulties in the child-parent
relationship in early childhood or even at birth
• Learning theory:
o Regards anxiety as a fear response that has been
attached to another stimulus through conditioning
Types of anxiety:
• More or less continuous:
o Fluctuates to some extent in response to environmental
circumstances
• Panic attacks:
o Sudden and unpredictable attacks of anxiety
o Usually accompanied by severe physical symptoms
• Phobic anxiety:
o Is anxiety triggered by a single stimulus of set of stimuli
that are predictable and that normally cause no
particular concern to others
o E.g. claustrophobia, agoraphobia
• An anxious personality:
o An individual who has a lifelong tendency to experience
tension and anxiety
o Usually have a worrisome attitude towards life and a
constant anticipation of setback and stress
264
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Feeling of pain over heart
• Genitourinary:
o Increased frequency
o Failure of erection
o Lack of libido
• Nervous system:
o Tinnitus
o Blurred vision
o Dizziness
o Headache
o Sleep disturbance
Hyperventilation syndrome:
• Panic attacks (fear, terror and impending doom) accompanied
by some or all of the following:
o Dyspnoea
o Palpitations
o Chest pain/discomfort
o Choking sensation
o Dizziness
o Paraesthesiae
o Sweating
• Cause:
o Over-breathing leading to a decrease in PaCO2 and an
increase in arterial pH
• Diagnosis:
o A provocation test – voluntary over-breathing for 2-3
minutes provokes similar symptoms. Re-breathing from
a paper bag relieves them
• Management:
o Explanation and reassurance
o The patient is trained in relaxation techniques and slow
breathing
o The patient is asked to breathe into a closed paper bag
once the symptoms appear
• Psychological symptoms of anxiety:
o Apprehension and fear
o Irritability
o Difficulty in concentrating
o Restlessness
o Sensitivity to noise
o Depression
o Depersonalization
o Obsessional symptoms
265
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Differential diagnosis:
Psychiatric Physical
Depressive illness Hyperthyroidism
Schizophrenia Hypoglycaemia
Pre-senile dementia Phaeochromocytoma
Alcohol dependence
Drug dependence
Drug treatment:
Are 2 types of drugs – those that act on the CNS and those that
block the ANS:
• Centrally acting anxiolytic drugs:
o Benzodiazepines
• ANS blocking drugs:
o E.g. propranolol Involves treating the underlying
disease
266
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Mechanical:
o Trauma
o Degenerative disease:
• Spondylosis
• Spondylolithesis
• Spinal stenosis
o Post-surgical back pain
• Inflammatory (non-infective):
o Spondyloarthropathy
o Spondylitis
• Malignant:
o Metastatic disease
o Multiple myeloma
o Primary tumour of bone, spinal cord or nerve root
• Infection:
o Osteomyelitis
o Paravertebral abscess
o Discitis
• Bone disorders:
o Osteoporotic vertebral collapse
o Paget’s disease
267
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cerebral infarction
Clinical features:
• The most common stroke is the hemiplegia caused by
infarction in the internal capsule following thromboembolism
of a branch of the middle cerebral artery
• There is weakness of the limbs of the opposite (contralateral)
side which develops over seconds, minutes or hours
• The signs are those of an acute complete contralateral UMN
lesion, including limbs and face
• Aphasia is usual when the dominant hemisphere is affected
• The affected limbs are, at first, flaccid and areflexic
• Headache is unusual and consciousness is NOT lost
• After a variable period (usually several days) the reflexes
recover and become exaggerated and an extensor plantar
response appears
• Weakness is maximal at first, and recovers gradually over the
course of days, weeks or many months
Brainstem infarction:
• Infarction in the brainstem causes complex patterns of
dysfunction depending on the site of the lesion and its
relationship to the cranial nerve nuclei, long tracts and
brainstem connections.
• Lateral medullary syndrome:
o Caused by PICA (posterior inferior cerebellar artery) or
vertebral artery thromboembolism
• Coma:
o Ensues when bilateral brainstem infarction damages the
reticular formation
• Locked-in syndrome:
o Is caused by an upper brainstem infarction
o The patient has a functioning cerebral cortex and is,
thus, aware but cannot move or communicate except by
vertical eye movement
• Pseudobulbar palsy:
o Bilateral infarction of the lower cranial nerve nuclei
o Produces weakness and poverty of movement of the
tongue and pharyngeal muscles
o Emotional lability (inappropriate laughing or crying)
often accompanies pseudobulbar palsy
268
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Features of a brainstem infarction:
Clinical feature Structure involved
Hemi/tetraparesis Corticospinal tracts
Sensory loss Medial lemniscus/Spinothalamic tracts
Facial numbness 5th nerve nuclei
Facial weakness 7th nerve nuclei
Nystagmus/vertigo Vestibular connections
Dysphasia/dysarthria 9th and 10th nerve nuclei
Horner’s syndrome Sympathetic fibres
Altered consciousness Reticular formation
Lacunar infarction:
• Lacunes are small (<1.5cm3) areas of infarction seen on MRI
or at autopsy
• HT is commonly present
• Minor strokes are syndromes caused, typically, by single
lacunar infarcts. Examples include:
o Pure motor stroke
o Pure sensory stroke
o Sudden unilateral ataxia
o Sudden dysarthria
• Lacunar infarction is often also ‘symptomless’
Hypertensive encephalopathy:
• This describes various neurological sequelae of severe
accelerate HT with occlusion of small arteries
• Leads to:
o Severe headaches
o TIA
o CVA
o Subarachnoid haemorrhage (rarely)
269
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Multi-infarct dementia:
• Multiple lacunes or larger infarcts cause the picture of
generalized intellectual loss that is seen in patients with
advanced cerebrovascular disease.
• Signs include:
o Dementia
o Pseudobulbar palsy
o Shuffling gait with small steps
Examination:
• In addition to neurological examination, particular care should
be taken to find a possible source of embolus, e.g:
o Carotid bruit
o Atrial fibrillation
o Valve lesion
o Evidence of endocarditis
• One must also determine whether HT or postural hypotension
is (or has been) present
Immediate management of a CVA:
• In practice, many TIAs and mild CVAs can be managed at
home and specialist advice sought when necessary
• Patients admitted to stroke wards tend to fare better than
those admitted to a general ward
• Thrombolytic agents (such as tissue plasminogen activator)
have sometimes appeared promising in the immediate
treatment of ischaemic CVA, but are not in general use
Preliminary investigations:
Test Potential yield
Urinalysis, blood glucose Diabetes mellitus
Hb, platelets Polycythaemia
WCC Infection (e.g. endocarditis)
ESR, CRP Possible arteritis
Serology for syphilis Possible neurosyphilis
CXR Neoplasm
ECG Recent infarct, dysrhythmias
270
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Carotid doppler and duplex scanning:
o Screening for arterial stenosis and occlusion
• Angiography:
o Very valuable in anterior circulation TIAs to diagnose
surgically accessible arterial stenoses (mainly internal
carotid stenoses)
o There is a high probability of finding a carotid stenosis
when there is a loud localised carotid bruit in the neck
Prognosis:
• Between 30-50% of patients who die, do so in the first month
following a stroke
• A poor outcome is likely when the following triad is present:
o Coma
o A defect in conjugate gaze
o Severe hemiplegia
271
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Recurrent strokes are common (10% in the first year)
• In addition, many patients die subsequently from a MI
• Of initial stroke survivors, 30-40% are alive after 3 years
• Of those who survive a stroke:
o 30% return to independent mobility
o 30% have severe disability, requiring permanent
institutional care
272
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Stroke is the 3rd most common cause of death in developed
countries
• 200 per 100,000 population die per year from strokes in the
UK
• The death rate following a stroke is ~25%
Definitions:
• Stroke (cerebrovascular accident, CVA):
o A focal neurological deficit due to a vascular lesion
o Usually of rapid onset
o Lasts longer than 24 hours
• Completed stroke:
o Implies that the neurological deficit has reached its
maximum
o Usually within 6 hours of onset
• Stroke in evolution:
o Describes evolving and deteriorating symptoms and
signs
o Usually during 24 hours from the onset
• Minor stroke:
o Patients recover without a significant deficit, usually within
1 week
• Transient ischaemic attack (TIA):
o A focal neurological deficit lasting from a few seconds up to
a maximum of 24 hours
o There is complete clinical recovery
o Usually of sudden onset
o TIAs have a tendency to recur, and to herald
thromboembolic stroke
273
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Mass effects of an expanding lesion, e.g:
• Brain tumour
• Abscess
• Subdural haematoma
274
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Causes of CRF:
• Congenital/inherited:
o Polycystic kidney disease
o Congenital hypoplasia
• Glomerular disease:
o SLE
o DM
o Amyloidosis
o Vasculitis
• Vascular disease:
o Arteriosclerosis
o Microscopic polyarteritis
o SLE
o Systemic sclerosis
• Tubulointerstitial disease:
o Tubulointerstitial nephritis
o Reflux nephropathy
o TB
o Schistosomiasis
• Urinary tract obstruction:
o Calculi
o Prostatic disease
o Pelvic tumours
o Retroperitoneal fibrosis
Symptoms of CRF:
• When serum urea >40mmols/L:
o Anorexia
o Insomnia
o Nocturia/Polyuria
o Pruritus
o Nausea/vomiting
o Diarrhoea
o Paraesthesiae/tetany (due to polyneuropathy/
hypocalcaemia)
o Bone pain (due to metabolic bone disease)
o Peripheral/pulmonary oedema
o Anaemia
o Amenorrhoea in women
o Erectile dysfunction in men
275
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Seizures
o Myoclonic twitching
Examination:
• Short stature – in patients who have had CRF in childhood
• Pallor – due to anaemia
• Increased photosensitive pigmentation – may make the
patient look misleadingly healthy
• Brown discolouration of the nails
• Scratch marks – due to uraemic pruritus
• Signs of fluid overload
• Pericardial friction rub
• Flow murmurs:
o Mitral regurgitation - due to mitral annular calcification
o Aortic/pulmonary regurgitation – due to volume
overload
Investigations:
• Urinalysis:
o Haematuria (e.g. GN)
o Proteinuria (e.g. UTI, DM, if heavy it suggests
glomerular disease)
o Glycosuria with normal BM is common in CRF
• Urine microscopy:
o WBCs in the urine indicate active bacterial urinary
infection
o Eosinophiluria:
• Allergic tubulointerstitial nephritis
• Cholesterol embolism
o Red cell casts strongly suggest GN
• Urine biochemistry:
o 24 hour creatinine clearance to assess the severity of
CRF
o Urine osmolality
• Serum biochemistry:
o Urea and creatinine
o Serum electrophoresis to detect myeloma
o Extreme elevation of CK and hyperkalaemia suggest
rhabdomyolysis
• Haematology:
o Eosinophilia:
• Vasculitis
• Allergic tubulointerstitial nephritis
• Cholesterol embolism
o Raised viscosity or ESR:
• Myeloma
• Vasculitis
276
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Haemolysis indicates haemolytic uraemic syndrome
• Immunology:
o Autoantibody screening:
• SLE
• Scleroderma
• Wegener’s granulomatosis
• Microscopic polyarteritis
• Goodpasture’s syndrome
• Microbiology:
o Urine culture
• Radiological investigations:
o Renal US (for renal size and to exclude
hydronephrosis)
o Plain AXR (renal calculi)
• Renal biopsy:
o Should be considered in every patient with unexplained
renal failure and normal-sized kidneys, unless there are
strong contraindications
Complications of CRF:
• Anaemia
• Renal osteodystrophy
• Skin disease
• GI complications
• Metabolic abnormalities
• Endocrine abnormalities
• CNS disturbances
• ANS disturbances
• PNS disturbances
• CVS disease
Anaemia:
Anaemia is present in the great majority of patients. Several factors
have been implicated:
• EPO deficiency (most important)
• Bone marrow toxins (retained in renal failure)
• Bone marrow fibrosis (secondary to hyperparathyroidism)
• Haematinic deficiency (Fe, folate B12)
• Haemolysis
• Increased blood loss (e.g. occult GI haemorrhage)
• ACE inhibitors (interfere with endogenous EPO release)
Renal osteodystrophy:
• Decreased production of 1α-hydroxylase results in decreased
production of 1,25(OH)2D3
• Decreased production of 1,25(OH)2D3 leads to secondary
hyperparathyroidism
• The increased PTH causes:
277
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Bone resorption
o Hypercalcaemia
o Raised serum ALP
Skin disease:
• Pruritus (itching) is common in severe renal failure and is
caused (mainly) by the retention of nitrogenous waste
products of protein catabolism
• Other causes of pruritus include:
o Hypercalcaemia
o Hyperphosphataemia
o Hyperparathyroidism (even if calcium and phosphate
levels are normal)
o Fe deficiency
GI complications:
• Decreased gastric emptying and increased risk of reflux
oesophagitis
• Peptic ulceration
• Acute pancreatitis
• Constipation (especially patients on CAPD)
Metabolic abnormalities:
• Gout
• Decreased insulin catabolism/excretion (therefore, dose must
be decreased in insulin-dependent diabetics)
• Dyslipidaemia
Endocrine abnormalities:
• Hyperprolactinaemia
• Increased LH levels in both sexes
• Decreased serum testosterone
• Oligomenorrhoea/amenorrhoea
• Decreased thyroid hormone levels
CNS abnormalities:
• Severe uraemia causes:
o Depressed cerebral function
o Asterixis
o Tremor
o Myoclonus
ANS abnormalities:
• Increased circulating levels of catecholamines
• Impaired baroreceptor sensitivity
• Impaired efferent vagal function
278
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
PNS abnormalities:
• ‘Restless legs’ syndrome
• Median nerve compression in the carpal tunnel is common
CVS disease:
• Increased risk of:
o MI
o Cardiac failure
o Sudden cardiac death
o Stroke
• Pericarditis is common and occurs in 2 clinical settings:
o Uraemic pericarditis:
• Haemorrhagic pericardial effusion and atrial
arrhythmias are often associated
• Is a danger of pericardial tamponade
• Anticoagulants should be use with caution
o Dialysis pericarditis
Management of CRF:
• BP control:
o Aim for around 130/80mmHg
o ACE inhibitors are believed to be the most beneficial
in renal failure
• Hyperkalaemia:
o Usually responds well to dietary restriction of potassium
o Drugs which cause potassium retention should be
stopped
• Acidosis:
o Correction of acidosis helps to correct hyperkalaemia in
CRF and may also decrease muscle catabolism
o Sodium bicarbonate supplements are often effective,
but may cause oedema and HT (owing to ECF
expansion)
279
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Most patients with renal impairment will require a diet
restricted in sodium and potassium
o Prolonged dietary protein restriction should be avoided.
It is preferable to commence renal replacement therapy
a little earlier than to cause malnutrition
280
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cluster headache
(Migrainous neuralgia, Horton’s neuralgia)
Epidemiology:
• Peak age 30s-40s
• Men > women
Clinical features:
• Recurrent bouts of excruciating pain that wake the patient at
night and are centred around one eye
• Can be precipitated by alcohol
• Pain rises to a crescendo over ~30 minutes and lasts for
several hours
• Vomiting occurs
• One side of the face and nostril feel congested
• A transient ipsilateral Horner’s syndrome is common during
the attack
Management:
• Despite the very severe pain, there are no serious sequelae
• Attacks recur at intervals over several years but tend to
disappear over the age of 55 years
• Analgesics during the attack are NOT effective
Prophylaxis:
• Lithium carbonate (400-1200mg daily)
• Inhalation of oxygen can help abort an attack
281
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Delirium
(acute confusional state)
Consciousness:
• Impaired, with onset over hours or days
• Can be described as either:
o A mild impairment of thinking, attending, perceiving and
remembering
o A mild global impairment of cognitive processes
associated with a reduced awareness of the
environment
• Conscious level fluctuates throughout the day with confusion
typically worsening in the late afternoon and at night
Disorientation:
• Disorientation in time (does not know the time, day or year)
and place (often more marked) is the rule
Behaviour:
• Either:
o Inactivity
o Quietness
o Reduced speech
• Or:
o Hyperactivity
o Noisiness
o Irritability (these patients can be very disruptive)
Thinking:
• Slow and muddled
• Commonly with ideas or delusions (e.g. accusing staff of
plotting against them)
Perception:
• Disturbed
• Often with illusions and hallucinations (especially visual but
also auditory and tactile)
Mood:
• Lability
• Anxiety
• Perplexion
• Fear
• Agitation
• Depression
282
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Memory:
• Impaired during delirium and on recovery
• Amnesia is usual
Differential diagnosis:
• If agitated, consider anxiety
• If delusions or hallucinations, consider primary mental illness
(e.g. schizophrenia)
• Remember that in hospitalized ill patients with no psychiatric
history, mental illness is rare and delirium is common
Causes:
• Systemic infection (e.g. pneumonia, UTI)
• Drugs (e.g. opiates, anticonvulsants, recreational)
• Alcohol/drug withdrawal
• Metabolic (e.g. hypoglycaemia, uraemia)
• Hypoxia (respiratory or cardiac failure)
• Vascular (CVA, MI)
• Intracranial infection (e.g. encephalitis, meningitis)
• Raised ICP/space-occupying lesions
• Epilepsy (status epilepticus, post-ictal states)
• Head injury (especially subdural haematoma)
• Nutritional (e.g. thiamine, B12 deficiency)
Management:
1. Identify and treat the underlying cause
2. Reduce distress and prevent accidents
3. Nurse in a moderately lit, quiet room with the same staff in
attendance (minimizes confusion) where the patient can be
watched closely
4. Minimize medication (especially if sedative)
283
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Dementia
The patient:
• The key to diagnosis is a good history (usually requiring the
help of a spouse, relative or friend) of progressive impairment
of memory and cognition together with objective evidence of
such impairment
• The impairment should go back at least several months, and
usually several years
• Typically, the patient has become increasingly forgetful, and
has carried out the normal tasks of daily living (e.g. cooking,
shopping) with increasing incompetence:
o E.g. going to the butchers to buy sausages 6 times a
day and then being baffled as to why there was a great
mound of sausages in the kitchen
• Sometimes the patient appears to have changed personality
(e.g. by becoming uncharacteristically rude and aggressive)
• For objective evidence, carry out the mini-mental state
examination (MMS exam – see below)
Commonest causes:
• Alzheimer’s disease
• Vascular dementia (~25% of all cases):
o Essentially multiple small strokes
o Is usually evidence of vascular pathology (e.g. HT,
previous CVAs)
Rarer causes:
• Chronic alcohol/barbiturate abuse
• Huntington’s disease
• CJD
• Parkinson’s disease
• Pick’s disease
• HIV
Ameliorable causes:
• Hypothyroidism
• B12/Folate deficiency
• Syphilis
• Thiamine deficiency
• Operable cerebral tumour
• Subdural haematoma
284
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Mini-mental state examination (MMS exam):
If dementia is suspected, test memory and other intellectual
abilities formally. The MMS exam is one of many similar tests. It has
been more fully studied than most.
• What day of the week is it? [1 point]
• What is the date today? Day, month, year [1 point each]
• What is the season? [1 point]
• What country are we in? [1 point]
• What is the name of this town [1 point]
• What are 2 main streets nearby [1 point]
• What floor of the building are we on? [1 point]
• What is the name of this place [1 point]
• ‘I am going to give you a piece of paper. When I do, take it in
your right hand. Fold the paper in half with both hands and
put the paper down on your lap’ [1 point for each of the 3
actions]
• Show a pencil and ask what it is called [1 point]
• Show a wristwatch and ask what it is called [1 point]
• ‘I am going to say something and I would like you to repeat it
after me: No ifs, ands, or buts’ [1 point]
• ‘Please read what is written here and do what it says’ (show
the patient a piece of card with CLOSE YOUR EYES written on
it [1 point]
• ‘Write a complete sentence on this sheet of paper’ [1 point]
• ‘Here is a drawing. Please copy the drawing’. Show the picture
of 2 pentagons intertwined [1 point]
• ‘I am going to name 3 objects. After I have finished saying all
3, I want you to repeat them. Remember what they are
because I am going to ask you to name them again in a few
minutes’ e.g. APPLE, TABLE, PENNY [1 point each]
• ‘Now I would like you to take 7 away from 100. Now take 7
away from the number you get. Now keep subtracting until I
tell you to stop’. Score 1 point each time the difference is 7,
even if the previous answer was incorrect. Go on for 5
subtractions [5 points]
• ‘What were the 3 objects I asked you to remember a little
while ago?’ [1 point each object]
The maximum score is 30. 28-30 does not support the diagnosis of
dementia. A score of 25-27 is borderline. <25 suggests dementia
but consider also acute confusional state an depression
Investigations:
• Urine dipstick
• FBC/blood film
• ESR
• U&Es
• LFTs
285
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Ca2+
• Syphilis serology
• B12/folate
• TFTs
• CXR
• CT scan (atypical history, young patient, head injury)
• EEG
Management:
There are specific treatments for Alzheimer’s, HIV, myxoedema and
dementia associated with a low B12 and folate
• Treat concurrent illnesses (these may contribute significantly
to confusion)
• In most people the dementia remains and will progress
• The approach to management is that of any chronic illness
• Prepare the spouse for the day when the patient no longer
recognises loved ones
286
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Depression
Aetiology:
• Genetic:
o 10-15% of first-degree relatives have an affective
disorder (risk in general population is 1-2%)
o 68% of monozygotic twins are concordant for manic-
depressive disorder
• Biochemical:
o Imbalance in NTs (e.g. monoamine NTs are depleted in
depression
o Loss of diurnal rhythm of plasma cortisol
o Hormonal factors (e.g. depression more common after
child-birth and post-hysterectomy)
• Psychological:
o Maternal deprivation
o Learned helplessness
• Social:
o Stressful events (e.g. bereavement, loss of a job)
o Vulnerability factors (e.g. lack of a confiding, intimate
relationship)
287
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Ideation feelings of futility, guilt, suicidal thoughts
Cognition Verbal memory impaired, pseudo-dementia
Physical Early waking, weight loss, loss of libido,
fatigue
Behaviour Retardation/agitation, poverty of movement
Hallucinations Auditory – often abusive, hostile, critical
288
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Act by potentiating the action of monoamines, serotonin and
noradrenaline by inhibiting their reuptake into nerve terminals
• Side-effects:
o Anticholinergic effects:
• Dry mouth
• Constipation
• Tremor
• Blurred vision
• Urinary retention
• Postural hypotension
o Cardiac effects:
• ECG changes
• Arrhythmias
o Convulsant activity:
• Lowered seizure threshold
o Other effects:
• Weight gain
• Sedation
• Mania
289
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
290
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Folate deficiency
Clinical features:
• Asymptomatic
• Symptoms of anaemia
• Symptoms of the underlying cause
• Glossitis
• Neuropathy does not occur
Investigations:
• Haematological findings show a megaloblastic anaemia:
o MCV >96fl
o Macrocytosis
o Hypersegmented neutrophils (with >6 nuclear lobes)
o Leucopenia/thrombocytopenia if severe
• Low serum folate
Treatment:
• 5mg of folic acid daily PO with an improvement in the clinical
picture within 48 hours
• Prophylactic folic acid (400µg) is recommended for all women
planning a pregnancy
291
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathology:
• Is a granulomatous arteritis of unknown aetiology
• Affects mainly those >60 years of age
• Other forms of arteritis can present with similar features, e.g:
o SLE
o Polyarteritis nodosa
• Very closely related to polymyalgia rheumatica (both can
occur in the same patient)
Clinical features:
• Headache:
o Pain is felt over the inflamed artery (superficial,
temporal or occipital)
o Touching the skin over the artery causes pain (e.g.
brushing hair)
• Facial pain:
o Jaw, face and mouth pain occurs
o Worse on eating (jaw claudication)
o Opening the mouth and protruding the tongue is difficult
• Visual problems:
o 25% of untreated cases go blind (due to
inflammation/occlusion of the ciliary and/or central
retinal artery)
• Systemic features:
o Polymyalgia rheumatica (occurs in 50% of cases):
• Generalized muscle pains
• Proximal limb girdle pain and tenderness
• NO joint effusions
• Weight loss
• Sweating
• Malaise
Investigations:
• Raised ESR
• Raised CRP
• Albumin reduced (occasionally)
• Diagnosis is confirmed by a biopsy of a superficial temporal
artery
Treatment:
• High dose steroids should be started immediately (e.g.
prednisolone 60-100mg daily), even before the biopsy
• The dose is reduced as the ESR falls
292
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• It is usually possible to stop steroid therapy after some
months to several years
293
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Guillain-Barre syndrome (GBS)
Pathogenesis:
• A demyelinating neuropathy
• Has an autoallergic basis
• Follows 1-3 weeks after infection (that is often trivial and
rarely identified)
• Campylobacter infection, however, is a recognised cause of
GBS
Clinical features:
• Weakness of distal limb muscles and/or distal numbness
ascending over several days or over a period of up to 3 weeks
• In mild cases, there is little disability before spontaneous
recovery begins
• 20% of cases have complete paralysis, including respiratory
muscles
• Weakness, areflexia and sensory loss are found in an
ascending pattern from fingers to toes
Diagnosis:
• Established on clinical grounds
• Confirmed by nerve conduction studies, which show:
o Slowing of conduction
o Prolonged distal motor latency
• Raised CSF protein level
294
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Haemodialysis
Basic principles:
• Blood is pumped from the patient through an array of
semipermeable membranes, which bring the blood into close
contact with diasylate, flowing counter-current with the blood
• The plasma biochemistry changes towards that of the
diasylate owing to diffusion of molecules down their
concentration gradients
• Blood flow during dialysis is usually 200-300ml per minute
and the diasylate flow is usually 500ml per minute
Complications:
• Hypotension during dialysis (major problem)
• Haemolytic reactions
• Air embolism
295
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Haemofiltration
Haemofiltration:
• This involves removal of plasma water and its dissolved
constituents (e.g. K+, Na+, urea and PO43-) by convective flow
across a high-flux semi-permeable membrane, and replacing
it with a solution of the desired biochemical composition
• Can be used for both acute and chronic renal failure
• High volumes need to be exchanged in order to achieve
adequate small molecule removal:
o CRF - 22L exchange 3 times a week
o ARF – 1L per hour
• Expensive and not often used in patients with ESRF
• May be cost-effective in treating ARF
296
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hypertension
Definition:
• Very hard to define as it is varies from individual to individual
and within individuals
• In a patient <50 years: 140/90mmHg
• In patient >50 years: 165/95mmHg
• Hypertension can be either primary (‘essential) or secondary
Secondary hypertension:
• Renal causes:
o >80% of the cases of secondary HT
o Diabetic nephropathy
o Chronic glomerulonephritis
o Polycystic kidney disease
o Renovascular disease
• Endocrine causes:
o Conn’s syndrome (hypersecretion of aldosterone)
o Adrenal hyperplasia
o Phaeochromocytoma
o Cushing’s syndrome
o Acromegaly
• CVS causes:
o Coarctation of the aorta
• Drugs:
o OCP
o Steroids
Complications of hypertension:
• Cerebrovascular disease (e.g. CVA)
• Coronary artery disease
• Renal failure
• Peripheral vascular disease
Malignant hypertension:
• Is said to occur when BP rises rapidly and is considered with
severe HT (diastolic BP >140mmHg)
• Are changes in the renal circulation resulting in rapidly
progressive renal failure, proteinuria and haematuria
• High risk of cerebral oedema and haemorrhage
• Marked changes in the retinal vessels (characteristic of
malignant HT)
297
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Without effective treatment, there is a 1 year survival of
<20%
Investigations:
• Routine investigation of the hypertensive patient should
include:
o CXR
o ECG
o Echocardiogram
o Urinalysis
o Fasting blood for lipids and glucose
o U&Es
Drug therapy:
• The decision to commence specific drug therapy should
usually be made only after a careful period of assessment (of
up to 6 months) with repeated measurements of BP
Diuretics:
• Thiazide diuretics:
o E.g. bendrofluazide (2.5-5mg daily)
o Duration of 12-24 hours
o Side-effects include:
• Hyperlipidaemia
• Hyperglycaemia
• Hyperuricaemia
• Hypokalaemia
• Loop diuretics:
o E.g. Frusemide (40mg daily)
o Have a hypotensive effect and are not routinely used in
essential HT
• Potassium-sparing diuretics:
o E.g. Spironolactone (50-200mg daily) or amiloride (5-
10mg daily)
o Not effective when used on their own, need to be used
in combination with another diuretic
β-blockers:
• Decrease force of cardiac contraction
• Reduce renin secretion
• Reduce anxiety (as anxiety increases BP)
298
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
β-blockers side-effects:
• Bradycardia
• Bronchospasm (avoid in asthmatics)
• Cold extremities
• Fatigue
• Nightmares
ACE inhibitors:
• E.g. captopril (50-150mg daily in divided doses), enalapril
(10-20mg daily)
• Block production of angiotensin II (potent vasoconstrictor)
• Inhibit degradation of bradykinin (potent vasodilator)
• Side-effects include severe hypotension on first administration
and a dry cough (caused by the accumulation of bradykinin)
299
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
α-blockers:
• E.g. doxazosin (1-4mg daily)
• Cause postsynaptic α1-receptor blockade
• Results in vasodilatation and a fall in BP
Drug selection:
• Treatment is normally commenced with a single agent
(monotherapy)
• The target of therapy should be to maintain:
o Diastolic BP in the range 80-90mmHg
o Systolic BP <160mmHg
• Conventionally, thiazide diuretics and B-blockers have been
used as a first line treatment, with the other agents reserved
for those in whom these prove ineffective
300
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Intracerebral haemorrhage
Aetiology:
• Intracerebral haemorrhage is the cause of ~30% of strokes
(the remainder being due to acute ischaemic events)
• The principal cause of intracerebral haemorrhage is rupture of
a microaneurysm (Charcot-Bouchard aneurysms, 0.8-1mm in
diameter)
• Occurs typically in patients with HT
• There are well-defined sites for the rupture:
o Basal ganglia
o Pons
o Cerebellum
o Subcortical white matter
• Saccular (Berry) aneurysms and arteriovenous malformations
also bleed into the brain, but cause principally subarachnoid
haemorrhage
Management:
• The general management is as for cerebral infarction,
although the immediate prognosis is worse
• Urgent neurosurgical evacuation of the clot should be
considered when an intracerebral haematoma behaves as an
expanding mass, causing:
o Deepening coma
o Coning
• Antiplatelet drugs and anticoagulants are contraindicated
301
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Iron-deficiency anaemia
Causes of Fe deficiency:
• Blood loss (e.g. menstruation)
• Increased demands (e.g. growth, pregnancy)
• Decreased absorption (e.g. bowel resection)
• Inadequate intake
Investigations:
• FBC and film:
o Decreased MCV (microcytosis)
o Decreased MCH (hypochromia)
o Anisocytosis (variation in RBC size)
o Poikilocytosis (variation in RBC shape)
• Serum ferritin:
o This reflects the amount of stored Fe
Treatment:
• Important to discover underlying cause and treat it
• Oral Fe is all that is required in most cases:
o Ferrous sulphate 600mg daily
• Side-effects include nausea and diarrhoea/constipation
302
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Severe Malabsorption
o Another cause for the anaemia
303
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Meningitis
Aetiology:
Meningitis means inflammation of the meninges
• It may be caused by:
o Bacteria
o Viruses
o Fungi
o Malignant cells
o Drugs and contrast media
o Blood (following SAH)
• Micro-organisms reach the meninges either via:
o The bloodstream
o Direct extension from the:
• Ears
• Nasopharynx
• Cranial injury
• Congenital meningeal defect
Clinical features:
• The meningitic syndrome - a triad of:
o Headache
o Neck stiffness
o Fever
• In acute bacterial meningitis – developing within hours or
minutes:
o Intense malaise
o Fever
o Rigors
o Severe headache
o Photophobia
o Vomiting
o The patient often prefers to lie still. Neck stiffness and a
positive Kernig’s sign appear within hours
• In uncomplicated meningitis, consciousness is not impaired,
although a patient with a high fever may be delirious
Complications:
• Septicaemia
• Venous sinus thrombus
• Severe cerebral oedema
• Hydrocephalus
• Complications may be indicated by:
o Progressive drowsiness
o Lateralizing signs
o Cranial nerve lesions
304
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Differential diagnosis:
• Migraine
• SAH
• Cerebral malaria
Management:
• Condition is lethal. Even with optimal care, the mortality is
still ~15%
• Immediate parenteral antibiotic treatment should be given
before any investigations
• LP is usually contraindicated if the clinical diagnosis is
meningococcal disease (because coning of the cerebellar
tonsils may follow)
• If there is any suspicion of an intracranial mass lesion. An
immediate CT scan should be carried out
• Immediate LP should be carried out (if deemed safe)
• Blood should be taken for FBC, U&Es, LFTs, glucose and a
culture
305
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Metabolic neuropathies
Diabetes mellitus
• Several varieties of neuropathy occur in diabetes mellitus:
o Symmetrical sensory polyneuropathy
o Acute painful neuropathy
o Mononeuropathy and multiple mononeuropathy:
• Cranial nerve lesions
• Isolated peripheral nerve lesions (e.g. median)
o Diabetic amyotrophy
o Autonomic neuropathy
Chronic uraemia:
• Progressive sensorimotor neuropathy occurs in chronic
uraemia
• Variable response to dialysis
• Usually improves after renal transplantation
Thyroid disease:
• A mild chronic sensorimotor neuropathy is sometimes seen in
both thyrotoxicosis and hypothyroidism
306
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Migraine
Definition:
• Recurrent headaches associated with visual and GI
disturbance
• The borderline between migraine and tension headaches is
vague
• Over 10% of any population sampled admit to these
symptoms
Clinical patterns:
• Migraine can be separated into phases:
o Occasionally, a feeling of well-being prior to the attack
o Prodromal symptoms
o Headache and associated features
307
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hemiplegic migraine:
• Rare
• Is where classical migraine is accompanied by hemiplegia
• Recovery occurs within 24 hours
Ophthalmoplegic migraine:
• Rare
• Is a 3rd nerve palsy occurring in a migraine attack
• Difficult to distinguish from other causes of a 3rd nerve palsy
without investigation
Basilar migraine:
• The prodromal symptoms are:
o Circumoral tingling
o Numbness of the tongue
o Vertigo
o Diplopia
o Transient visual disturbance
o Complete blindness
o Syncope
o Dysarthria
o Ataxia
• These occur either in isolation or progress to a migrainous
headache
Differential diagnosis:
• Meningitis
• Subarachnoid haemorrhage
• TIA (note: headache is uncommon)
• Epilepsy
Management:
• General measures include:
o Reassurance and relief of anxiety
o Avoidance of precipitating dietary factors
• During an attack:
o Paracetamol (or another simple analgesic)
o Antiemetic if necessary (e.g. metoclopramide)
o 5HT1 agonist (e.g. sumatriptan SC, PO Inh) is of value
• Prophylaxis:
o 5HT antagonist (e.g. pizotifen 0.5mg ON PO for several
days, increasing to 1.5mg ON PO)
o Propranolol 10mg PO TID, increasing to 40-80mg PO
TID
o Amitripyline 10-30mg ON PO is sometimes helpful
308
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Mononeuritis multiplex
(multiple mononeuropathy)
309
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Mononeuropathies
Definition:
• A pathological process affecting a single peripheral nerve
310
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Decompression and transposition of the nerve at the elbow
may be necessary
311
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Osteoarthritis
Aetiology:
• Early in the development of OA, the surface of the cartilage
becomes fibrillated and fissured as the collagen matrix breaks
down
• These changes lead to focal erosion of cartilage
• Cartilage ulceration exposes underlying bone to increased
stress (producing microfractures and cysts)
• The bone attempts repair but produces abnormal sclerotic
subchondral bone and overgrowths at the joint margins
(called osteophytes)
Risk factors:
• Obesity
• Sex (females > males)
• Family history
• sport
Symptoms:
• Joint pain
• Evening stiffness
• Joint instability
• Loss of function
312
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Signs:
• Crepitus on movement
• Limitation of range of movement
• Joint instability
• Joint effusion
• Bony swelling
• Wasting of muscles
Clinical subsets:
• There are 5 main subsets:
o Nodal OA
o Erosive OA
o Generalized OA
o Large-joint OA
o Crystal-associated OA
Nodal OA:
• The joints are usually affected one at a time over several
years
• DIPs being most often involved
• Onset may be painful and associated with:
o Tenderness
o Swelling
o Inflammation
o Impairment of hand function
• The inflammatory phase settles after some months or years,
leaving painless bony swellings posterolaterally with
Heberden’s nodes (DIPs) and Bouchard’s nodes (PIPs) along
with stiffness and deformity
Large-joint OA:
• This affects the hips and the knees independently
• The hips:
o Superior-pole hip arthritis:
• Most common in men
• Affects the weight-bearing upper surface of the
femoral head and adjacent acetabulum
313
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Unilateral at presentation but may become
bilateral
o Medial cartilage loss:
• Most common in women
• Associated with hand involvement
• Usually bilateral
• The knees:
o Generally bilateral
o Strongly associated with polyarticular OA of the hand
o Medial compartment is most commonly affected
Investigation in OA:
• X-rays:
o Characteristic changes (see below) only apparent when
the damage is advanced
• MRI:
o Can demonstrate early cartilage changes
• Arthroscopy:
o Can reveal early fissuring and surface erosion of the
cartilage
Treatment – medical:
• Short courses of analgesics
• Intra-articular corticosteroid injections provide short-term
improvement when there is a painful joint effusion
Surgery:
• Total replacement arthroplasty:
o Complication rate ~1%
314
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• The peripheral nerve consists of 2 principle cellular structures:
o Axon
o Myelin sheath
• Blood supply to a peripheral nerve is via the vasa nervorum
Mechanisms of damage:
• Demyelination (e.g. Guillain-Barre syndrome)
• Axonal degeneration (e.g. toxic neuropathies)
• Wallerian degeneration (describes the changes following
section of a nerve)
• Compression (e.g. carpal tunnel syndrome)
• Infarction (e.g. diabetes mellitus, polyarteritis nodosa)
• Infiltration (e.g. malignancy, leprosy)
315
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Peripheral oedema
Starling’s principles:
• Distribution of ECF depends on:
• Venous tone (which determines the capacitance of the blood
compartment and thus hydrostatic pressure)
• Capillary permeability
• Oncotic pressure (mainly dependent on serum albumin)
• Lymphatic drainage
• Depending on these factors, fluid accumulation may result in
expansion of interstitial volume, blood volume or both
Clinical features:
• Peripheral oedema is caused by expansion of the ECF volume
by at least 2L (15%)
• Ankles are normally the first to be affected
• Oedema may be noticed in the face (particularly in the
morning)
• In bed-bound patients, oedema may accumulate in the sacral
area
• Expansion of the interstitial volume also causes:
o Pulmonary oedema
o Pleural effusion
o Pericardial effusion
o Ascites
• Expansion of the blood volume causes:
o A raised JVP
o Cardiomegaly
o Added heart sounds
o Raised arterial BP
Causes:
• Heart failure
• Hypoalbuminaemia
• Hepatic cirrhosis (owing largely to peripheral vasodilatation)
• Sodium retention
Treatment:
• Treat the underlying cause where possible
• The mainstay of therapy is diuretics
Loop diuretics:
• E.g. Frusemide
• Potent
• Stimulate excretion of both NaCl and water
316
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Also increase venous capacitance (resulting in rapid clinical
improvement in patients with LVF)
• Side-effects include:
o Hyperuricaemia (resulting in gout)
o Hypokalaemia
o Hypomagnesaemia
o Decreased glucose tolerance
o Ototoxicity (due to an action on sodium pump activity in
the inner ear)
Thiazide diuretics:
• E.g. bendrofluazide
• Less potent than loop diuretics
• Reduce peripheral vascular resistance by an unknown
mechanism
• Reduce calcium excretion
• Cause relatively more hyperuricaemia, glucose intolerance
and hypokalaemia than loop diuretics
Potassium-sparing diuretics:
• Relatively weak diuretics
• Most commonly used in combination with loop or thiazide
diuretics to prevent hypokalaemia
• Two types:
o Spironolactone (aldosterone antagonist, therefore
+
reduces Na absorption
o Amiloride (inhibits sodium uptake in the collecting duct
and reduces renal potassium excretion)
317
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Peritoneal dialysis
Basic principles:
• Utilizes the peritoneal membrane as a semipermeable
membrane, therefore avoiding the need for extracorporeal
circulation of blood
• The principles are simple:
o A tube is placed into the peritoneal cavity through the
anterior abdominal wall
o Diasylate is run into the peritoneal cavity under gravity
o Urea, creatinine, phosphate and other uraemic toxins
pass into the diasylate down their concentration
gradients
o Water (with solutes) is attracted into the peritoneal
cavity by osmosis, depending on the osmolarity of the
diasylate (this is determined by the dextrose
concentration of the diasylate)
o The fluid is changed regularly to repeat the process
• There are 3 main adaptations of peritoneal dialysis:
o Continual ambulatory peritoneal dialysis (CAPD)
o Nightly intermittent peritoneal dialysis (NIPD)
o Tidal dialysis
Complications:
• Bacterial peritonitis
• Infection around the catheter site
• Constipation
• Pleural effusion (caused leakage of the diasylate through a
diaphragmatic defect)
318
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Polyneuropathies
Varieties of polyneuropathy:
• Guillain-Barre syndrome (acute post-infective
polyneuropathy)
• Chronic inflammatory demyelinating polyneuropathy (CIDP)
• Metabolic neuropathies
• Toxic neuropathies
319
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Renal transplantation
320
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Complications:
• Technical failure:
o Occlusion/stenosis of the arterial and/or venous
anastomoses
o Leaks (owing to damage to the lower ureter)
• Immunosuppression:
o Corticosteroid complications (e.g. moon face, easy
bruising, etc)
o Cyclosporin can produce a rash, nephrotoxicity, tremor,
diabetes
o Tacrolimus can cause nephrotoxicity and neurotoxicity
o Azathioprine can lead to bone marrow suppression
321
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathology:
• Widespread persisting synovitis (inflammation of the synovial
lining of joints, tendon sheaths or bursae)
• Unknown mechanism but the production of rheumatoid factors
(RFs) is thought to be important
• The synovium becomes greatly thickened to the extent that it
is palpable as a ‘boggy’ swelling around the joints and
tendons
• There is marked vascular proliferation
• Increased permeability blood vessels and the synovial lining
layer leads to joint effusions
• The hyperplastic synovium spreads from the joint margins on
to the cartilage surface. This ‘pannus’ of inflamed synovium
damages the underlying cartilage by blocking its normal route
for nutrition and the direct effect of cytokines on the
chondrocytes
Typical presentation:
• ~70% of cases begin as a slowly progressive, symmetrical,
peripheral polyarthritis
• Usual timescale is a few weeks or months
• Women 3x > men
• Peak age of onset is 30-40 (can occur at any age)
322
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• 15% of patients have a rapid onset of symptoms (occurring
over a few days or even overnight). Surprisingly, these
patients have a better prognosis
• Bad prognostic signs include:
o Female
o Gradual onset over a few months
o Positive IgM RF
o Anaemia occurring within the first 3 months
Complications:
• Of the disease:
o Ruptured tendons
o Joint infection (septic arthritis)
o Ruptured joints (e.g. Baker’s cysts)
o Spinal cord compression
o Amyloidosis
• Of the therapy:
o Anaemia
o Marrow hypoplasia
o Renal impairment
o GI bleeding
Septic arthritis:
• Serious complication with a high mortality
• The joint(s) may be hot, inflamed with accompanying fever
• Increased WCC
• However, these signs can be absent and any effusion
(particularly of sudden onset) should be aspirated
• Staph. aureus is the most common organism
• Treatment is with systemic antibiotics
323
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Amyloidosis:
• Is found in a small number of cases of severe RA
• RA is the most common cause of secondary amyloidosis
Drug therapy:
• Essentially comprises 3 main groups of drugs:
o NSAIDs (Non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs)
o DMARDs (Disease modifying anti-rheumatic drugs)
324
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Corticosteroids
NSAIDs:
• Control the pain and stiffness but do not reduce the
underlying inflammatory relapse or the acute flare reactants
in the serum
• Always start with a familiar drug. It should be cheap, have a
low incidence of side-effects and a convenient dosage
schedule
• Major side-effects of NSAIDs are gastrointestinal:
o Haemorrhage a major problem in the elderly
o Pts with previous PUD should have their H. pylori status
checked, followed by eradication therapy if required
o Risks can be reduced by the co-administration of H2-
receptor antagonists or PPIs
• Other side-effects include:
o Fluid retention
o Tubulo-interstitial nephritis
o Drug interactions
DMARDs:
• Sulphasalazine:
o 1-1.5g BD PO
• Methotrexate:
o 2.5-15mg once weekly PO (remember folate
supplementation)
• Gold:
o 3mg BD PO or 50mg weekly IM
• Penicillmine:
• 250-400mg AC PO
• Antimalarials:
o 400mg OD PO
It should be noted that DMARDs are almost exclusively prescribed
by a rheumatologist and that each drug has numerous side-effects
Corticosteroids:
• The use of oral corticosteroids has a number of problems:
1. Patients are increasingly anxious about the use of
corticosteroids because of adverse publicity about their
potential side-effects
2. Risk of weight gain
3. Skin becomes thin and easily damaged
4. Monitor for DM and HT
5. Cataract formation may be accelerated
6. Osteoporosis develops within 6 months on doses >7.5mg
daily and HRT and/or calcium and vitamin D or
bisphosphonate is used
325
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Must be avoided in the long-term
• Intra-articular injections have a powerful but short-lived effect
• IM depot injections (40-120mg depot methylprednisolone)
help to control severe flare-ups of the disease; or can be used
before a holiday or other important event but should be used
with caution and infrequently
326
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Septic arthritis
Causative organisms:
• Staph. aureus (most common)
• Streptococci
• N. gonorrhoea
• Haemophilus influenzae
Clinical features:
• Is a medical emergency
• In the young the joint is:
o Hot
o Swollen
o Red
o Agonisingly painful
o Held immobile by muscle spasm
• In the elderly/immunocompromised:
o Clinical picture is less dramatic
Investigations:
• Aspirate the joint:
o Send the fluid for urgent Gram stain and culture
o The fluid is usually frankly purulent
• Blood cultures:
o Are usually positive
• Leucocytosis:
o Is usual, unless patient is severely immunocompromised
Treatment:
• Should be started immediately on diagnosis as joint
destruction occurs in days
• IV antibiotics should be given for a week
• It is usual to give 2 antibiotics to which the organism is
sensitive for 6 weeks, then 1 for a further 6 weeks orally
• Immobilize the joint initially
• Physiotherapy should be started early to prevent stiffness and
muscle wasting
327
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• In immunocompromised patients:
o Flucloxacillin 1-2g IV QID, plus
o Gentamycin IV (to cover anaerobes)
Prognosis:
• Surgical drainage may be required if there is joint destruction
and osteomyelitis
• Patients can start weight-bearing as soon as the inflammation
subsides
• Resolution of the arthritis with complete recovery can occur in
a few days or weeks
328
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Causes:
• Common causes:
o Saccular (‘berry’) aneurysms ~70%
o Arteriovenous malformations ~10%
o No lesion found ~20%
• Rare associations:
o Bleeding disorders
o Mycotic aneurysms
o Acute bacterial meningitis
o Brain tumours (e.g. metastatic melanoma)
o Marfan’s syndrome
329
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Loss of consciousness
• The patient remain comatose or drowsy for several hours to
several days
• Less severe headaches cause diagnostic difficulties (SAH is
possible diagnosis in any sudden headache)
On examination:
• Neck stiffness
• Positive Kernig’s sign:
o Pain and resistance on passive knee extension with hips
fully flexed
• Papilloedema is occasionally present
Investigations:
• CT imaging:
o Is the initial investigation of choice
o Subarachnoid or intraventricular blood is usually seen
• LP:
o Only necessary after CT if the diagnosis is in doubt
o The CSF becomes yellow (xanthochromic) several hours
after SAH
• Carotid and vertebral angiography:
o Usually performed in all patients who are potentially fit
for surgery (i.e. <65 years and not in a coma) to
establish the cause and site of bleeding
Differential diagnosis:
• Severe migraine
• Acute bacterial meningitis (caused by the rupture of a
meningeal microabscess)
Complications:
• Hydrocephalus:
o Caused by blood clots in the subarachnoid space
obstructing the flow of CSF
o Is a cause of deteriorating consciousness level a few
days or weeks after the initial bleed
o Shunting may be required
• Severe spasm of the intracranial arteries:
o Is an occasional complication
o Is a poor prognostic sign
Management:
• Where angiography demonstrates aneurysm, a direct
neurosurgical approach to clip the neck of the aneurysm is
carried out
• In selected cases, the results of surgery are excellent
• Immediate treatment:
330
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Bedrest
o Supportive measures
o Control HT
o Dexamethasone is often prescribed to reduce cerebral
oedema
• All cases of SAH should be referred to a specialist centre for a
decision about angiography and possible surgery
Prognosis:
• 50% of cases are dead or moribund before they reach hospital
• Of the remainder, a further 10-20% die in the early weeks in
hospital from further bleeding
331
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Tension headache
Aetiology:
• Worry
• Depression
• Noise
• Concentrated visual effort
• Fumes
Clinical features:
• Tight band sensation
• ‘Pressure behind the eyes’ sensation
• Throbbing
• ‘Bursting’ sensations
Signs:
• Tenderness/tension in the nuchal and scalp muscles
Management:
• Firm reassurance
• Avoiding the causes (where possible)
• Analgesics
• Physical treatments:
o Massage
o Icepacks
o Relaxation
• Antidepressants (where indicated)
• Imaging is occasionally needed to confirm the benign nature
of the problem
332
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Dietary deficiency causes the clinical syndrome of beriberi
• The principle features are polyneuropathy and cardiac failure
• It also leads to an amnesic syndrome called Wernicke-
Korsakoff syndrome
• Alcohol abuse is the commonest cause of thiamin deficiency in
the UK
Wernicke-Korsakoff syndrome:
• Composed of a classic triad of:
o Ocular signs
o Ataxia
o Confusion
• It is due to ischaemic damage to the brainstem and its
connections owing to thiamin dietary deficiency, alcohol or
other causes (e.g. anorexia nervosa)
• Clinical features include:
o Ocular signs:
• Nystagmus
• Bilateral lateral rectus palsies
• Conjugate gaze palsies
o Ataxia:
• Broad-based gait
• Vestibular paralysis (absent response to caloric
stimulation)
o Confusion:
• Apathy
• Decreased awareness
• Restlessness
• Amnesic syndrome
• Coma
• Thiamin should be given parenterally if the diagnosis is in
question. The drug is harmless, the condition is not
333
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• Anterior circulation (carotid system) affected:
o Amaurosis fugax
o Aphasia
o Hemiparesis
o Hemisensory loss
o Hemianopic visual loss
• Posterior circulation (vertebrobasilar system):
o Diplopia, vertigo, vomiting
o Choking and dysarthria
o Ataxia
o Hemisensory loss
o Hemianopic visual loss
o Transient global amnesia
o Tetraparesis
Amaurosis fugax:
• This is sudden, transient loss of vision in one eye
• A TIA causing amaurosis fugax is often the first clinical
evidence of internal carotid artery stenosis, which may herald
a hemiparesis
• Also occurs as a benign event in migraine
Differential diagnosis:
• Space-occupying lesion
• Focal epilepsy
• Migraine
Prognosis:
• Within 5 years of a TIA:
o 40% of patients will have suffered a stroke
o 25% of patients will have died, usually from heart
disease or stroke
• A TIA in the anterior circulation carries a more serious
prognosis than one in the posterior circulation
334
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hemiparesis:
• The level within the corticospinal tract (CoST) is recognized by
various accompanying features
• Motor cortex:
o Paralysis localized to one contralateral limb
(monoplegia) or part of a limb (e.g. a weak hand) is
characteristic of an isolated lesion of the motor cortex
(e.g. a secondary neoplasm)
o There may be a defect in higher cortical function (e.g.
aphasia if the speech area is affected)
o Focal epilepsy may be present
• Internal capsule:
o Since all CoST fibres are tightly packed in the internal
capsule (occupying ~1cm2) a small lesion causes a large
deficit
o E.g. an infarct of a small branch of the middle cerebral
artery causes a sudden contralateral hemiplegia that
includes the face
• Pons:
o A pontine lesion (e.g. a plaque of MS) is rarely confined
only to the CoST
o As adjacent structures such as the 6th and 7th cranial
nerve nuclei, MLF and PPRF are involved, there are
other localizing signs:
o VI and VII nerve palsies
o Intranuclear nuclear ophthalmoplegia (INO)
o Lateral gaze palsy
• Spinal cord:
o An isolated lesion of a single lateral CoST within the
cord (which is unusual) causes an ipsilateral UMN lesion,
the level of which is indicated by:
o A reflex level (e.g. absent biceps jerk)
o The presence of a Brown-Sequard syndrome
o Muscle wasting at the level of the lesion
335
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Paraparesis:
• Paraparesis (and tetraparesis when all 4 limbs are involved)
indicates bilateral damage to the CoSTs
• Spinal cord compression or other cord disease is the usual
cause, but cerebral lesions can occasionally produce
paraparesis
336
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Thrombosis can occur in any vein, but the veins of the leg and
pelvis are the most common sites.
Superficial thrombophlebitis:
• Commonly involves the saphenous vein
• Often associated with varicosities
• Occasionally the axillary vein is involved (usually as a result of
trauma)
• Local, superficial inflammation of the vein wall, with
secondary thrombosis
• The clinical picture is of a painful, tender, cord-like structure
with associated redness and swelling
• Treatment:
o Rest
o Elevation of the limb
o Analgesics (e.g. NSAIDs)
o Anticoagulants are NOT necessary as embolism does not
occur from superficial thrombophlebitis
337
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features of a DVT:
• Asymptomatic
• Calf DVT:
o Pain
o Redness
o Swelling
o Engorged superficial veins
• Iliofemoral DVT:
o Severe pain
o Thigh swelling
o Ankle oedema
PE can occur with any DVT but is more frequent from an iliofemoral
thrombosis and is rare with thrombosis confined to veins below the
knee
Investigations of DVT:
• Doppler ultrasound
• Venography
Treatment:
• All patients with thrombi above the knee are anticoagulated
• Anticoagulation of below-knee thrombi is controversial but is
usually recommended for 6 weeks
• Heparin is usually given for 2-3 days whilst warfarin (which is
started immediately) becomes effective
• Target INR should be 2.5
• Warfarin is usually continued for 3 months
• Thrombolytic therapy is sometimes used for patients with a
large iliofemoral thrombosis
Prognosis:
• Approximately 50% of patients with a DVT will have
destruction of the deep vein valve. This produces a:
o Clinically painful, swollen limb
o Made worse by standing
o Oedema
o Venous eczema
• Elastic support stockings are required for life
338
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
339
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Loss of vibration sense and proprioception
o Progressive weakness and ataxia
o Paraplegia may result
o Dementia can also occur
Investigations:
• FBC:
o Shows a megaloblastic anaemia
• Bone marrow:
o Shows the typical features of megaloblastic
erythropoiesis
• Serum bilirubin:
o May be raised (as a result of ineffective erythropoiesis)
• Serum vitamin B12:
o Usually well reduced
• Serum folate level:
o Is normal or high
o The red cell folate is normal or reduced (owing to the
inhibition of normal folate synthesis)
Treatment:
• Hydroxycobalamin 1000µg IM to a total of 5-6mg over the
course of 3 weeks
• 1000µg is then necessary every 3 months for the rest of the
patients life
• Clinical improvement may occur within 48 hours
• Improvement of the polyneuropathy may occur over 6-12
months (but longstanding spinal cord damage is irreversible)
340
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
General Surgery
341
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Para-umbilical hernia:
• The weakest area of the scar is at the superior aspect
between the umbilical vein and the upper margin of the
umbilical ring
• It is at this point that a para-umbilical hernia develops
• The emerging sac displaces the umbilical scar which lies below
and slightly to one side
• More common than true umbilical hernias
• Typically found in the obese middle-aged patient
• Women are 5x more likely than men to suffer from a para-
umbilical hernia
• The neck of the hernia is often narrow. In consequence,
tissues that enter have great difficulty leaving:
o Adhesions form
o Hernia becomes irreducible
o The sac progressively acquires more contents and may
become very large
o The contents are usually omentum, often with small
bowel or transverse colon
• Unsurprisingly, these hernias are at great risk of strangulation
342
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features – para-umbilical hernia:
• Symptoms:
o There is local pain and a swelling at the navel
o Non-specific GI symptoms are common
o Features of recurrent intestinal obstruction may have
occurred
• Signs:
o The umbilicus assumes a crescent shape
o Inspection and palpation reveal a swelling just above
the umbilicus whose centre (in contrast to a true
umbilical hernia) is not attached to the apex of the
protrusion
o However, in grossly obese patients, the swelling may
not be obvious to the naked eye and moreover is barely
palpable
o In others, the hernia may be enormous
o Usually it is (at least in part) reducible and there is a
cough impulse
Management:
• True umbilical hernia:
o Any underlying cause should be sought and dealt with
o In the rare event that nothing is found and the hernia is
causing symptoms, it is treated as a para-umbilical
hernia
• Para-umbilical hernia:
o Symptomatic hernias require treatment
o There is a high risk of strangulation and repair should
be advised, even in the absence of symptoms
o The usual procedure is to mobilise the sac and its
contents, return the latter to the abdomen, close the
neck and repair the abdominal wall by overlapping its
layers
• Strangulated umbilical hernia:
o The patient with severe abdominal pain and vomiting
and a soft non-tender umbilical hernia is a diagnostic
trap
o The loculated nature of the hernia allows a strangulated
portion of bowel (often of the Richter’s type) to go
unnoticed clinically
o In other instances, the local features of strangulation
may be obvious
o The operative approach is as for an elective case, and
the strangulating contents are dealt with according to
their state
343
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Anti-emetic drugs
H1-receptor antagonists:
• E.g. cyclizine, cinnarizine, promethazine
• Little or no activity against vomiting produced by substances
acting directly on the CTZ
• Effective in motion sickness and against vomiting caused by
substances which act locally in the stomach
• Most effective if given before the onset of nausea and
vomiting
• May have some action in controlling it when established
Muscarinic-receptor antagonists:
• E.g. hyoscine
• Active against nausea and vomiting of labyrinthine origin and
against vomiting due to local stimuli in the stomach
• Ineffective against substances which act directly on the CTZ
• Not very useful once sickness has occurred
• Main side-effects:
o Drowsiness
o Dry mouth
344
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Headache
o GI disturbances
DD-receptor antagonists:
• E.g. metoclopramide
• Acts in the CTZ
• Is a pro-kinetic (increases gut motility)
• Main side-effects:
o Extrapyramidal effects
o Dizziness
o Hyperprolactinaemia
o Amenorrhoea
o Diarrhoea
Cannabinoids:
• E.g. nabilone
• Decreases vomiting due to agents which stimulate the CTZ
• Its antiemetic effect is antagonised by naloxone (which
implies that opioid receptors may be important in the action
of this drug)
• Main side-effects:
o Drowsiness
o Dizziness
o Dry mouth
o Mood changes
345
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Wound infections:
• Occur in 20-60% of those undergoing GI surgery
• Sepsis may lead to:
o Delayed mobilisation
o Haemorrhage
o Wound dihescence
o A fatal chain of events
• Prophylaxis substantially reduces infection rates
Antibiotic regimens:
• There is usually a local preference
• Examples include:
o Biliary surgery:
• Broad spectrum penicillin (e.g. ampicillin 500mg
IV/8h for 3 doses), or
• Cephalosporin (e.g. cefuroxime IV/IM 1.5g/8h for 3
doses)
o Appendicectomy:
• A 3-dose regimen of metronidazole suppositories
(1g/8h) plus cefuroxime 1.5g/8h IV or gentamicin
IV
o Colorectal surgery:
• Cefuroxime 1.5g/8h IV/IM for 3 doses plus
metronidazole 500mg/8h IV for 3 doses
o Vascular surgery:
• Co-amoxiclav 1.2g IV on induction
• If penicillin-allergic, use cefuroxime 1.5g IV/IM plus
metronidazole 500mg IV
346
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Blood groups
The ABO and Rh systems are the 2 most important blood groups,
but incompatibilities involving many other blood groups (e.g. Kell,
Duffy, Kidd) may cause haemolytic transfusion reactions and/or
haemolytic disease of the newborn (HDN)
ABO system:
This blood group system involves naturally occurring IgM anti-A and
anti-B antibodies, which are capable of producing rapid and severe
intravascular haemolysis of incompatible RBCs
Rh system:
• There is a high frequency of development of IgG RhD
antibodies in RhD-negative individuals after exposure to RhD-
positive red cells
The antibodies formed are of major importance in causing HDN and
haemolytic transfusion reactions
347
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
348
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Immunological complications:
• Alloimmunisation (doesn’t cause problems with the first
transfusion)
• Incompatibility
• Haemolytic transfusion reactions:
o Immediate (usually due to ABO incompatibility):
• Rigors
• Lumbar pain
• Dyspnoea
• Hypotension
• Haemoglobinuria
• Renal failure
• DIC (disseminated intravascular coagulation)
o Delayed:
• Anaemia and jaundice ~1 week post-transfusion
• Non-haemolytic (febrile) transfusion reactions:
o Usually caused by leucocyte antibodies in the recipient’s
serum acting against transfused leucocytes, leading to
the release of pyrogens
• TRALI (transfusion-related acute lung injury):
o Is caused by potent leucocyte antibodies in the plasma
of donors (who are often multiparous women)
o Characterised by:
• Dyspnoea
• Fever
• Cough
• Shadowing in the perihilar and lower lung fields on
the CXR
• Anaphylaxis:
o Transfusion should be stopped
o Adrenaline 0.5mg IM
o Chlorpheniramine 10mg IV
o Endotracheal intubation may be required
Non-immunological complications:
• Transmission of infection (all rare):
o Hepatitis (<1 in 200,000 units in UK)
o HIV (<1 in 3,000,000 units in UK)
o Other viruses (e.g. CMV, EBV)
o Parasites (e.g. malaria, toxoplasmosis)
o Syphilis
• Circulatory failure due to volume overload
• Iron overload (multiple transfusions)
349
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Massive transfusion of stored blood may cause bleeding and
electrolyte changes
• Thrombophlebitis
• Air embolism
350
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Burns
Pathophysiology:
• Loss of integument and direct tissue injury lead to a
generalised fluid leak into the burn area
• This results in fluid loss and oedema formation
• Secondary problems include myocardial depression (which
usually recovers within 24 hours)
• There is also a degree of immunosuppression, with the major
late problem of infection
Assessment:
• The area of burn should be determined
• The method used is to assess the percentage of the total body
surface area which has been damaged and the depth of the
injury
• There are graphical charts available for this
Management:
• The rules of ABC (airway, breathing and circulation) apply
• The airway must be assessed and, if necessary, protected by
intubation
• Indications for endotracheal intubation include:
o Lung injury with hypoxia from inhalational burns
o Oedema (in the case of head and neck burns – can
develop rapidly and occlude the airway)
• There are massive fluid losses post-burn injury due to the
formation of oedema and loss of the cutaneous barrier
• Various formulae have been produced to guide fluid
management in the resuscitation, an example of which is the
Parkland formula using Ringer’s lactate solution:
351
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Volume (mL)/24h = 4 x weight (kg) x percentage of total body
surface area burnt
Specific treatment:
• Do NOT apply cold water to extensive burns – this may
intensify shock
• Do NOT burst blisters
• Covering extensive partial thickness burns with sterile linen
prior to transfer to a burns unit will deflect air currents and
relieve pain
• Use morphine in 1-2mg aliquots IV
• Suitable dressings (which should be changed every 1-2 days)
include:
o Vaseline gauze
o Silver sulfadiazine under absorbent gauze
• Ensure tetanus immunity
• Give 50ml whole blood for every 1% full-thickness burn, half
in the second 4h of IV therapy and half after 24h
352
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Body composition:
• In a 70kg male, body composition is approximately:
o Fat (15kg)
o Protein (12kg)
o Water (42kg)
o Glycogen and minerals (1kg)
Fluid compartments:
• Total body water (TBW) is divided into 2 main compartments:
o Extracellular fluid (ECF) – water around cells
o Intracellular fluid (ICF) – water in the cytoplasm
• The ECF is further subdivided into:
o Interstitial (15L)
o Intravascular (3L)
o Transcellular (1kg):
• Mainly GI secretions and glomerular filtration
• High turnover (12L/day for GI tract and 170L/day for
glomerular filtration)
353
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Response to injury and fluid balance:
• As part of the response to injury, the secretion rate of
cortisol, aldosterone and ADH increases in the first 24-48
hours leading to:
o A reduction in renal excretion of Na and, therefore,
water so that osmolality remains constant
o An increase in renal excretion of K, some of which is the
result of the amount of the tissue damage and
breakdown of cells
o Decreased renal water excretion with a urine of low
volume and high concentration, unresponsive to the
normal effect of any increase in water intake
• After this time, and depending on the degree of surgical
trauma and the presence or otherwise of sepsis, Na (and
water passively) retention may continue, with increased K
excretion
Fluid management:
• Water and electrolyte therapy are divided into maintenance
needs, restoration of pre-existing deficits and replacement of
ongoing losses
• Provision of maintenance requirements:
o Water – 100 ml/hr (adjusted upwards for fever and/or
high ambient temperature)
o Sodium – 75mmol/day (but can be further reduced over
the first 2 days)
o Potassium – 60mmol/day
• Replacement of pre-existing deficits:
o Loss of ECF fluid:
• Is combined loss of Na and water
• Replaced with fluids which have a Na content
close to that in the extracellular space
• E.g. normal saline, Hartmann’ solution
o Loss from the stomach:
• Although H+ is lost, renal compensation takes
place with H+ reabsorption increased and
excretion of K and bicarbonate are raised
• In consequence, hypochloraemic alkalosis and
hypokalaemia may develop
o Pure water loss:
• Occurs only when either access to water is
impossible (e.g. trapped patients after injury) or
there is a high obstruction to the GI tract (usually
oesophageal)
• Replacement is enteral if the obstruction can be
bypassed or by isotonic (6%) dextrose solution IV
354
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Replacement of ongoing losses:
o GI – Nasogastric aspiration, vomiting, fistulae and
diarrhoea
o Loss into an abnormal third space – usually the result of
inflammation (e.g. the retroperitoneal effusion that
occurs in pancreatitis)
The more distal in the intestine the source, the higher the K content
355
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Hernia
Definition:
• A hernia is a ‘protrusion of a viscus or other structure beyond
the normal coverings of the cavity in which it is contained or
between two adjacent cavities, such as the abdomen and the
thorax, or into a subcompartment of a cavity’
• The first category is commonly called external and the second
and third are internal
• The most frequent hernias are external ones of the abdominal
wall in the:
o Inguinal
o Femoral
o Umbilical, regions
Classification
• Hernias are best classified as congenital or acquired
• Congenital:
o There is a pre-formed sac which occurs as a
consequence of the ordered or disordered process of
intra-uterine development
o The patent processus vaginalis is a good example
• Acquired – are 2 types:
o Primary hernias – occur at natural weak points
o Secondary hernias – develop at sites of surgical or other
injury to the wall which normally constrains the
contents of a body cavity (usually the abdomen)
Aetiology:
• The 2 main factors predisposing to hernia are increased
intracavity pressure and a weakened abdominal wall
• Using the abdomen as an example:
o Increased intra-abdominal pressure:
• Heavy lifting
• Persistent cough (e.g. COAD)
• Straining to pass urine (e.g. BPH)
• Straining to pass faeces (>15% of men with large
bowel cancer present with an inguinal hernia)
• Abdominal distension (faeces, fat, flatus, fluid,
foetus)
• Weakened abdominal wall:
• Abnormal collagen metabolism
• Advancing age
• Malnutrition
• Damage to, or paralysis of, motor nerves
356
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Anatomical features:
• A hernia consists of:
o A sac
o Its coverings
o Its contents
• The sac comprises a:
o Mouth
o Neck
o Body
o Fundus
• The coverings of a hernia refer to the overlying layers which
are attenuated as the hernia emerges
• Working from the outermost layer inwards, these are as
follows:
o Skin
o Subcutaneous fat
o Aponeurosis
o Muscle
o Endo-cavity fascia
o Endothelial lining (peritoneum in the abdomen)
• The contents of hernias vary, but most intracavity viscera
have been reported
• In the abdomen, the commonest contents are the small bowel
and the greater omentum
• Other possibilities include:
o The large bowel and appendix
o Meckel’s diverticulum
o The bladder
o The ovary (with or without the fallopian tube)
o Ascetic fluid
Reducible hernia:
• The contents can be returned from whence they came, but
the sac persists
357
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• The contents do not necessarily reappear spontaneously, but
do so when assisted by gravity or raised intra-abdominal
pressure
Irreducible hernia:
• The contents cannot be returned to the body cavity in this
type of hernia
• The causes of irreducibility are:
o Narrow neck with rigid margins, often in association
with a capacious sac (e.g. femoral, umbilical)
o Adhesion formation between the contents and the sac
(usually long-standing hernias)
• Irreducible hernias have a greater risk of obstruction and
strangulation than do reducible ones
Obstructed hernia:
• Contains intestine in which the lumen has been occluded
• Obstruction is usually at the neck of the sac but may be
caused by adhesions within it
• If the obstruction is at both ends of the loop, fluid
accumulates within it and distension occurs (closed-loop
obstruction)
• Initially, the blood supply to the obstructed loop of bowel is
intact, but with time this becomes impeded and strangulation
supervenes
• The term ‘incarcerated’ is sometimes used to describe a
hernia that is irreducible but not strangulated. Thus, an
irreducible, obstructed hernia can also be called an
incarcerated one
Strangulated hernia:
• 10% of groin hernias present for the first time with
strangulation
• The blood supply to the contents of the hernia is cut off
• The pathological sequence is:
o Venous/lymphatic occlusion and oedema causing further
swelling
o Venous haemorrhage develops and a vicious circle is set
up, with swelling eventually impeding arterial inflow
o The tissues undergo ischaemic necrosis
• If the contents of the sac of an abdominal hernia are NOT
bowel (e.g. omentum) then the necrosis is sterile, but
strangulation of bowel is by far the most common and leads
to infected necrosis (gangrene):
o The mucosa sloughs
o Bowel wall becomes permeable to bacteria
358
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o The bacteria translocate through the wall and into the
sac and from there into the bloodstream and peritoneal
cavity (causing peritonitis)
o Septic shock ensues with circulatory failure and death
Inflamed hernia:
• The contents of the sac are inflamed by any process that
causes this in the tissue or organ that is not normally
herniated, e.g.:
o Acute appendicitis
o Meckel’s diverticulum
o Acute salpingitis
• It may be impossible to distinguish an inflamed hernia from
one that is strangulated
Surgical techniques:
• Herniotomy:
o Is the removal of the sac and closure of its neck
o It is the first step in nearly every hernia repair
• Herniorrhaphy – involves some sort of reconstruction to:
o Restore the anatomy if this is disturbed
o Increase the strength of the abdominal wall
o Construct a barrier to recurrence
Prognosis:
• Mortality:
o For elective repair, the overall mortality is <0.5%
o Increases with age to 0.5-1% for those over 60 years of
age
o For emergency operations, the mortality is 10x greater
o Mortality for strangulated hernia is ~20%
o Death is dependent on:
• Age
• Contents of the sac – gangrenous intestine
(present in 10% of strangulated hernias) is
associated with a 40% mortality rate
• Morbidity:
o The overall complication rate is ~7%
o Specific complications include:
• Persistent wound pain – often ascribed to a
neuroma which forms after damage to or division
of the ilio-inguinal or other nerve
• Cutaneous anaesthesia – division of a nerve
• Recurrent hernia
• The rate of recurrence is between 1-10% for primary hernias
and 5-30% for recurrent hernias
• Recurrence is associated with:
359
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Age
o Presence or absence of predisposing factors
o Site
o Size – the larger the hernia, the more likely it is to have
distorted the surrounding anatomy
o Emergency or elective operation – more likely to recur
with an emergency procedure
o Operation on a recurrent hernia – more difficult and
more likely to fail
o Experience of the surgeon
Inguinal hernia
Epidemiology:
• Account for 80% of all external abdominal hernias
• Most common in infants and the elderly
• Inguinal hernias are 20x more common in men than in women
• Occur most frequently on the right-hand side
Classification:
• Indirect inguinal hernia:
o This passes through the internal ring lateral to the
inferior epigastric artery and along the canal to emerge
at the external ring above the pubic crest and tubercle
o Its coverings are the attenuated layers of the cord
• Direct inguinal hernia:
o This hernia bulges out through the posterior wall of the
canal medial to the inferior epigastric artery
o Is, therefore, not covered by the layers of the cord
• Pantaloon hernia:
o This is a combination of both an indirect and a direct
inguinal hernia
Aetiology:
• Indirect hernia:
o There is a congenital sac or potential sac which is the
remnant of the processus vaginalis
o If the processus does not close, then an indirect hernia
occurs in early life, but other factors may lead to it
reopening at any age
o Indirect hernias are 20x more common in men than in
women
o 60% occur on the right side (possibly contributed to by
damage to the motor nerves of the abdominal muscles
at open appendicectomy)
o 40% on the left
o 20% are bilateral
360
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Direct hernia:
o This is an acquired lesion
o For reasons unknown, the posterior wall of the inguinal
canal becomes attenuated
o Direct hernia is, therefore, a condition of later life and is
rarely seen under the age of 40 years
Indirect Direct
Patient’s age Usually young Older
Cause May be congenital Acquired
Bilateral 20% 50%
Protrusion on coughing Oblique Straight
Appearance on standing Full size delay Full size
immediately
Reduction on lying Not immediate Immediate
Descent into scrotum Common Rare
Occlusion of internal ring Controls Does not
control
Neck of sac Narrow Wide
Strangulation Not uncommon Unusual
Relation to inferior Lateral Medial
epigastric vessels
Clinical findings:
• If it is impossible to get above a groin swelling, it is most
likely to be an inguinal hernia
• In addition to the features listed above, an indirect hernia that
extends beyond the external ring appears above and medial
to the pubic tubercle (in contrast to a femoral hernia, which is
below and lateral)
Management:
• Most adult inguinal hernias are repaired by open operation
under local or general anaesthesia as a day case procedure
• Open operation usually means:
o A layered suture technique (Shouldice), or
361
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Insertion of a non-absorbable prosthetic mesh
(Lichtenstein)
• Alternatively, mesh repair may be done laparoscopically
Specific complications:
• Urinary retention:
o Because of the proximity of the inguinal region to urine
excretion in the male, temporary problems may be
encountered
o Rare with modern techniques (unless BPH has been
overlooked in the preoperative evaluation)
• Scrotal haematoma:
o May follow extensive dissection
• Damage to the ilio-inguinal nerve:
o Produces an area of anaesthesia over the:
• Pubic tubercle
• Scrotum/labia
Outcome:
• Recurrence rates for groin hernias should be <1%
• It is more widely quoted as 3% for primary hernias and up to
30% in the management of recurrence
Management of recurrence:
• Recurrent inguinal hernias should be repaired in order to
avoid the same complications that occur in primary hernias,
which are even more likely when recurrence has taken place
• Because of scarring, the dissection can be difficult and, in the
male, orchidectomy is sometimes performed to allow closure
of the deep ring
362
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Femoral hernia
Overview:
• Femoral hernias are acquired downward protrusions of
peritoneum into the potential space of the femoral canal
• 33% of groin hernias in women and 5% in men
• Rare in children
• 20% are bilateral
History:
• Patient is typically a middle-aged or elderly female, often of
thin build
• Intermittent lump in the groin
• However, a major problem is that she may not have noticed
the lump and the first clinical presentation is with
strangulation (which occurs in 20%)
Signs:
• In a small hernia, a cough impulse is rare
• A larger hernia may be seen to bulge on straining just below
the medial part of the inguinal ligament
• An irreducible hernia is a lump whose consistency varies
according to its contents, which may straddle the inguinal
ligament
• In consequence, it can be difficult to distinguish from an
inguinal hernia; although the upper medial border of a
femoral hernia is always below and lateral to the pubic
tubercle
Strangulation:
• In contrast to a strangulated inguinal hernia, in a strangulated
femoral hernia, there are often no localising symptoms and
signs and the lump is often small, unimpressive and
overlooked by the patient
• The classic presentation is that of small bowel obstruction
• It is not unheard of for a femoral hernia to only be diagnosed
after gut perforation with spreading peritonitis
Management:
• All femoral hernias should be repaired without delay because
of their great risk of strangulation
• In elective operations, repair is usually by direct incision over
the hernia, excision of the sac and sutured closure of the
femoral canal
• For operation on a patient with obstruction or strangulation, it
may be necessary to open the abdomen to find the segment
363
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
of gut that has been trapped, should it reduce before it can be
dealt with
364
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Criteria:
• It is very difficult to have set rules for who should be admitted
and who should not as patients in ITU are such a
heterogeneous group
• There are, however, some common criteria:
o Shock (systolic BP <90mmHg or 40mmHg fall from
baseline) not responding to therapy
o Respiratory failure:
• Type I - PaO2 <8kPa and PaO2 <6kPa
• Type II - PaO2 <8kPa and PaO2 >6kPa
o Severe acidosis (pH <7.25, BE<-8)
o Exhaustion, drowsiness or coma
o Respiratory arrest
365
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Surgical intervention almost always causes pain
• As it can have serious physiological and psychological
consequences, prevention is best, but if that cannot be
completely achieved, rapid and adequate relief is essential
• The intensity of postoperative pain that is perceived by the
patient is influenced by:
o Cultural and family background, upbringing, personality,
constitution, past experiences and motivation
o Amount of information provided preoperatively – the
more the better is a good guide
o Psychological factors which are often situation-specific,
such as emotional arousal and fear; a calm reassuring
attitude from the team is of great value and is helped
by close interpersonal relations with the patient
o Preoperative and postoperative support provided by the
whole team, which includes nurses and physiotherapists
Management:
• Management has increasingly become a specialised province
of either the anaesthetist or a pain management team
Prevention:
• A caring, sympathetic and informative approach by the team
does much to reduce the patient’s perception of pain, as does
assurance that any pain felt will be relieved at once
• Physical methods for preventing pain include:
o Gentle surgical technique with minimal tissue damage
o Adequate immobilisation of areas that have been
operated when this is possible – limbs in particular and
after orthopaedic procedures
366
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Blockade of nerve impulses which may be achieved at a
number of sites on the afferent pathway
Therapy:
• All agents are better given on a regular basis rather than
withheld until relief is asked for
• NSAIDs, aspirin and Paracetamol:
o Are often sufficient for mild postoperative pain provided
the patient can swallow
• Narcotic (opioid) analgesics:
o Have long been the main agents used to counteract
postoperative pain
o Morphine sulphate remains the drug most widely used
o Immediately after the operation, they are given by the
parenteral route (IM or IV)
o It is now common for continuous infusion to be used so
that saturation of the opioid receptors in the brain is
achieved
367
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Definition:
• Infection of the respiratory tract includes a wide range of
conditions:
o Bronchitis
o Pneumonia
o Lung abscess
o Empyema
• An element of alveolar under-expansion after operation is
common – this can cause mild pyrexia
Organisms:
• Pneumococcus
• Haemophilus influenzae
• Gram (–ve) organisms can also be found in postoperative
chest infections
Symptoms:
• Fever
• Cough
• Breathlessness
• Confusion (from hypoxia)
Signs:
• Cyanosis
• Green sputum
• Consolidation on chest examination
Investigation:
• CXR
• Culture (sputum or bronchial washings)
• ABG
Management:
• Prophylaxis:
o Do not undertake elective surgical procedures in the
presence of uncontrolled respiratory infection
o In the postoperative period, provide adequate
postoperative analgesia, physiotherapy and early
mobilisation
• Treatment:
o Initial administration of oxygen with the aim of restoring
normal blood gas tensions
• Antibiotic administration:
368
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o A combination of penicillin and erythromycin is a
common first-line treatment which can be altered on the
outcome of sputum culture
o Drainage of focal collections (e.g. purulent pleural
effusion or an empyema)
369
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Haemorrhage:
• Major postoperative haemorrhage can be recognised by:
• Evidence of overt bleeding including heavily bloodstained fluid
from a drain
• Cold and wet (clammy) peripheries
• Distension after abdominal procedures
• Usually, the diagnosis is self-evident but occasionally it may
not be apparent that major bleeding has occurred, particularly
if the patient is obese or if the drain malfunctions because of
obstruction by clot
• In such circumstances the diagnosis may need to be
confirmed by urgent, repeated Hb estimation and by US
examination
• Management:
o The loss is stopped by control of the source of bleeding
or by correction or coagulopathy
o Either at the same time or immediately subsequently,
transfusion corrects the deficit
o Re-operation may be required to control a bleeding
point
370
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Hypotension
o Tachycardia
o Warm periphery
• Management:
o Resuscitation is with IV fluids and IV antibiotics
o Re-exploration may be indicated to deal with a septic
focus or a technical failure
Hypersensitivity reactions:
• This may develop as an immune response to a blood infusion
or to drug administration (e.g. IV antibiotic)
• There is usually pyrexia and the circulatory collapse may also
be accompanied by respiratory distress and urticaria
• Management:
o Discontinue the drug/infusion
o IV corticosteroids
o Circulatory support
371
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Postoperative monitoring
372
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
373
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pressure sores
(decubitus ulcers)
Overview:
• These occur in the:
o Elderly
o Immobile
o Unconscious
o Paralysed
• They are due to skin ischaemia from sustained pressure over
a bony joint, most commonly the heel and sacrum
• Normal individuals feel the pain of continued pressure and,
even during sleep, movement takes place to change posture
continually
• 70% of pressure sores occur in hospital
• 70% appear in the first 2 weeks of hospitalisation
• 70% are in orthopaedic patients (especially those on traction)
• 80% of patients with deep ulcers involving the subcutaneous
tissue die in the first 4 months
• Altered sensation of the skin increases the risk of ulceration,
and patients with diseases that affect the circulation and
tissue nutrition are also predisposed, e.g.:
o Rheumatoid arthritis
o Diabetes mellitus
o Peripheral vascular disease
• General illness, anaemia, malnutrition and oedema may affect
skin breakdown
• Other predisposing factors include:
o Anaesthesia
o Surgery
o Sedation
o Dehydration
o Urinary incontinence
o Faecal impaction
• The early sign of red/blue discolouration of the skin can lead
rapidly to ulcers in 1-2 hours
• Leaving patients on hard A&E trolleys, or sitting them in
chairs for prolonged periods, must be avoided
Management:
• General measures should include identifying at-risk patients
• Those with non-fading marking of the skin on pressure sites
need immediate attention
• The following are used in management:
o Bedrest with pillow to keep pressure off bony areas
(e.g. pelvis and heels)
374
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Regular turning, but avoid pressure on hips
o Fleece over lower 1/3 of bed for heels
o Roto cushions for patients in wheelchairs
o Treatment of general circulation
o Special mattresses and beds to relieve pressure areas
o Topical treatment:
• Keep ulcer clean and moist
• Many topical therapies are HARMFUL
o Pain relief (may need diamorphine)
o Plastic surgery
375
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Blood grouping:
• The ABO and RhD groups of the patient are determined
Antibody screening:
• The patient’s serum is screened for atypical antibodies that
may cause a significant reduction in the survival of the
transfused RBCs
• The patient’s serum is tested against RBCs from at least 2
group O donors, expressing a wide range of RBC antigens, for
detection of IgM RBC alloantibodies and IgG antibodies
• If there is a positive result, the blood group specificity of the
antibody should be determined using a comprehensive panel
of typed RBCs
Cross-matching procedures:
• Patients without atypical RBC antibodies:
o The full cross-match involves testing the patient’s
serum against the donor RBCs suspended in saline in a
direct agglutination test, and also using an indirect
antiglobulin test
• Patients with atypical RBC antibodies:
o Donor blood should be selected that lacks the relevant
RBC antigen(s), as well as being the same ABO and RhD
group as the patient
o A full cross-match should always be carried out
376
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Scrotal swellings
Clinical examination:
• The following points enable distinctions to be made:
o If it is possible to get above the swelling and palpate a
normal cord, the swelling is NOT a hernia
o If there is a cough impulse in the groin or, with the
patient lying flat, the scrotal mass disappears or is
reducible, the swelling is a hernia
o If the testicle lies anteriorly and the epididymis
posteriorly, gentle palpation establishes where the
swelling lies and therefore its origin
o Hydroceles transilluminate
o Varicoceles are more apparent with the patient standing
and feel like a bag of worms
Testicular tumours
Pathological features:
• Classification of germ cell tumours is as follows:
o Seminoma
o Teratoma
o Mixed:
• These consist of both seminomatous and
teratomatous elements, but should be treated as
teratomas
377
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Teratomas of the testis:
o Differentiated – teratoma differentiated (TD)
o Intermediate – malignant teratoma intermediate (MTI)
o Undifferentiated – malignant teratoma undifferentiated
(MTU)
o Trophoblastic – malignant teratoma trophoblastic (MTT)
Symptoms:
• 10% give a history of previous orchidopexy and in 5% the
tumour is bilateral
• Often a recent history of trauma (is not a cause but merely
draws the patient’s attention to the presence of a lump)
• Painless swelling which causes a dragging sensation in the
scrotum
• In 30%, the swelling is painful
• Patients with choriocarcinoma may develop gynaecomastia
• Others present with symptoms from secondary deposits such
as:
o Backache
o Haemoptysis
o Neurological complaints
Signs:
• A hard lump in the body of the testis
• Diffuse testicular enlargement
• Absence of tenderness on gently squeezing the testicle
• Hydrocele
Investigation:
• Tumour markers:
o α-fetoprotein (AFP)
o ß-human chorionic gonadotrophin (ß-HCG)
o LDH
o Placental ALP (seminomas)
• Ultrasound:
o Helpful for determining the nature of the mass if this is
not possible clinically
o The normal testis has a homogeneous appearance
o Malignant tumours are inhomogeneous, may be cystic
and are often associated with speckled calcification
378
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Staging:
Stage Findings
I Tumour limited to testis
II Tumour of testis and retro-peritoneal lymph nodes
III Involvement of infra- and supra-diaphragmatic lymph
nodes
IV Extra-lymphatic metastases
Management:
• Improvements in therapy mean that the majority of testicular
tumours should be regarded as curable
• Surgery:
o Orchidectomy is done through a groin incision
(operations through the scrotum have a high incidence
of tumour implantation)
o In order to reduce the risk of disseminating malignant
cells by manipulation of the testis, the cord is mobilised
and occluded with a non-crushing intestinal clamp
before the testis is delivered from the scrotum
o In men with a small or atrophic contralateral testis, or a
history of subfertility, a biopsy from the contralateral
testis should be taken:
• Up to 5% of men will have carcinoma in situ
involving the other testis
• Supplementary management:
o If chemotherapy is to be used, the patient should be
advised to store semen prior to the chemotherapy
o Patients with testicular tumours are often subfertile and
chemotherapy may result in irreversible germ cell
damage
379
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Prognosis:
• Stage I – 100% of patients survive
• Stage II/III – 5-year survival is between 80-90%
• Seminoma:
o For a tumour localised to the testis, >95% of patients
should survive 5 years
o For those who present with metastatic disease, the 5-
year survival is ~75%
• Non-seminomatous germ-cell tumours:
o For those with a tumour confined to the testis and low
tumour markers, 90% survive 5 years
o If the tumour markers are grossly elevated and
metastases are confined only to the lungs, 80% survive
5 years
o If there are visceral metastases and grossly elevated
tumour markers, the 5-year survival falls to 45%
These may be single or multiple and are usually related to the head
of the epididymis
Management:
• Asymptomatic cysts do not require treatment
• If they cause discomfort, simple aspiration is often
satisfactory:
o Spermatoceles – turbid milky fluid
o Epididymal cysts – lemon barley coloured fluid
o Should recurrence occur after aspiration, surgical
excision is required
Varicocele
380
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• There is a dragging sensation in the scrotum which is worse
in hot weather and on prolonged standing
• Subfertility may be mentioned
• Physical examination reveals the ‘bag of worms’ which
becomes more obvious if the patient stands
• A cough impulse is present in the same position
• The left testicle may be smaller than the right
Management:
• Treatment is required for those with symptoms and for those
with subfertility
• The procedure of choice is embolisation of the testicular vein
under radiological control
Hydrocele
Aetiology:
• May be congenital or acquired
• Congenital:
o Follow failure of obliteration of the processus vaginalis
o Peritoneal fluid can then enter the scrotum
• Acquired:
o The great majority are of unknown origin
o 10% are associated with testicular tumour or infection
Clinical features:
• A infant presents with a large scrotal sac and the hydrocele is
easily demonstrated by transillumination
• In adult life, there is a firm, painless transilluminable swelling
which it is possible to get above
Management:
• Congenital:
o Majority resolve by the age of 3 years
o Persistence beyond this time requires operative
treatment by division and ligation of the processus
• Acquired:
o Aspiration is first done to allow examination of the
testicle for any underlying cause
o Sometimes this is therapeutic and the hydrocele does
not recur
o If it does, surgical excision of the outer wall of the
hydrocele is required
381
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Wound healing
Inflammatory phase:
• Bleeding followed by clotting and then clot lysis
• Inflammatory cytokine release with:
o Cell swelling
o Increased capillary permeability
o Intercellular oedema
o Migration of leucocytes into the damaged area
• Phagocytosis (by macrophages) of dead cells and other debris
• The inflammatory phase lasts ~3 days
Reparative phase:
• Formation of new capillary loops in the damaged area. These
provide a blood supply for subsequent events
• Fibroblasts appear:
o These are capable of producing strands of collagen.
• Deposition of extracellular collagen – at first provisional and
apparently untidy but gradually becoming orientated along
any lines of stress applied to the wound
• This mass of granulation tissue begins to contract (probably
through the effects of specialised myofibroblasts)
• A distinction is drawn between this active process of
contraction of the whole wound mass and the later shrinkage
of mature collagen, which may lead to distortion of a healed
area – known by the general term contracture
Consolidative phase:
• Collagen synthesis = degradation (both accelerated)
• Ratio of collagen reverts back to normal
• Increased cross-linkage of collagen
• Increased tensile strength (maximum 80%)
• Vascularity of the wound gradually decreases
Collagen:
• Are >14 types
• Ratio of type I: type III
o 4:1 in normal skin
o 2:1 in granulation tissue
382
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Local factors inhibiting wound healing:
• Infection
• Ischaemia
• Foreign bodies
• Tumour
383
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Wound management
Haemorrhage
Overview:
• A dry wound (i.e. one with minimal oozing) is an essential
prerequisite for successful closure to achieve the best result
with minimal formation of fibrous tissue
• Failure to achieve adequate control of bleeding:
o Keeps the wound edges apart and thus requires a larger
gap to be bridged, which leads to a greater deposition
of fibrous tissue
o May result in a haematoma:
• An accumulation of clot which is lysed and may
require release before the wound edges can be
opposed
o May lead to infection:
• A haematoma is an ideal place in which bacteria can
multiply
• The 3 main techniques used to stop bleeding are:
o Compression
o Ligation
o Thermal coagulation
Compression:
• Packing a bleeding cavity or applying pressure to a bleeding
area are both particularly useful if there is widespread oozing
• 5 minutes of compression allows normal haemostasis to take
place by:
o Contraction of the mouths of small vessels
o Platelet aggregation
o Clotting
• However, these processes must be normal for the effective
arrest of bleeding
Ligation:
• The mouth of the divided vessel which bleeding is picked up
with special forceps (haemostats) and tied off with a ligature
(either absorbable or non-absorbable)
• Absorbable sutures:
o Have a clear advantage in that, once the vessel has
been occluded and has thrombosed behind the point of
ligature, the suture ultimately disappears so that the
foreign body reaction is minimal
384
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o However, they may degrade too fast, especially in the
presence of sepsis and, in consequence, secondary
haemorrhage may occur
• For this reason, large vessels are more often ligated with non-
absorbables, which may be braided for easy handling
• Blood vessels and other small tubes (e.g. the cystic duct) may
also be closed with stainless steel clips carried on a special
forceps
• Larger vessels may be transected using vascular stapling
instruments
Thermal coagulation:
• This involves the use of diathermy (or cautery in the USA)
• Is a high-frequency electric current
• The pathway of current is either:
o Unipolar (from the point of application through the body
of the patient to a large area contact plate and thence
to earth )
o Bipolar (between 2 points of the instrument)
• Small blood vessels can be precisely dealt with using either
technique and the method is also used for cutting soft tissues
with minimal bleeding when a continuous waveform is
produced and an arc is generated between the electrode and
the tissue
• Vaporisation of the water in the cells occurs with disruption of
tissue continuity (so-called cutting diathermy)
Infection
Wound classes:
• There are 4 classes:
o Incised – of recent origin without significant
contamination
o Lacerated – of recent origin, with tissue damage and/or
contamination
o Late – 6-18 hours after injury
o Infected – wounds seen beyond 18-24 hours. Must be
regarded as infected
385
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• In surgical incisions:
o Debridement is unnecessary
o Delayed closure is sometimes useful if there is
contamination at operation
• Many wounds can be assumed to be contaminated the
moment they are sustained (e.g. when the abdomen is
opened to deal with an intraperitoneal infection):
o In the early part of the preparative phase (when
bacterial proliferation is just beginning) it may be
possible to eliminate these organisms by establishing a
high concentration of antibiotic in the tissues by
parenteral administration
o This prophylactic use of antibiotics over a short period
of time is now common in many circumstances
386
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
GI Surgery
387
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute appendicitis
Epidemiology:
• Most common surgical emergency
• Lifetime incidence of 6%
Pathogenesis:
• Gut organisms invade the appendix wall after lumen
obstruction by:
1. Lymphoid hyperplasia
2. Faecalith (a small, hard mass of faeces)
3. Filarial worms
• There may be impaired ability to prevent invasion, brought
about by improved hygiene (so less exposure to gut
pathogens), the so called ‘hygiene hypothesis’
Symptoms:
• As inflammation begins – central abdominal colic
• Once peritoneum inflamed – pain shifts to RIF and becomes
more constant
• Anorexia
• Constipation
• Vomiting (occasionally)
• Diarrhoea (occasionally)
Signs:
• Tachycardia
• Pyrexia (37.5˚-38.5˚)
• Shallow breathing
• Furred tongue
• Coughing hurts
• Lying still
Signs in RIF:
• Tenderness
• Guarding
• Rebound tenderness
• Painful PR on right
388
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Perforated ulcer
• Crohn’s disease
• Cystitis
Management:
• Prompt appendicectomy
• 3 doses IV A/Bs starting 1 hr pre-op decreases wound
infections (Metronidazole 1g/8h + Cefuroxime 1.5g/8h)
Complications:
• Perforation leading to peritonitis (with later infertility in girls)
• Appendix mass (inflamed appendix surrounded by omentum)
• Appendix abscess
Appendicitis in pregnancy:
• 1 in 2000 pregnancies
• Pain/tenderness is higher due to displacement of appendix by
uterus
• Appendicectomy is well tolerated but foetal mortality
approaches 30% after perforation
389
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute cholangitis
Aetiopathogenesis:
• Organisms enter the biliary tree either from the GI tract via
the duodenal papilla or by excretion in the bile after reaching
the liver via the bloodstream.
• In the bile, these organisms multiply in the presence of an
obstruction to cause inflammation
• In the Western world, the most common cause of this
obstruction is a common bile duct stone(s)
• Infected bile in the biliary tree is potentially fatal because it
may lead to septicaemia and hepatorenal failure.
• Long-term sequelae of repeated attacks of cholangitis include:
o Liver abscesses
o Secondary biliary cirrhosis
o Liver failure
o Portal hypertension
Clinical features:
• Charcot’s triad:
o Abdominal pain
o High fever with rigors
o Jaundice
• Past history of biliary disease may be obtained
• The liver may be somewhat enlarged and tender
Investigation:
• Full blood count:
o Leucocytosis
• LFTs:
o Cholestasis (raised ALP)
• Blood cultures:
o Positive in most instances
• Ultrasound:
o Gallbladder stones
o Dilated duct
o Ductal stone (occasionally)
Management:
• Resuscitation with IV fluids and parenteral A/Bs are begun on
a best guess basis
• A prompt response will result in:
o Relief of symptoms
o Resolution of fever
o Rapid reduction in jaundice
390
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Failure to achieve this indicates the need for bile duct
drainage by urgent ERCP
• If possible, stones should be extracted, but effective biliary
drainage is the first essential requirement
• Treatment of cholelithiasis can be deferred until the acute
episode has settled
391
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute cholecystitis
Clinical features:
• The symptoms are similar to biliary colic but:
o Pain is more severe and persistent
o Nausea/vomiting
o Fever
o Tenderness/guarding in the RUQ
o Murphy’s sign:
• Lay a hand lightly on the upper right abdomen and
ask the patient to take a deep breath in
• A positive sign will be revealed by the pt ‘catching
their breath’ caused by the inflamed gallbladder
impacting on the examining hand
Investigations:
• Blood tests:
o Leucocytosis
o Raised Bilirubin
o Moderately elevated serum amylase
• Imaging:
o Ultrasound shows an enlarged gallbladder with:
• Stone(s)
• Thickened wall
• Surrounding rim of fluid from local oedema
Management:
• Conservative (the initial treatment):
o Analgesia
o Systemic A/Bs
o IV fluids
• Operative (if conservative treatment fails):
o Cholecystectomy is curative and must be performed if
initial treatment fails to work due to the risk of
perforation or the formation of an empyema
Perforation:
• This is caused by a progressive rise in tension in the
gallbladder
• The blood supply of the wall becomes reduced and gangrene
occurs (usually at the fundus)
• Abdominal pain becomes increasingly severe and more
generalised
• Perforation may lead to diffuse peritonitis
• A variant is local perforation with abscess formation
392
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Empyema and pericholecystic abscess:
• The infection remains localised, with the accumulation of pus
within the gallbladder.
• Swinging fever
• Tachycardia
• Tender mass in the RUQ
393
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Acute peritonitis
Localized peritonitis:
• There is virtually always some degree of localized peritonitis
with all acute inflammatory conditions of the GI tract
• Pain and tenderness are largely features of this localized
peritonitis
• Rx is of the underlying disease
General peritonitis:
• Serious condition resulting from irritation of the peritoneum
• Caused by:
o Infection (e.g. perforated appendix)
o Chemical irritation due to leakage of intestinal contents
(e.g. perforated ulcer)
• The peritoneal cavity becomes acutely inflamed with
production of an inflammatory exudate that spreads
throughout the peritoneum leading to intestinal dilatation and
paralytic ileus.
Clinical features:
• When the peritonitis is due to perforation:
o Sudden onset
o General collapse
o Shock
o Pt may improve temporarily, only to deteriorate later as
generalized toxaemia develops
• When the peritonitis is secondary to inflammatory disease:
o Onset is less rapid
o Initial features being that of the underlying disease
Investigations:
• Erect CXR (to detect free air under the diaphragm)
• Serum amylase (to diagnose acute pancreatitis)
• US or CT is becoming popular for diagnosis
Management:
• Peritonitis is always treatment surgically after adequate
resuscitation with the re-establishment of a good urinary
output
• Insertion of a NG tube
• IV fluids
• A/Bs
394
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Surgical management:
• Is two-fold:
o Peritoneal lavage of the abdominal cavity
o Specific treatment if the underlying condition
Complications:
• Delays in treatment produces more profound toxaemia and
septicaemia
• Local abscess formation can occur and should be suspected if
the pt continues to remain unwell post-op with a:
• Swinging fever
• High WCC
• Continuing pain
• Abscesses are typically pelvic or subphrenic:
o Treatment is with drainage and A/Bs
395
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Benign
Epidemiology:
• Up to 10% of the Western world’s population may have a
benign tumour(s)
Pathological features:
• Adenomas are the most common and important benign large
bowel neoplasms.
• Arise from glandular or epithelial cells
• The tumour is most often a polyp with a stalk but flat (sessile)
lesions also occur
• May be single or multiple (and in the polyposis syndromes,
hundreds may be present)
Clinical features:
• Most adenomas are asymptomatic and devoid of signs
• Diagnosis is usually made either as the result of a screening
programme or on incidental examination of the large bowel by
colonoscopy or Barium enema
Management:
The finding of an adenomatous polyp (particularly if > 1cm)
requires the following action:
• Complete examination of the large bowel by colonoscopy to
exclude or identify other similar neoplasms
• Removal of all lesions (usually endoscopically)
396
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Regular lifelong surveillance for recurrence and/or
development of large bowel cancer
Malignant
Epidemiology:
• Second most common malignancy (behind ca bronchus)
• Peak age incidence is in those > 60yrs
Aetiological factors:
• Diet:
o Bile salt conversion:
• It is believed that a diet rich in animal fat is a major
risk factor
• Such a diet (common in the Western world)
produces an environment within the gut which
favours the bacterial conversion of bile salts to
carcinogens
o Low intake of fibre:
• This slows down gut transit time and, therefore,
increases the time of exposure of the mucosa to
carcinogens
• Adenomatous polyps
• Genetic factors:
o FAP is an inevitable cause of cancer
o 2-3x increased risk to a first-degree relative of a pt with
adenocarcinoma
o This hereditary non-polyposis colon cancer (HNPCC)
probably accounts for ~10% of colon malignancies
• Inflammatory bowel disease (CD and UC)
Pathological features:
• Distribution:
o Rectum 57%
o Sigmoid colon 21%
• Synchronous lesions:
o Up to 3% of pts have one or more synchronous cancers
o 75% of pts have a benign adenoma
• Macroscopic classification:
o Polypoid
o Ulcerative
o Annular
o Combination of the above
• Spread:
o Direct extension
397
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Lymphatic (largely upwards to the aorta and portal
vein)
o Haematogenous (mainly to liver)
o Transcoelomic (can lead to ascites)
o Direct implantation (iatrogenic)
Clinical features:
• Alteration in bowel habit
• Rectal bleeding
• Weight loss
• Abdominal pain
• Malaise
• Tenesmus
398
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features – rectal tumours:
• Rectal bleeding (usually on defaecation)
• Tenesmus
• A growth that has spread locally may cause:
o Faecal incontinence from invasion of the anal sphincters
o Back pain because of involvement of the sacral plexus
o UTIs, retrovesical fistula or renal failure through
infiltration of the renal tract
Investigation:
• PR exam
• Sigmoidoscopy:
o Biopsy of any mucosal abnormality
• Barium enema (if colonoscopy is unavailable)
• Colonoscopy
• Assessment of extent of disease and of spread:
o Carcinoembryonic antigen (CEA) is a useful marker of
the elimination of disease and the emergence of
recurrence
o CT scan
399
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Damage to sexual function
• Damage to duodenum (right hemi-colectomy)
• Damage to spleen (left hemi-colectomy)
• Anastomotic complications (stenosis/leakage)
• Complications of stoma
• Diarrhoea/constipation
Adjuvant therapy:
• Radiation:
o Pts with Duke’s B and C rectal carcinoma should receive
local deep X-Ray therapy
• Chemotherapy:
o Although solid-tumours such as colorectal cancers are
not very sensitive to chemotherapy, there is evidence
that results can be improved in Duke’s B and C by the
use of chemotherapy with 5-fluouracil
400
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Biliary colic
Clinical features:
• Waves of pain in the epigastrium and right upper quadrant
• Pain radiates through to the back, in the region of the inferior
angle of the scapula
• Attacks of pain last for between 15mins to 7hrs
• Pain is often exacerbated by ingestion of fatty foods (as these
stimulate the release of CCK, which causes gallbladder
contraction)
• Vomiting is common
Investigations:
• Plain X-Ray:
o Reveals only 10% of gallstones (the remainder have
insufficient radio-density)
• Ultrasound:
o Detects 98% of gallbladder stones
o Less reliable at detecting stones within the bile ducts
o Provides additional information on:
• Thickness of the gallbladder wall
• Diameter of the common bile duct
• Architecture of the liver and pancreas
Management:
• Parenteral analgesics (e.g. Morphine, Pethidine) to relieve the
acute exacerbations of pain
• Condition nearly always resolves over the course of a few
hours
• If the diagnosis is confirmed by imaging, subsequent
cholecystectomy is usually indicated
401
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Far East >> West
• In Europe 2-8 per 100,000 population
Aetiology:
• Squamous cell carcinoma (55%) – 40% in middle 1/3, 15% in
upper 1/3:
• Diet is probably of the most importance:
o High intake of nitrosamines derived from nitrates used
in food preservatives
o Low intake of both vitamin A and nicotinic acid
o Fe deficiency anaemia
• Adenocarcinoma (45%) – occurs in the lower 1/3:
o Metaplastic change in the oesophageal mucosa from
Squamous to columnar epithelium as a result of reflux
(Barrett’s oesophagus) predisposes to the development
of adenocarcinoma
Pathological features:
• Nearly all lesions are a combination of narrowing and
ulceration, although the extent of each varies
• Spread takes place by:
o Direct invasion:
• Into adjacent structures such as:
• Trachea
• Bronchi
• Pericardium
• Chest wall
• Diaphragm
• Once a fistula into the air passages has occurred, the
condition is incurable and the life expectancy is short
o Submucosal infiltration
o Lymph node involvement:
• In the mediastinum and, in distal lesion, around the
stomach
• Upward spread in the mediastinum may produce a
sentinel node in the supraclavicular fossa
o The bloodstream:
• Unusual in the early stages
• By the time of death, 90% of pts may have distant
metastases (liver, lung and brain)
Symptoms:
• Early ill-defined symptoms:
o Feeling of an oesophageal obstruction
402
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Retrosternal discomfort
o Belching
o Dyspepsia
• Progressive dysphasia:
o Most common and important presenting symptom
o At first there is dysphagia for solids only, only later is
there difficulty with liquids
• Weight loss
• Acute obstruction:
o Usually precipitated by the impaction of a large (usually
inadequately chewed) bolus of food
• Hoarseness:
o Caused by the involvement of the recurrent laryngeal
nerve
Signs:
• Lymphadenopathy (25%) – usually of the supraclavicular
region
• Is an indication of metastatic disease
Investigations:
• Barium swallow:
o Preferred first-line ix
o High sensitivity in the diagnosis of a stricture (although
this does not, necessarily, mean that it is malignant)
o Accurate determination of the anatomical site
o Simple
o Cheap
• Endoscopy:
o This is done under LA and allows:
• Biopsy and brush cytology
• Partial assessment of the extent of the lesion
• Concurrent dilatation and temporary relief of
obstruction
• However there are some dangers, such as:
• Failure to detect a small lesion
• Perforation of a growth
• Ultrasound:
o May demonstrate liver metastases and/or enlarged
lymph nodes
• CT:
o Helpful in determining the size of the primary tumour
and whether it is attached to surrounding structures
o To detect metastases
403
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Surgical resection:
• In the overwhelming no. of cases, surgical intervention is
purely palliative (e.g. to relieve dysphagia)
• There are two main procedures available for resecting
tumours of the oesophagus that do not require a thoracotomy
• These are described below
• Trans-hiatal removal:
o The abdomen alone is opened and the oesophagus freed
in the chest by blunt dissection through the
diaphragmatic hiatus
o Stomach or colon for reconstruction is then passed
through the posterior mediastinum to the neck, where it
is anastomosed to the upper oesophagus through a
cervical incision
• Endoscopic removal:
o The whole procedure can now be done endoscopically
by dissection within the chest (thoracoscopy) and
abdomen (laparoscopy), although there is no evidence
that this method is better than an open operation.
Prognosis:
• When tumour is confined to the mucosa – 5yr survival of 60%
• If tumour has penetrated the full thickness of the gullet – 5yr
survival is < 5%
404
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Fourth leading cause of death from cancer in the Western
world
• In the UK ~ 5000 deaths per year
• Peak incidence is 50-70 yrs (although it occasionally occurs in
those as young as 30 yrs)
Aetiology:
• Putative factors in exocrine pancreatic cancer:
o ‘Western’ lifestyle
o Cigarette smoking (perhaps due to nitrosamine
inhalation)
o High-fat diet
o Working in chemical industries:
• Beta-naphthylamines
• Benzidine
• Petroleum
• Dry cleaning
• Nuclear fuels
• Coke and coal gas
• Men >> women (2 : 1)
Pathological features:
• 95% of tumours are adenocarcinomas, originating from the
pancreatic ducts
• 70% of tumours occur in the pancreatic head
• Spread of the tumour is by four typical routes:
o Direct invasion
o Lymphatic
o Haematogenous
o Transcoelomic
• Direct invasion:
o Cancers arising from the pancreatic head invade and
obstruct the lower end of the common bile duct to
produce extra-hepatic obstructive jaundice
o The development of obstruction causes the biliary tree
to dilate
o Of those pts with a tumour of the head of the pancreas,
15-20% have direct invasion of the duodenum, resulting
in gastric outflow obstruction and vomiting
• Lymphatic:
o The most common nodes involved are the:
• Pre-aortic coeliac nodes
• Nodes of the porta-hepatis
405
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Haematogenous:
o The tumour drains into the portal vein and liver
metastases are most common
• Transcoelomic:
o Spread across the peritoneal cavity resulting in:
• Peritoneal seedlings
• Ascites
Clinical features:
• Obstructive jaundice
• Pruritus
• Weight loss
• Epigastric pain, which radiates through to the back and can
sometimes be alleviated by sitting crouched forward
• Recent dx of diabetes mellitus
• Vomiting (if duodenal invasion has occurred – a sign of
advanced disease)
Signs:
• Virchow’s node (a palpable, hard, left supraclavicular lymph
node)
• Abdominal distension
• Ascites
• A palpable, enlarged, gallbladder
• A palpable mass in the epigastrium which characteristically
transmits aortic pulsation
Differential diagnosis:
• Choledocholithiasis
• Malignant compression of the bile duct by metastases in
portal lymph nodes
• Drug-induced cholestatic jaundice
• A carcinoma of the duodenum or papilla at the lower end of
the common bile duct
• Carcinoma of the bile duct
• Mirizzi’s syndrome:
o Cholecystitis and a gallstone in Hartmann’s pouch with
local inflammation and oedema and sometimes erosion
into the common hepatic duct
• Sclerosing cholangitis
Investigations:
• LFTs:
o Show an obstructive pattern
• Impaired glucose tolerance
• Prolonged INR
• Ultrasound:
406
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Excludes gallstones in the gallbladder
o May show a normal common bile duct
o Dilated intra- and extra-hepatic biliary tree
o May show a mass in the head of the pancreas
o Possible liver metastases
• Endoscopy:
o Can demonstrate a malignant mass infiltrating the
medial wall of the second part of the duodenum (from
which a biopsy may be taken)
o ERCP may indicate a malignant stricture of the common
bile duct or pancreatic duct
• Percutaneous Transhepatic Cholangiography (PTC):
o Done by direct puncture of the bile duct through the
liver substance
o Usually reserved for pts in whom ERCP has failed
• CT:
o Valuable in demonstrating the relationship of the
tumour to the superior mesenteric vessels and portal
vein
o May show lymphatic and hepatic metastases
• Specific serum tumour markers:
o Elevated CEA (Carcinoembryonic antigen)
o Elevated CA 19-9 (Carbohydrate antigen 19-9):
• This is 90% specific for pancreatic cancer
Management:
• Resection of the primary lesion for cure (feasible on < 20%)
• Alleviation of obstructive jaundice:
o Stenting
o Palliative surgical decompression (either
cholecystojejunostomy or hepaticojejunostomy)
• Pain control:
o Narcotics
o Coeliac plexus nerve block by alcohol injection
• Treatment of exocrine/endocrine failure:
o Replacement therapy
• Radiation and chemotherapeutic palliation:
Prognosis:
• Very poor
• Most pts are dead within two years of dx – more than 50%
within 6 months
• Even for those pts fortunate to present with a surgically
resectable lesion, the 5yr survival after successful removal is
< 20%
407
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Third most common cause of death from cancer in men and
fourth in women
• More common in the Eastern world (China/Japan) than in the
West
• Peak age distribution is 50-70yrs, however 5% of pts are <
35yrs
• Male > female (3:1)
Aetiology:
• The cause is largely unknown
• The most likely proximate pathological event is gastric
atrophy which causes hypochlorhydria and is a consequence
of:
o Prolonged H. pylori infection after initial active chronic
gastritis
o Pernicious anaemia
o Gastric operations for peptic ulcer, particularly partial
gastrectomy.
Pathological features:
• At time of presentation, most gastric cancers are both micro-
and macroscopically advanced
• The great majority of tumours are adenocarcinomas
• The adenocarcinoma is a locally invasive tumour which
directly infiltrates the full thickness of the gastric wall to
involve the serosal layer and contiguous structures such as:
o Pancreas
o Transverse mesocolon
o Left lobe of the liver
• The tumour also spreads via the lymphatic system to local
and regional lymph nodes
408
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Signs:
• Weight loss
• Abdominal mass (17%)
• Abdominal tenderness (15%)
• Hepatomegaly (13%)
• Cervical lymphadenopathy (left supraclavicular fossa –
Virchow’s node) (4%)
• Ascites (3%)
Investigations:
• Faecal occult blood testing:
o Positive in 80%, but the ix is non-specific
• Oesophagogastroscopy:
o Most sensitive procedure for determining the presence
or absence of a gastric neoplasm
• Imaging:
o Double contrast barium meal
o CT
o Ultrasound
• Full blood count:
o Microcytic hypochromic anaemia
• Laparoscopy:
o Detects irresectability, particularly by the detection of
small liver or peritoneal metastases
Cure:
• The only curative procedure is surgical resection
• In the UK, only 30-40% of pts are suitable for an attempt at
cure (although up to 70% of lesions may be resectable)
Palliation:
• Surgical resection:
o May be done in spite of nodal or metastatic disease that
makes cure impossible
o Often alleviates troublesome symptoms such as
abdominal pain, dysphagia, blood loss and vomiting
o However, because of late diagnosis and advanced
disease, bypass of an obstructing lesion in the distal
part of the stomach may be all that is possible
• Laser ablation:
o For unresectable tumours at the cardia
o Can dramatically improve swallowing by using a laser
through an endoscope so as to core out a passage
through an obstruction
409
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Chronic cholecystitis
Clinical features:
• May be a past history of attacks of acute cholecystitis
• Chronic discomfort in the RUQ which is often punctuated by
intermittent acute exacerbations
• Intolerance to fatty foods
• May be some tenderness in the RUQ
Investigation:
• Gallstones are detected on ultrasound
Management:
• Cholecystectomy results in a cure
410
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
411
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Crohn’s disease
Epidemiology:
• Incidence is 5-8 per 100,000 and rising
• Worldwide distribution, but is more common in the West
• Incidence is lower in the non-white races with a particular
penchant for Jews
Aetiopathogenesis:
• The aetiology is unknown but it is believed that both genetic
and environmental influences are important
• Familial:
o CD is more common amongst relatives than in the
general population
• Diet:
o Possible relationship with a high sugar diet
• Smoking:
o Strongly predisposes to and aggravates CD
• Infective agent:
o Both mycobacterium and the measles virus have been
loosely associated
Pathology:
• Chronic inflammatory condition affecting any part of the GIT
from the mouth to the anus
• Most commonly affects the terminal ileum and ascending
colon (ileocolonic disease)
• ‘Skip lesions’
Macroscopic changes:
• The involved small bowel is usually thickened and narrowed
• Deep ulcers and fissures in the mucosa – cobblestone
appearance
Microscopic changes:
• Inflammation is transmural
• Increase in chronic inflammatory cells and lymphoid
hyperplasia
• Granulomas present in 50-60% of pts
Clinical features:
• Is a remitting and relapsing disease
• There are two distinct peaks:
o 20-40yrs
412
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o >60yrs (mainly colonic disease)
• Diarrhoea (often bloody in colonic disease)
• Abdominal pain (ranging from discomfort to severe colicky
pain)
• Weight loss
• Constitutional symptoms of:
o Malaise
o Lethargy
o Anorexia
o Nausea
o Vomiting
o Low-grade fever
• May present insidiously or acutely
Examination:
• Aphthous ulceration of the mouth is common
• In colonic CD (80%) examination of the anus may show:
o Oedematous skin tags
o Fissures
o Perianal abscesses
• Eyes:
o Uveitis
o Episcleritis
o Conjunctivitis
• Joints:
o Monoarticular arthritis
o Ankylosing spondylitis
o Sacroiliitis
• Skin:
o Erythema nodosum
o Pyoderma gangrenosum
• Other:
o Fatty liver
o Kidney stones
o Gallbladder stones
Investigations:
• Blood tests:
o Normocytic normochromic anaemia of chronic disease is
common
o Fe/folate deficiency also occurs
o Raised ESR/CRP/WCC
o Hypoalbuminaemia in severe disease
• Stool cultures:
• Small bowel follow-through:
o Shows an asymmetric alteration in the mucosal pattern
413
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Deep ulceration and areas of narrowing largely confined
to the ileum
o ‘Skip lesions’ with normal bowel in between are also
seen
• Colonoscopy:
o Performed if colonic CD is suspected
• CT scanning:
o Useful in delineating abscesses, masses, thickened
bowel wall and mesentery
Differential Diagnosis:
• All chronic diarrhoeas
• Malabsorption
• Malnutrition
Complications:
• Toxic dilatation (more common in colonic CD)
• Obstruction (e.g. strictures)
• Perforation
• Abscesses
• Fistulae
Medical Management:
• Control diarrhoea with:
o Loperamide 2-4mg tid, or
o Codeine phosphate 30-60mg tid
• Acute attacks:
o Anti-inflammatory drugs (e.g. prednisolone 30-
60mg/daily)
o Fluid/electrolyte correction
o Azathioprine (2mg/kg/daily) is helpful in maintaining
the steroid-induced remission
Surgical Management:
• Approx. 80% of pts will require an operation at some time
• Surgery should be avoided as much as possible as recurrence
(15% per year) is almost inevitable
• Indications for surgery are:
o Failure of medical management with acute/chronic
symptoms producing ill-health
o Complications
o Failure to grow in children
414
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Ulcerative colitis
Epidemiology:
• Incidence is stable at 6-15 per 100,000
• Worldwide distribution, but is more common in the West
• Incidence is lower in the non-whites with a particular
penchant for Jews
Aetiopathogenesis:
• Unknown aetiology but is thought to involve both genetic and
environmental factors
• Familial:
o UC is more common amongst relatives than in the
general population
• Smoking:
o ‘Protective’ to some degree (higher incidence of UC in
non-smokers)
Pathology:
• Always affects the rectum (proctitis)
• May extend to infect the sigmoid and descending colon (left-
sided colitis)
• May involve the rectum and entire colon (total colitis)
Macroscopic changes:
• The mucosa looks reddened, inflamed and bleeds very easily
Microscopic changes:
• The mucosa shows a chronic inflammatory cell infiltrate in the
lamina propria
• Crypt abscesses
• Goblet cell depletion
Clinical features:
• Peak age of onset is 20-40yrs
• Women > men
• Diarrhoea with blood and mucus
• Lower abdominal discomfort
• Malaise
• Lethargy
• Anorexia
• Aphthous ulceration of the mouth
• The disease may be mild, moderate or severe
• When the disease is confined to the rectum:
o Blood mixed in with the stool
o Urgency
o Tenesmus
415
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• In an acute attack:
o Bloody diarrhoea (occasionally just blood and mucus are
passed)
o 10-20 liquid stools per day
o Diarrhoea also occurs at night
Examination:
• The abdomen may be slightly distended
• PR exam will show the presence of blood
• Sigmoidoscopy is always abnormal and shows an inflamed,
bleeding, friable mucosa (a biopsy should be taken to confirm
the diagnosis)
Extra GI manifestations:
• Eyes:
o Uveitis
o Episcleritis
o Conjunctivitis
• Joints:
o Monoarticular arthritis
o Ankylosing spondylitis
o Sacroiliitis
• Skin:
o Erythema nodosum
o Pyoderma gangrenosum
• Other:
o Fatty liver
o Sclerosing cholangitis
Investigations:
• Blood tests:
o Normocytic normochromic anaemia of chronic disease
o Fe/folate deficiency occurs
o Raised ESR/CRP/WCC
o Hypoalbuminaemia in severe disease
• Stool cultures
• Plain AXR:
o Look for signs of colonic dilatation
• Colonoscopy
Complications:
• Toxic dilatation
• Perforation
• Severe haemorrhage
• Ca colon
• Perianal abscess
416
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Medical Management:
• All pts are treated with a 5-ASA (5-Amino Salicylic Acid)
compound. It is used to decrease the no. of relapses when
taken long-term
• Mild attacks:
o Local rectal steroids in the form of enemas or foam.
• Moderate attacks:
o Prednisolone (40mg/daily po). Pts with their first attack
or those who do not respond quickly should be admitted
to hospital
• Severe attacks:
o Prednisolone (60mg/6h IV) or Hydrocortisone
(100mg/6h IV)
o IV correction of fluid/electrolytes
o A/Bs for concomitant sepsis
Surgical Management:
• In UC, the disease is confined to the colon and, therefore, a
colectomy is curative.
• The usual indication for surgery is usually a severe attack
which fails to respond to medical treatment
• A prophylactic colectomy is sometimes performed in those
who have a high cancer risk
• Protocolectomy with an ileostomy:
• This is the standard operation in which the colon and rectum
are removed and the ileum is brought out through an opening
in the RIF
• Problems associated with ileostomies include:
o Mechanical problems
o Dehydration (particularly in hot climates)
o Psychosexual problems
o Infertility in men
• Colectomy with an ileorectal or ileoanal anastomosis:
o These procedures avoid the need for an ileostomy
o Ileorectal anastomoses leave a diseased rectum in situ
and frequent diarrhoea still occurs
417
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Diverticular disease
Pathology:
• Most occur in the sigmoid colon (95% of complications occur
at this site)
• Lack of dietary fibre is thought to lead to high intraluminal
pressures which force the mucosa to herniate through the
muscle layers of the gut
• 1/3 of the western world population has diverticulosis by age
60yrs
Diagnosis:
• PR exam
• Sigmoidoscopy
• Barium enema
• Colonoscopy
Differential diagnosis:
• Colorectal cancer
• Pelvic abscess
Complications:
• Painful diverticular disease:
o Altered bowel habit
o Left-sided, colicky pain that is relieved by defaecation
o Nausea/flatulence
o Treatment is:
• High fibre diet
• Antispasmodics (e.g. Mebeverine 135mg/8h po)
• Surgical resection (occasionally)
• Diverticulitis:
o All of the above + signs of inflammation (pyrexia, inc
WCC, inc ESR)
o Colon is tender
o Local/general peritonism
• Treatment is:
o Bed rest
o NBM
o IV fluids
o A/Bs (Cefuroxime 1.5g/8h IV + Metronidazole
500mg/8h IV/PR) until culture results available
418
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Perforation:
o Ileus
o Peritonitis ± shock
o Treatment is emergency laparotomy (perform
Hartman’s procedure – temporary colostomy + partial
colectomy)
o Mortality is approx. 40%
• Haemorrhage:
o Sudden and painless
o Diverticular disease is a common cause of big rectal
bleeds
o Bleeding usually stops with bed rest
o Transfusion may be necessary
o Other treatment:
• Embolization
• Colonic resection
• Fistulae:
o May form between the colon and the:
• Bladder (leading to pneumaturia/intractable UTIs)
• Vagina
• Small bowel
• Rx is surgical
• Abscesses:
o Swinging fever
o Leucocytosis
o Localizing signs (e.g. boggy rectal mass)
o If NO localizing signs, remember:
• “Pus somewhere, pus nowhere = pus under the
diaphragm”
o Do urgent US to exclude subphrenic abscess (a ‘horrible
way to die’)
o Rx is drainage and A/Bs
• Post-infective strictures:
o May form in the sigmoid colon
o Rx is surgical
419
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathological features:
• Multiple adenomatous polyps develop in the colon, usually
between the ages 13-30yrs
• Progression through the polyp-cancer sequence is inevitable
Clinical features:
• The condition is initially asymptomatic, although a family hx
may be present
• Blood from the rectum is the most common symptom
• Tenesmus
• Diarrhoea
420
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Gallstone ileus
Aetiology:
• A gallbladder which contains stones erodes into adjacent
small bowel, usually the duodenum
• Stones can then be shed through this cholecystenteric fistula
into the gut
• A stone that has a diameter greater than the narrowest part
of the small bowel (the terminal ileum) may impact to
produce lower small bowel obstruction.
Clinical features:
• Vague attacks of colic as the stone passes down the gut
• Eventually, signs of a low small bowel obstruction
Investigations:
• In addition to the characteristic features of a small bowel
obstruction on an AXR, it may be possible to see:
o Aerobilia (air in the biliary tree)
o A gallstone in the RLQ
Management:
o Surgical
421
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Gallstones
(Cholelithiasis)
Epidemiology:
• Prevalence of ~10%
• ‘Fair, fat, females in their fifties’
• Can occur at any age in any sex
• 2-4x more common in women than in men
• There are two main types of stone:
o Pure cholesterol stones (20%)
o Mixed cholesterol and bile pigment, mainly Bilirubin
(75%)
Aetiology:
• There are three main predisposing factors:
• Cholesterol supersaturation:
o Cholesterol is insoluble in water
o In bile, it is normally solubilised in lecithin-bile acid
aggregates (micelles)
o If the concentration in bile is high, the capacity of this
mechanism becomes exceeded and nucleation of
cholesterol occurs
• Stasis:
o This may be caused by:
• Fasting
• TPN
• Truncal vagotomy (loss of stimulation to gallbladder
emptying)
• Increased Bilirubin secretion in bile or deconjugation:
o Bilirubin is kept in solution by conjugation with
glucuronide
o Pigment stones form when there is:
• Haemolysis
• Failure of conjugation
Complications:
• Gallstones anywhere in the biliary tree can be asymptomatic
(silent) and lie undetected for many years
• They become clinically evident by the complications they
cause:
o Gallbladder:
• Biliary colic
• Acute cholecystitis
• Chronic cholecystitis
• Empyema
• Mucocele
422
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Common bile duct:
• Obstructive jaundice
• Cholangitis
• Pancreatitis
o Small intestine:
• Gallstone ileus
423
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Intestinal obstruction
Features of obstruction:
• Anorexia
• Nausea/vomiting
• Colicky abdominal pain with abdominal distension
• Constipation (although need not be absolute if obstruction is
high)
• Active ‘tinkling’ bowel sounds
Causes:
• Small bowel:
o Adhesions (common)
o Hernias (common)
o Crohn’s disease
o Gallstone ileus
o Tumour
o Intussusception (only in infants <18mths)
• Large bowel:
o Tumour (common)
424
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Diverticulitis (common)
o Faeces
o Sigmoid/caecal volvulus (twisting of part of the gut)
Management:
• Conservative:
o Pass NG tube
o IV fluids to rehydrate and correct electrolyte imbalances
• Surgery:
o Strangulation requires urgent surgery (<1h), as does
large bowel obstruction with gas dilatation (>8cm) and
tenderness over the caecum (as perforation as close)
o For less urgent large bowel obstructions, there is time
for an enema to try to clear the obstruction and correct
fluid imbalance
425
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Obstructive jaundice
Clinical features:
• Jaundice
• Pruritis
• Dark urine
• Pale stools
• Preceding biliary colic
Investigations:
• Ultrasound:
o Shows dilatation of the bile ducts
o May identify ductal stones
• ERCP (Endoscopic Retrograde CholangioPancreatoGraphy):
o Confirms the diagnosis
o Makes the distinction between a stone and other causes
of obstructive jaundice
Management:
• The treatment of choice is ERCP and extraction of the ductal
stone(s) after division or dilatation of the sphincter of Oddi
• Subsequently (if it has not been done already) the gallbladder
should be removed unless the pt is elderly or at a high
operative risk
426
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• Primary tumours of the small bowel are relatively uncommon
• Account for 5% of GI neoplasms
• May be benign or malignant
• Commonest benign tumours are leiomyomas (smooth muscle
tumours)
• There are 4 factors associated with small bowel malignancies:
o Developmental disorders
o Immunocompromisation
o Geographical location
o Crohn’s disease
Developmental disorders:
• Polyposis coli
• Peutz-Jegher syndrome:
o An ill-understood inherited relationship between
intestinal polyps mainly in the jejunum and marginal
pigmentation around the buccal and anal mucosa – the
usual presentation is with intussusception
• Gardner’s syndrome:
o A rare disorder in which small bowel adenomas and
carcinomas are associated with skeletal abnormalities
and desmoid tumours
Immunocompromisation:
• Coeliac disease
• Acquired immunodeficiency (e.g. AIDS)
• Immunosuppression (chiefly in transplant pts) is associated
with small bowel lymphomas
Geographical location:
• Lymphomas are more common in the Middle East than
elsewhere
427
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Adenocarcinomas (most common in the duodenum)
o Secondary tumours (rare, but occur in lung and breast
cancer)
428
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Upper GI bleeds
Causes:
• Common:
o Gastric/duodenal ulcer (50%) (GU more likely to
bleed/higher mortality than DU)
o Oesophageal varices (5-10%)
o Gastritis
o Mallory-Weiss tear (oesophageal tear due to vomiting)
o Portal hypertensive gastropathy
o Drugs:
• NSAIDs
• Steroids
• ThrombolyticsAnticoagulants
• Rarer:
o Nose bleeds (swallowed blood)
o Oesophageal/gastric malignancy
o Oesophagitis
o Haemobilia
o Peutz-Jegher’s syndrome (Benign small intestinal
hamartomartous polyps occurring with dark freckles on
lips, oral mucosa, face, palms and soles)
Assessment:
• Swift, relevant history and examination
• History:
o ‘Do you feel faint when you sit up?’ If yes, put up an IVI
before continuing
o Drugs (NSAIDs, steroids, anticoagulants)
o Alcohol abuse
o Previous GI bleed, peptic ulcer or its symptoms?
o Any other serious concomitant disease?
• Examination:
o Vital signs (pulse, BP standing/lying, JVP, urine output)
o Signs of chronic liver disease?
o Jaundice (biliary colic + jaundice + Malaena suggests
haemobilia)
429
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Assess whether the patient is in shock:
• Cool and clammy to touch (especially nose, toes, fingers)
• Pulse >100bpm
• JVP <1cm H2O
• Systolic BP <100mmHg
• Postural drop
• Urine output <30mL/h
Surgical Management:
• Varices:
o Oesophageal transaction with gun stapler re-
anastomosis
o Transthoracic transoesophageal ligation
• Gastric ulcer:
o Under-running
o Excision
o Partial gastrectomy
430
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Respiratory Medicine
431
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Definition:
• Defined as:
o Diffuse pulmonary infiltrates
o Non-cardiogenic pulmonary oedema
o Refractory hypoxaemia
o Stiff lungs
o Respiratory distress
• Commonest predisposing factor, by far, is sepsis (20-40% of
patients with severe sepsis will develop ARDS)
Pathophysiology:
• ARDS can be considered as the earliest manifestation of a
generalized inflammatory response and is, therefore,
frequently associated with the development of MODS
(multiple organ dysfunction syndrome)
Pulmonary hypertension:
• Common feature of ARDS
• Initially, mechanical obstruction of the pulmonary circulation
may occur as a result of vascular compression by interstitial
oedema and, subsequently, oedema of the vessel wall itself
432
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Later, constriction of the vasculature may develop in
response to increased ANS activity and circulating substances
(e.g. catecholamines)
Fibrosis:
• Starts to occur within 7 days of the onset of ARDS
• Is progressive, and causes a loss of elastic tissue and
obliteration of the lung vasculature, together with lung
destruction and emphysema
Physiological changes:
• Increased dead-space
• Decreased compliance
• Evidence of airflow limitation
Management of ARDS:
• This is based on treatment of the underlying cause and
supportive measures
• Limit pulmonary oedema:
o Fluid restriction
o Diuretics
o Haemofiltration (if severe)
• Body position changes:
o When the patient is changed from the supine to the
prone position, lung densities in the dependent regions
are redistributed and gas exchange may improve
o Repeated position changes between prone and supine
may, therefore, allow reduction in airway pressures and
the inspired oxygen concentration
• High dose steroids:
o Only shown to be beneficial when administered during
the late fibroproliferative phase of ARDS
• Inhaled nitric oxide:
o Can improve V/Q matching and oxygenation by
increasing perfusion in ventilated lung units
o Also reduces pulmonary hypertension
• Aerosolized prostacyclin:
o Has similar effects to inhaled NO
• Aerosolized surfactant:
o Yet to be established
433
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Beneficial in animal models of ARDS
Prognosis:
• Mortality is >50%
• Prognosis is very dependent on aetiology
• When ARDS occurs in association with septic shock, mortality
can be as high as 90%
• ~40% of uncomplicated cases die
• The major cause of mortality is not so much impaired gas
exchange but MODS and haemodynamic instability
434
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Asthma
Characteristics:
• Asthma has 3 characteristics:
1. Reversible airflow limitation
2. Airway hyperresponsiveness
3. Inflammation of the bronchi
Prevalence:
• Affects 15-20% of people in their 20s
• Commoner in the West
Classification:
• 2 classes:
o Intrinsic or cryptogenic (when no causative agent can
be identified)
o Extrinsic (implying a definite external cause)
Extrinsic asthma:
• Occurs most frequently in atopic individuals who show (+ve)
skin-prick reactions to common inhaled allergens
• (+ve) skin tests to inhalant allergens are shown in 90% of
children and 50% of adults
Intrinsic asthma:
• Often starts in middle age
• Many show (+ve) skin tests and on close questioning give a
history of respiratory symptoms compatible with childhood
asthma
435
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Airway hyperreactivity:
• Demonstrated by asking the patient to inhale gradually
increasing doses of histamine or methacholine
• This induces a transient episode of airflow limitation in
susceptible individuals (~20% of the population)
• The dose of the agonist (provocation dose) necessary to
produce a 20% fall in FEV1 is known as the PD20FEV1
• Patients with clinical features of asthma respond to very low
doses of methacholine, i.e. they have a low PD20FEV1
(<11µmol)
Precipitating factors:
• Occupational sensitizers
• Cold air
• Exercise
• Atmospheric pollution, irritant dusts, vapours and fumes
• Emotion
• Drugs (e.g. NSAIDs)
Clinical features:
• Wheezing
• Episodic SOB
• Cough (especially nocturnal)
• Chest ‘tightness’
Investigations:
• Lung function tests:
o The diagnosis of asthma is based on the demonstration
of a greater than 15% increase in FEV1 or PEFR
following the inhalation of a bronchodilator
• Peak flow charts
• Exercise tests
• Histamine or methacholine bronchial provocations test:
o This test should NOT be performed on individuals who
have poor lung function (FEV1 <1.5L)
• Trial of corticosteroids (as for COPD)
• CXR:
o Useful in excluding other possible diagnoses
• Skin-prick tests
• Blood and sputum tests
Management:
• The aims of management are as follows:
o To abolish symptoms
o To restore normal or best possible long-term airway
function
o To reduce the risk of severe attacks
436
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o To enable normal growth to occur in children
o To minimise absence from school or work
Drug therapy:
• β2-adrenoceptor agonists:
o E.g. salbutamol 100µg (2 puffs PRN) or salmeterol (50-
100µg 1 puff daily)
o Cause relaxation of bronchial smooth muscle
o Very effective at relieving symptoms but does little for
the underlying inflammatory nature of the disease
o Only the mildest asthmatics, with intermittent attacks
should rely on bronchodilator treatment alone
• Anticholinergic bronchodilators:
o E.g. ipratropium bromide 20-40mg TID by inhalation
• Inhaled corticosteroids:
o E.g. inhaled beclomethasone (available in doses of 50,
100 and 250µg per puff)
o Unwanted effects of inhaled corticosteroids include:
• Oral candidiasis
• Hoarsenes
• Abnormalities of bone formation (with very high
steroid doses)
• Growth retardation in children if inhaling >400µg
daily
• Oral corticosteroids:
o Used for those patients who are not controlled on
inhaled corticosteroids
o Keep dose as low as possible to avoid side-effects
• Leukotriene receptor antagonists:
o E.g. Montelukast (single tablet daily)
o Improves control when used with an inhaled steroid
437
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Bronchial carcinoma
Epidemiology:
• Most common malignant tumour in the western world
• Third most common cause of death in the UK (after heart
disease and pneumonia)
• 32,000 people a year die from bronchial carcinoma in the UK
• Males affected more than females (3.5:1)
• The link between bronchial carcinoma and smoking is
overwhelming
Cell types:
• Bronchial carcinoma is divided into 2 classes:
o Non-small cell carcinoma
o Small-cell carcinoma
Small-cell carcinoma:
• Also known as an oat-cell carcinoma
• Accounts for 20-30% of all lung tumours
• Secrete many polypeptide hormones
• Responds well to chemotherapy
438
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features of bronchial carcinoma:
Symptom Frequency (%)
Cough 41
Chest pain 22
Cough and pain 15
Haemoptysis 7
Chest infection <5
Malaise <5
Weight loss <5
SOB <5
Hoarseness <5
Distant spread <5
Asymptomatic <5
Direct spread:
• The tumour may directly involve the pleura and ribs
• Carcinoma of the apex of the lung can erode the ribs and
involve the lower part of the brachial plexus (C8, T1 and T2)
causing severe pain in the shoulder and down the inner
surface of the arm (Pancoast’s tumour)
• The sympathetic ganglion can also be involved, producing
Horner’s syndrome
• Further extension may involve the recurrent laryngeal nerve
as it passes down the aortic arch, causing unilateral vocal
cord paresis with hoarseness and a bovine cough
• Bronchial carcinoma can also directly invade the phrenic
nerve, causing paralysis of the diaphragm
Metastatic complications:
• Commonly metastasises to:
o Brain (causing personality change, epilepsy or a focal
neurological lesion)
o Bone (severe pain and pathological fractures)
o Liver
Investigations:
• CXR:
o Very valuable but very insensitive (the tumour must be
>1-2cm to be visible)
o About 70% of bronchial carcinomas arise in the hilar
region
o At the time of clinical presentation, the chest CXR will
demonstrate >90% of carcinomas
• CT scans:
o Particularly useful for identifying pathological changes in
the mediastinum (such as lymphadenopathy or local
spread of the tumour)
439
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Also good for identifying secondary spread of the
carcinoma to the opposite lung by detecting masses too
small to be seen on the CXR
• MRI:
o Is being increasingly used for staging
• Fibre-optic bronchoscopy:
o Used to obtain biopsy specimens
o If the carcinoma involves the first 2cm of either main
bronchus, the tumour is inoperable
o Vocal cord paresis on the left indicates involvement of
the left recurrent laryngeal nerve and inoperability
• Transthoracic FNA biopsy:
o This involves the direct aspiration, through the chest
wall, of peripheral lung lesions under appropriate X-ray
or CT screening
o Pneumothorax occurs in 25% of patients
o Mild haemoptysis occurs in 5%
• Blood tests:
o FBC (to detect anaemia)
o LFTs (t detect liver involvement)
Prognosis:
• Only 20% of patients are alive one year after diagnosis and
only 6-8% after 5 years
Surgery:
• The only treatment of any value for non-small cell cancer of
the lung is surgery
• Only 20% of all cases are suitable for resection and of these,
only 25-30% survive for five years
440
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Response rates with single-agent treatment with newly
introduced drugs exceed 20%
• Median survival can be increased to 6-12 months
Palliative treatment:
• Endobrachial irradiation
• Tracheobronchial stents
• Laser ablation via a fibre-optic bronchoscope
441
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Cor pulmonale
Acute
442
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
•On examination:
• Tachypnoea
• Localized pleural rub
• Coarse crackles over the involved area
• A pleural effusion can develop
• There may be a fever
• Normal CVS
o Massive PE:
• Much rarer scenario
• Sudden collapse occurs due to an acute
obstruction of the right ventricular outflow tract
• Symptoms:
• Severe central chest pain (cardiac ischaemia
due to lack of coronary blood flow)
• Shock
• Death can occur
• On examination:
• Tachypnoea
• Tachycardia
• Hypotension
• Peripheral vasoconstriction
• Raised JVP
• Right ventricular heave
• Gallop rhythm
• Widely split second heart sound
o Multiple recurrent pulmonary emboli:
• Symptoms:
• Increasing breathlessness (often over
weeks or months)
• Weakness
• Syncope on exertio
• Angina (occasionally)
• On examination:
• Signs of right ventricular overload
• Right ventricular heave
• Loud pulmonary second heart sound
Diagnosis of PE:
• PE should be considered if patients present with symptoms of
new-onset AF (or other tachycardia), unexplained
breathlessness or cough, if no other obvious cause is present
443
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• ECG:
o In small/medium PE, there is usually sinus tachycardia
or AF
o In massive PE there is:
• Tall peaked T waves in lead II
• Right axis deviation
• Right bundle branch block
• Blood tests:
o Hypoxia and hypercapnia
o Raised ESR/LDH due to pulmonary infarction
• Plasma D-dimer:
o If undetectable, it excludes the diagnosis of PE
• Radionucleotide ventilation-perfusion scan (V/Q scan):
o Ultrasound:
• To detect clots in pelvic/lower limb veins
• Spiral CT scans
• MRI
Acute management:
• High-flow O2, unless they have significant chronic lung disease
• In severe cases:
o IV fluids
o Inotropic agents
• Analgesia
• Dissolution of the thrombus:
o Streptokinase 250,000U IVI over 30 minutes, followed
by streptokinase 100,000U IV hourly is often used
following a major embolism
• Prevent further emboli:
o The basis of therapy is IV heparin
o Give a bolus of 10,000U of unfractionated heparin
followed by a continuous infusion of 1000-2000U per
hour
o Oral anticoagulants are usually begun after 48 hours
and the heparin is tapered off as the oral anticoagulant
becomes effective
Oral anticoagulants are continued for 6 weeks to 6 months
Chronic
444
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• The pulmonary HT becomes chronic and progressively more
severe
• Right ventricular function is progressively compromised
because of the increased pressure load
• Hypoxia further impairs right ventricular function and, as it
develops, left ventricular function is also depressed
Clinical features:
• Symptoms:
o Chest pain
o Exertional dyspnoea
o Syncope
o Fatigue
o Sudden death
• On examination:
o Right ventricular (parasternal) heave
o Loud pulmonary component to the second heart sound
o Mid-systolic ejection murmur
o Early diastolic murmur (due to pulmonary regurgitation)
o Pansystolic murmur (if tricuspid regurgitation develops)
Investigations:
• CXR:
o May show right ventricular enlargement and right atrial
dilatation
o Prominent pulmonary artery
• ECG:
o Right axis deviation (indicating right ventricular
hypertrophy)
o Tall peaked T waves in lead II (P pulmonale)
• Echocardiography:
o Will usually demonstrate right ventricular dilatation
and/or hypertrophy
o May also reveal the cause of the pulmonary
hypertension
o If no other cause is found, then the diagnosis of primary
pulmonary hypertension is made. This disease typically
affects young females (20-35 years)
Treatment:
• Treatment is determined by the underlying condition
• Diuretic therapy in right ventricular failure:
o Use with care as excessive fluid depletion will result in a
reduced output from the impaired ventricle
• Oxygen therapy
• Primary pulmonary hypertension:
445
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Treated with anticoagulation (because the possibility of
recurrent thromboembolism can seldom by fully
excluded)
o Vasodilators (e.g. verapamil) are sometimes of
symptomatic benefit
• Usually there is a progressive downhill course
• Heart and lung transplantation is recommended for young
patients
446
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
COPD has become the most popular term to describe patients with
chronic bronchitis and emphysema. The distinction between COPD
and asthma is blurred as most patients with COPD have some
reversible airflow obstruction.
Definitions in COPD:
• Chronic bronchitis:
o Cough productive of sputum on most days for at least 3
months of the year for more than 1 year
• Emphysema:
o Dilatation and destruction of the lung tissue distal to the
terminal bronchioles
Epidemiology:
• 18% of male and 14% of female smokers
• In the UK, COPD causes approximately 18 million lost working
days for men and 2.1 million lost working days for women per
year (approximately 7% of all days off sick from work)
Aetiology:
• Smoking is a major factor in the development of COPD
• Is virtually only a disease of smokers
• Climate and air pollution play an important role, with a great
increase in mortality from COPD during periods of heavy
atmospheric pollution
447
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Hereditary deficiency of α1-antitrypsin is responsible for 2% of
cases of emphysema
Pathophysiology of emphysema:
• Most commonly, distension and damage of lung tissue is
concentrated around the respiratory bronchioles, whilst the
more distal alveolar ducts and alveoli tend to be well
preserved
• Emphysema leads to expiratory airflow limitation and air
trapping
• The loss of lung elastic recoil results in an increase in TLC
• The loss of alveoli results in decreased gas transfer
Symptoms of COPD:
• Productive sputum
• Wheeze
• Shortness of breath
Signs of COPD:
• In mild disease:
o No signs except wheeze throughout the chest
• In severe disease:
o Tachypnoea
o Prolonged expiration
o Use of the accessory muscles
o Intercostal indrawing on inspiration
o Pursing of the lips on expiration
o Poor chest expansion
o Lung hyperinflation
448
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• The ‘pink puffer’:
o Always breathless
o Not usually cyanosed
• The ‘blue bloater’:
o Oedematous
o Deeply cyanosed
o Hypoventilation
o These patients are likely to have hypercapnia, so the
following are present:
• Peripheral vasodilatation
• Bounding pulse
• CO2 retention tremor
• Severe hypercapnia leads to CO2 narcosis:
o Confusion
o Progressive drowsiness and coma with papilloedema
Complications of COPD:
• Respiratory failure:
o Usually defined as one or both of the following:
• PaO2 less than 8kPa
• PaCO2 of greater than 7kPa
• Cor pulmonale:
o Heart disease secondary to disease of the lung
o Pulmonary HT
o Right ventricular hypertrophy
o Right heart failure
Investigations:
• Lung function tests:
o Evidence of airflow limitation
o FEV1 : FRC is reduced
o Low PEFR
• CXR:
o Often normal but may show hyperinflation
• Hb level and PCV:
o Can be elevated as a result of persistent hypoxaemia
(secondary polycythaemia)
449
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Treatment:
• Stop smoking:
o Even at a late stage of the disease this may slow down
the rate of deterioration
• Bronchodilators (e.g. salbutamol 200µg every 4-6 hours)
• Corticosteroids:
o Initial 2 week trial pf prednisolone 30mg daily
o If lung function improvements, gradually replace with
inhaled corticosteroids (e.g. beclomethasone 100-500µg
TID)
• Antibiotics:
o Patients should be given a supply of antibiotics to use
once their sputum turns yellow or green
o The antibiotics of choice are cefaclor 500mg TID or
cefixime 400mg OD
• Diuretics (for all oedematous patients)
450
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
451
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pleural effusion
Definition:
• An excessive collection of fluid in the pleural space
• Can be detected by X-ray when >300ml of fluid is present
• Can be detected clinically when >500ml of fluid is present
Clinical signs:
• Decreased chest expansion on affected side
• Mediastinum displaced away from lesion (in massive
effusions)
• Stony dull to percussion
• Vesicular breath sounds – reduced or absent
• Reduced or absent vocal resonance
• No added sounds
Diagnosis:
• Pleural aspiration
• The fluid that accumulates may be a transudate or an exudate
Transudates:
Causes include:
• Heart failure
• Hypoproteinaemia (e.g. nephrotic syndrome)
• Constrictive pericarditis
• Hypothyroidism
• Ovarian tumours
Exudates:
Causes include:
• Bacterial pneumonia (common)
• Bronchial carcinoma
• TB
• Connective tissue disease
452
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pneumonia
Definition:
• Inflammation of the substance of the lungs
• It is usually caused by bacterial infection
Classification:
• Pneumonia may be classified both anatomically and on the
basis of the aetiology
• Classification by site:
o Lobar
o Diffuse (bronchopneumonia)
• Classification by aetiology:
o Infective (by far the most common)
o Chemical causes (e.g. the aspiration of gastric contents)
o Radiotherapy
o Allergic mechanisms
• Note, the last 3 are generally referred to as ‘pneumonitis’
Precipitating factors:
• Viral respiratory infection
• Hospitalized patients
• Smoking
• Alcohol excess
• Bronchiectasis (e.g. in cystic fibrosis)
• Bronchial obstruction (e.g. carcinoma)
• Immunosuppression (e.g. AIDS or treatment with cytotoxic
drugs)
• IV drug abuse (frequently associated with Staph. Aureus
infection)
Clinical features:
• Varies according to the immune status of the patient and the
infecting agent. In the most common type of pneumonia
(caused by Strep. pneumoniae) there is often:
o Preceding history of viral infection
o High fever (up to 39.5˚C)
o Pleuritic pain
o Dry cough that progresses (after ~ 2 days) to a
productive cough with rusty coloured sputum
o Patient breathes rapidly and shallowly
o Decreased chest expansion on the affected side
o A pleural rub
Investigations:
• CXR:
o Confirms areas of consolidation
453
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o May show areas of collapse
• Blood tests:
o FBC (will show WCC of <4 or >20, may also show
polycythaemia if chronic)
o LFTs (some organisms can affect liver function – e.g.
Legionella)
o U&Es (signs of dehydration – increased urea/creatinine)
o ESR
o CRP
• Arterial blood gas:
o Will usually show hypoxaemia and hypercapnia
• Blood culture
• Sputum (only useful for proving the existence of an atypical
infecting organism)
o Gram stain
o Culture
Types of pneumonia:
• Strep. pneumoniae – very common cause
• Mycoplasma pneumoniae – teens and adults in their 20s
• Haemophilus infuenzae – commonly infects patients with
COPD
• Chlamydia psittaci – transmitted by infected birds (especially
parrots)
• Chlamydia pneumonia – person-to-person transmission
• Staph. aureus – IVDUs and patients with central lines
• Legionella pneumophilia – air-conditioning and shared water
systems
• Pneumocystis carinii – immunocompromised (especially AIDS
patients)
• Pseudomonas – cystic fibrosis (bad prognostic sign)
Management of pneumonia:
• Antimicrobials (see below for details)
• IV fluids (to rectify dehydration and maintain a good urine
output)
• Oxygen
• Analgesia (for pleuritic pain, e.g. NSAIDs)
454
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Aspiration:
o Clindamycin 450-900mg/8h IV, or
o Cefoxitine 2g/8h IV
Complications of pneumonia:
• Lung abscesses:
o Common in aspiration pneumonias
o Clinical features:
• Persistent or worsening pneumonia
• Production of large quantities of foul-smelling
sputum
• Swinging fever
• Empyema:
o This is the presence of pus within the pleural cavity
o Usually arises after the rupture of a lung abscess into
the pleural space or from bacterial spread from a severe
pneumonia
455
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pneumothorax
Definition:
• Air in the pleural space
Causes:
• Trauma to the chest wall
• Spontaneous
Pathophysiology:
• Pneumothorax is localised if the visceral pleura has previously
undergone adhesion to the parietal pleura, or generalized if
the whole hemithorax contains air
• Normally, the pressure in the pleural space is negative but
this is lost once a communication is made with atmospheric
pressure
• The elastic recoil pressure of the lung then causes it to
partially deflate
• If the communication between the airways and the pleural
space remains (an open pneumothorax), a bronchopleural
fistula is created
• It takes about 40 days for a 50% collapse of the lung to
reabsorb completely once the pneumothorax is closed
Tension pneumothorax:
• A valvular mechanism may develop through which air can be
sucked during inspiration but not expelled during expiration
• The intrapleural pressure remains positive throughout
breathing, the lung deflates further, the mediastinum shifts
and venous return to the heart decreases – with increasing
respiratory and cardiac embarrassment
• A tension pneumothorax is very rare, unless the patient is on
positive ventilation
Spontaneous pneumothorax:
• Usually occurs in young males (male:female is 6:1)
• It is caused by the rupture of a pleural bleb, usually apical
and is thought to be due to congenital defects in the
connective tissue of the alveolar walls
• Both lungs are affected with equal frequency
• Often these patients are tall and thin
• In patients >40 years, the usual cause is underlying COPD
• Clinical features:
o Sudden onset of unilateral pleuritic pain
o Increasing breathlessness
456
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Treatment:
• Essentially involves aspirating the air in the pleural space
• If the air reaccumulates, insert an intercostal drainage tube
with underwater seal for 2-3 days
• If the air reaccumulates after this, a pleurectomy is
sometimes required
457
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Respiratory failure
Definition:
Respiratory failure occurs when pulmonary gas exchange is
sufficiently impaired to cause hypoxaemia, with or without
hypercapnia
• It can be divided into 2 types:
o Type I respiratory failure (‘acute hypoxaemic failure’):
• PaO2 <8Kpa
• PaCO2 is normal or low
o Type II respiratory failure (‘ventilatory failure’):
• PaO2 <8kPa
• PaCO2 >7kPa
458
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• HCO3- 20-25mmol/L
• SaO2 95-100%
Oxygen therapy:
• Oxygen is, initially delivered via a face mask or nasal specs. If
this is proving inadequate, there are several other techniques
for respiratory support available:
• Non-invasive positive pressure ventilation:
o Bi-level positive airway pressure (BPAP) (insp and exp
pressures can be set separately)
o Continuous positive airway pressure (CPAP) via a face
mask (constant pressure but can vary volumes)
• Invasive positive pressure ventilation:
o Intermittent positive pressure ventilation (IPPV) (may
be given with positive end expiratory pressure – PEEP)
• CPAP via an endotracheal tube
• High frequency jet ventilation (HFJV) (useful for patients with
a lung leak)
IPPV:
• This is achieved by intermittently inflating the lungs with a
positive pressure delivered by a ventilator and applied via an
endotracheal tube or a tracheostomy
• Beneficial effects:
o Improved CO2 elimination
o Relief from exhaustion
o Reduction in total body O2 demand
• Dangers of IPPV:
o Airway complications
o Mechanical faults with ventilator
o CVS complications (the intermittent application of
positive pressure impedes venous return and distends
alveoli, thereby stretching the pulmonary capillaries and
causing an increase in pulmonary vascular resistance
o Pulmonary infection
o Barotrauma
459
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Abdominal distension associated with an ileus (unknown
cause)
o Increased ADH secretion, therefore causing salt and
water retention
Complications of tracheostomy:
• As for endotracheal tubes, plus the following:
• Early:
o Pneumothorax
o Haemothorax
o Subcutaneous emphysema
• Intermediate:
o Erosion of tracheal cartilages
o Erosion of innominate artery (may lead to fatal
haemorrhage)
o Infection
• Late:
o Tracheal stenosis at level of stoma
o Collapse of tracheal rings at level of stoma
460
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Sarcoidosis
Epidemiology:
• Unknown aetiology
• 19 per 100,000 in the UK
• Peak incidence is in the 30s and 40s
• Females > males
Clinical features:
• Respiratory symptoms
• Abnormalities found on CXR (e.g. bilateral hilar
lymphadenopathy)
• Fatigue (~5%)
• Weight loss (~5%)
• Peripheral lymphadenopathy (~5%)
• Fever (~4%)
Pulmonary infiltration:
• This type of sarcoidosis may be progressive and may lead to:
o Increasing effort dyspnoea
o Cor pulmonale
o Death
• Pulmonary function tests show a typical restrictive lung defect
461
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Investigations:
• Imaging:
o CXR
o CT
• Blood tests:
o FBC (there is a mild normochromic normocytic anaemia)
o ESR (raised)
o Biochem (hypercalcaemia and
hypergammaglobulinaemia)
• Transbronchial biopsy:
o Is the most useful investigation
462
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o This test provides histological evidence of a granuloma
in ~50% of patients with clinically extrapulmonary
sarcoidosis in whom the CXR is normal
• Serum level of ACE:
o Is 2 SDs above normal in 75% of patients with
untreated sarcoidosis
Treatment:
• If the disease is not improving spontaneously within 6 months
of diagnosis, treatment should be started
• Prednisolone 30mg daily for 6 weeks, reducing to alternate-
day treatment with prednisolone 15mg for 6-12 months
Prognosis:
• The disease is fatal in <5% of patients in the UK
• Most deaths are from respiratory failure and cor pulmonale
• The disease remits within 2 years in over:
o 65% of patients with hilar lymphadenopathy alone
o 50% of patients with hilar lymphadenopathy plus CXR
evidence of pulmonary infiltration
o 30% of patients with X-ray evidence of infiltration
without any demonstrable lymphadenopathy
463
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Tuberculosis (TB)
Epidemiology:
• TB is the world’s leading cause of death from a single
infectious disease
• 2,000,000 deaths in 1990
• This is the result of:
o Inadequate programmes for disease control
o Drug resistance
o Co-infection with HIV
• In the UK, there are 7,000 new cases per year
• In the UK, the highest risk groups are immigrants from the
Asian subcontinent and the West Indies
• TB is a notifiable disease
Pathology:
• The initial infection with M.tuberculosis is known as primary
tuberculosis
• It is usually subpleural, often in the mid to upper zones
• Within an hour of reaching the lung, tubercle bacilli reach the
draining lymph nodes at the hilum of the lung and a few
escape into the bloodstream
• The initial reaction comprises:
o Exudation
o Infiltration with neutrophil granulocytes (these are
rapidly replaced by macrophages which ingest the
bacilli)
• Granulomatous lesions consist of a central area of necrotic
material of a cheesy nature (called caseation) surrounded by
epithelioid cells and Langerhan’s giant cells
• Subsequently, the caseated areas heal and many become
calcified
• It is known that at least 20% of these calcified primary lesions
contain tubercle bacilli, initially lying dormant but capable of
being reactivated by depression of the hosts immune system
• Reactivation leads to typical post-primary pulmonary TB with
cavitation, usually in the apex or upper zones of the lung
• Post-primary TB refers to all forms of TB that occur after the
first few weeks of the primary infection when immunity to the
mycobacterium has developed
464
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Erythema nodosum
Miliary TB:
• Is the result of acute diffuse dissemination of tubercle bacilli
via the bloodstream
• Is universally fatal unless treated
• It may present in an entirely non-specific manner with a
gradual onset of:
o Vague ill-health
o Weight loss
o Fever
• Occasionally it presents as tuberculosis meningitis
• Positive Mantoux test
• Transbronchial biopsies are frequently positive before any
abnormality is visible on the CXR
On examination:
• Very few signs
• Finger clubbing (if disease is advanced and associated with
considerable production of purulent sputum)
465
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Investigating adult post-primary TB:
• CXR:
o An abnormal CXR is often found with no symptoms, but
the reverse is extremely rare (pulmonary TB is unlikely
in the absence of any radiographic abnormality)
o Typically shows:
• Patchy or nodular shadows in the upper zones
• Loss of volume
• Fibrosis (with or without cavitation)
• Calcification may be present
Diagnosis:
• The diagnosis is made on the basis of the following
investigations:
o Imaging:
• CXR
• CT
• Staining:
o The sputum is stained with Ziehl-Nielsen (ZN) stain for
acid-fast and alcohol-fast bacilli (AAFB)
• Culture:
o The sputum is cultured for 4-8 weeks
o Cultures to determine the sensitivity of the bacillus to
antibiotics take a further 3-4 weeks
• Fibre-optic bronchoscopy with washings from the affected
lobe(s):
o Useful if no sputum is available
• Biopsies of the:
o Pleura
o Lymph nodes
o Solid lesions within the lung (tuberculomas)
Treatment:
• Directly observed therapy (DOT):
o In order to improve compliance, special clinics are used
to supervise treatment regimens directly
o Incentives to attend (e.g. free meals) may be helpful
• Six-month regimen:
o This is standard practice for patients with pulmonary
and lymph node disease
o Daily administration of:
• Rifampicin 600mg, and
• Isoniazid 300mg
• Pyrazinamide 1.5-2g (for the first two months
only)
o These are given as combination tablets and are taken
30 minutes before breakfast (since the absorption of
rifampicin is influenced by food)
466
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Longer regimens:
o Treatment of bone TB should be continued for a total of 9
months
o Tuberculosis meningitis should be treated for 1 year
o The drugs are the same as for pulmonary TB
467
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Vascular Surgery
468
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathological features:
• An aortic aneurysm inevitably expands, a process made much
more likely by hypertension
• Eventually, rupture takes place through all the attenuated
layers, with either the:
o Initial formation of a retroperitoneal clot, or
o Immediate free bleeding into the peritoneal cavity
sufficient to cause death
• The risk of rupture is related to the size of the aneurysm – the
normal aorta is 1.5-2.5cm in diameter and is defined as
aneurysmal when it is >4cm
• The reported annual risk of rupture is probably in the region
of:
o 4cm 1-2%
o 5cm 5-10%
o 6cm 10-15%
o 7cm >20%
• Only 30% of patients with rupture live long enough to reach
hospital , and of those operated upon, only 50% survive
• Thus, the overall (community) mortality for rupture is as high
as 80-90%
Clinical features:
• In thin patients, the aneurysm itself as well as its transmitted
pulsation may be visible on inspection
• On palpation, there will be a pulsatile, expansile swelling in
the midline of the abdomen, usually extending towards the
left-hand side
• However, clinical examination alone is very unreliable at
confirming the presence or absence of an AAA
• Any suspicion of AAA should therefore prompt an US
investigation
• There may be a bruit on auscultation in association with origin
stenoses of the branches of the abdominal aorta (coeliac axis,
superior mesenteric, renal arteries)
469
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• There is an association between AAA and aneurysms
elsewhere, so one should specifically exclude the presence of
femoral and popliteal aneurysms
Management:
• The unpredictable nature of this process means that vascular
surgeons usually organise repeat US examination at 3-6
monthly intervals for those who do not require urgent
management
470
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• Symptoms:
o Patients present at almost any age; onset of symptoms
may be related to the appearance of the menarche, to
pregnancy or to an episode of minor trauma
o Swelling
o Discolouration
o Bleeding
o Pain
o High-output cardiac failure
o Limb hypertrophy
• Signs:
o Lesions with an arterial component are usually pulsatile
o A machinery-type murmur is heard on auscultation
o Venous lesions engorge and empty with dependency
and elevation, respectively
Diagnosis:
• Appearance in later life requires distinction from malignant
lesions such as sarcoma and metastatic deposits
• Apart form biopsy to exclude malignancy in cases of doubt,
the diagnosis is usually clinical
Investigation:
• A CXR allows assessment of cardiac size
• US can be used to assess venous lesions
• CT and particularly MRI give valuable information about deep
extent when excision is contemplated
Management:
• AVMs may not require treatment except for counselling and
the reassurance for both the patient and, in children, the
parents
• Occasionally operation may be required to exclude malignancy
• Complete excision provides good long-term control but is
rarely feasible
• Amputation is sometimes required as a last resort
471
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Therapeutic embolisation, in which the lesion is filled from
within with thrombogenic coils or gel, is the mainstay of
treatment:
o Carries a risk of ischaemia in surrounding or distal vital
tissues
• Venous lesions can be treated by direct injection of sclerosant
and/or partial excision of prominent veins once the normality
of the deep venous system (sometimes absent or hypoplastic)
has been assured
472
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Pathological features:
• ~80% of all strokes are ischaemic rather than haemorrhagic
• Of these, as many as 50% are caused by atherosclerosis at
the carotid artery bifurcation
• This leads to either distal or thrombotic occlusion
Symptoms:
• Amaurosis fugax:
o Microembolism to the eye leads to ipsilateral transient
loss of vision
o Described as a black curtain coming across the eye
o Usually lasts from a few seconds to a few minutes
o A larger embolus may cause permanent blindness due
to a retinal infarct
• Embolisation to the middle cerebral artery leads to
hemispheric symptoms:
o Usually a contralateral hemiparesis
o Loss of speech (if the dominant hemisphere is affected)
• Transient ischaemic attack (TIA):
o A focal neurological deficit lasting less than 24 hours.
The major complication of carotid artery disease is a
stroke
Signs:
• The neurological findings and their duration are consistent
with the size of the area of brain affected
Management:
• Indications for carotid endarterectomy (CEA):
o In cases of amaurosis fugax, TIA or stroke with good
recovery plus an internal carotid artery stenosis of
>70%, the risk of future stroke is significantly reduced
by CEA carried out as a supplement to best medical
therapy alone
473
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Most stenoses <70% should be treated medically
• Technique for CEA:
o The major complication of CEA is a stroke
o The benefits of the operation depend crucially upon a
low perioperative stroke rate, which should be less
than:
• 7.5% after a previous stroke
• 5% in amaurosis fugax or TIA
• 3% in those who are asymptomatic
• Balloon angioplasty:
o Early data suggests that the immediate complication
rate from endovascular treatment is higher than that
associated with CEA
474
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Defined as ‘rest pain which requires strong (opiate) analgesia
for a period of 2 weeks or more, and tissue loss, in
association with an ABPI of <50mmHg’
• The inference is that, without intervention, a patient with CLI
will come to major amputation within weeks or months
Symptoms:
• Rest pain is indicative of severe ischaemia, usually felt in the
forefoot and, typically, the pain is worse at night and disturbs
sleep
• The reasons for this are:
o Metabolic rate in the foot is increased under the warm
bedclothes
o Cardiac output and BP fall during sleep
o The beneficial effect of gravity on pedal BP is lost
• For these reasons, relief at night is often sought by hanging
the leg over the side of the bed or walking about on a cold
floor
Signs:
• In addition to the findings of arterial insufficiency, there may
be evidence of multilevel disease
• Constant pain in the foot with single level arterial disease is
uncommon and should lead to a search for other causes
• Ischaemic tissue is extremely sensitive to injury; even minor
wounds fail to heal and ulceration follows
• Minor damage quickly leads to infection and bacterial toxins
destroy yet more tissue
• Frank gangrene then ensues and can spread extremely
rapidly, especially in diabetics
Medical management:
• In contrast to a presentation with claudication, rest pain is a
warning that tissue loss is imminent
• In the great majority, CLI does not improve without surgical
intervention but medical therapies have important roles:
o Assessment and treatment of heart failure, intercurrent
infection and anaemia
o Control of diabetes
o Antibiotic therapy for local infection
o Pain relief
o Use of anticoagulants and, occasionally, prostacyclin-
based drugs when tissue loss is minimal
475
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• All of these measures can ensure that an optimum condition is
achieved before surgical intervention is performed
Balloon angioplasty:
• In patients with early rest pain and/or minimal tissue loss
(subcritical ischaemia), PTA may tip the balance just enough
to salvage the limb when surgical reconstruction is not
feasible
• However, some believe that all patients with CLI should in the
first instance be managed with PTA and that operation should
be reserved for those who do not respond
Amputation:
• This is a last resort
• Primary amputation can be the best option in the elderly frail
patient with extensive tissue loss, but mortality is inevitably
high
Surgery:
• Bypass surgery and, to a far lesser extent, local
endarterectomy are the mainstays of treatment, although the
frequently present multisystem medical and vascular
problems dictate a mortality for limb salvage surgery of up to
10%
• Aortoiliac disease:
o In CLI, this is usually associated with infra-inguinal
disease
o In younger, fitter patients who are considered
unsuitable for PTA, the standard operation is
aortobifemoral bypass graft
o In those not fit for aortic surgery, an extra-anatomical
bypass may be suitable. For example, if there is an iliac
occlusion on one side and a relatively disease-free
vessel on the other, a femorofemoral crossover graft is
possible
• Femorodistal bypass:
o This refers to an arterial reconstruction below the
inguinal ligament in which common femoral or
superficial femoral arteries are the site of proximal
anastomosis and the popliteal or tibial vessels are the
site of distal anastomosis
• The requirements for a successful distal bypass are:
o Good inflow
o A reliable conduit
o Good outflow
476
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
477
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Overview:
• Is the mildest manifestation of lower limb ischaemia (LLI)
• Affects ~5% of men >60 years of age
• In the majority, it is the consequence of narrowing or
occlusion of the superficial femoral artery in the thigh
Symptoms:
• Ischaemic muscle pain on walking that is relieved by rest
• To begin walking again causes re-arrest after the same
distance has been travelled
• At rest, the blood requirement is met by the collateral
circulation through the profunda femoris system:
o Joins the popliteal artery below the blockage usually
just above the knee
• However, exercise produces a demand which cannot be met
and the calf muscles become ischaemic
• Cycling may be used as an alternative to walking as this relies
predominantly on the thigh muscles
• If stenosis is more proximal (aortoiliac), then pain is felt in
the whole leg and even the buttock if the blood flow to the
internal iliac artery is compromised
• Leriche syndrome:
o Difficulty or impossibility of sustaining an erection
o Consequent upon an aortoiliac obstruction
Signs:
• The limb may be obviously ischaemic
• Pulses are usually diminished or absent below the femoral
but, if they are present, exercise causes their disappearance
Diagnosis:
• There are many causes of pain in the leg, of which arterial
disease is only one
• Much of the time of a vascular service is spent excluding other
disorders
• Pain that radiates from the back, hip and knee joint, OA and
venous outflow obstruction (venous claudication) may all be
difficult to distinguish from true arterial claudication
Management:
• Arterial claudication is common, but progression to critical
ischaemia is unlikely
• Anxious patients should be reassured that amputation is
unlikely
478
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• The risks for arterial surgery or amputation are <1-2% per
year
• However, certain patients are at risk of disease progression,
including those who:
o Present with severe claudication of less than 50m
o Have low ABPI (<0.5)
o Have multilevel or distal disease
o Are diabetic
o Continue to smoke
• Such patients need careful assessment, aggressive treatment
of risk factors and the offer of reconstruction or endovascular
therapy if and when critical limb ischaemia develops
Medical therapy:
• For many years, the standard treatment for the majority of
patients has been to stop smoking and keep walking
• All should be:
o Reassured that the legs are not in imminent danger
o Warned about the hazards of continued smoking
o Screened and treated for correctable risk factors (e.g.
diabetes, hyperlipidaemia)
o Told to exercise regularly to the point of pain in order to
develop collateral circulation
• The majority accept the wisdom of this advice and attempt to
alter their lifestyle
• However, a proportion will not comply and/or will not accept
their level of disability and in these, intervention may have to
be considered
Surgical intervention:
• Percutaneous transluminal angioplasty (PTA)
• Operation
Operation:
• Aortoiliac (supra-inguinal) disease:
o There is a lower threshold for reconstruction in this
arterial segment because:
• The ability to compensate for aortoiliac occlusion by
formation of collaterals is not as good as it is in
infra-inguinal disease
• The long-term result of aortoiliac reconstruction is
considerably better than in infra-inguinal bypass;
more than 80% of aortobifemoral grafts for
claudication are patent at 10 years
• Bilateral claudication can be corrected by a single
operation
479
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Those affected by aortoiliac disease are generally
younger and more likely to have their livelihood
threatened by their disability
o Infra-inguinal disease:
• By contrast, there is much less enthusiasm for infra-
inguinal bypass because:
o Compensation by collateral development is often
good
o At 5 years, less than 70% of femoropopliteal
grafts are still patent
o Bilateral claudication is common, requires 2
operations and so doubles the risk
o Insertion of a bypass graft leads to involution of
collateral pathways; if the graft blocks, the
patient nearly always returns to a worse level of
ischaemia than that present before operation
• Rest pain may develop after a failed graft and force re-
operation; the long-term results of such procedures are less
impressive than those of primary reconstruction
480
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Raynaud’s phenomenon
Overview:
• Raynaud’s phenomenon (RP):
o Is the general term which describes the clinical features
of episodic digital vasospasm in the absence of an
identifiable associated disorder
• Secondary Raynaud’s syndrome (RS):
o This is when the phenomenon occurs secondary to one
of the conditions listed below
481
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• There are 3 phases:
o Pallor – because of digital artery spasm
o Cyanosis – from the accumulation of deoxygenated
blood
o Redness (rubor) – reactive hyperaemia as blood flow
returns
• Pain is usual unless there are other complications (e.g. digital
ulceration and gangrene)
Diagnosis:
• In the majority, the diagnosis of RP can be made on
symptoms and physical findings; additional investigations are
not required unless secondary RS is suspected
• Only a minority have clear evidence of connective tissue
disease at presentation
• Presentation for the first time in childhood or over the age of
30 increases the likelihood of RS
• 80% of those who present >60 years of age have an
underlying disorder (although it is most likely atherosclerosis)
Medical management:
• Most often, reassurance about the usually benign nature of
their condition, advice to stop smoking and to avoid exposure
to cold are sufficient
• Numerous drugs have been used, the best of which appears
to be the calcium-channel blocker nifedipine, although side-
effects are common
• Vasodilators may also be useful
• In those with severe attacks:
o Admission to hospital for a 5-day infusion of
prostacyclin may provide great symptomatic relief in the
winter months and, for unknown reasons, the beneficial
effects may last up to 6 weeks
Surgical management:
• Secondary RS caused by macrovascular arterial disease is
nearly always unilateral and may progress rapidly to tissue
loss in the hand if the underlying lesion is not identified and
treated
• Sympathectomy is useful in the long-term treatment of RS in
the feet, but NOT in the hand
• In the variant CREST syndrome, digits affected by severe
ulceration or calcium deposits may require amputation
482
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Clinical features:
• Diabetics have a tendency to develop, often quite suddenly,
severe ischaemia and infection in the feet which progresses to
rapid tissue necrosis and amputation
• There are 4 reasons for this:
o Vascular disease
o Sensory neuropathy
o Autonomic neuropathy
o Motor neuropathy
Vascular disease:
• In diabetics, this develops earlier in life and tends to be more
extensive and distal
• The clinical features are similar to non-diabetic vascular
disease except that a palpable popliteal pulse is more
frequently present, due to the more distal distribution of the
disease (particularly affecting the tibial vessels)
Sensory neuropathy:
• Reduces or abolishes protective reactions to minor injury and
to symptoms of infection or ischaemia
Autonomic neuropathy:
• Causes a lack of sweating and the development of dry,
fissured skin which permits entry of bacteria
Motor neuropathy:
• Results in:
o Wasting and weakness of the small muscles
o Loss of the longitudinal and transverse arches of the
foot
o Development of abnormal pressure areas, such as over
the metatarsal heads
Management:
• Tissue loss is neuropathic or ischaemic, or more commonly a
combination of both (neuroischaemic)
• The principles of management are:
o Best medical care for the diabetes
o Wide debridement of devitalised tissue
o Drainage of pus
o Revascularisation (if ischaemia is present)
483
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Traumatic arteriovenous fistula
Clinical features:
• Pain
• Swelling
• Other features of distal ischaemia
• If the shunt is large, then, over some weeks and months,
cardiac failure may develop
• Palpable thrill
• Machinery bruit on auscultation throughout the cardiac cycle
• Distal venous engorgement may develop
Management:
• Surgical repair is indicated
• Other techniques may be used:
o Embolisation
o Covering the fistulous opening in the artery with a stent
484
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Varicose veins
Epidemiology:
• Female:male ratio of 3:1
• ~2% of the population
• Up to 50% of 65-75 year olds may have them
• The major complication is the nutritional change in the skin
which may eventually go on to ulceration
Classification:
• Primary:
o Poorly understood aetiology
o There is deep to superficial incompetence only
o The varicosities appear without an obvious underlying
cause
• Secondary:
o The varicosities occur because of some other cause:
• Obstruction
• Thrombo-inflammatory destruction of valves, in both
the communicating and deep veins
485
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• Skin atrophy
Investigations:
• The investigations described below are for localisation of
incompetent deep to superficial communications and for
identification of valvular insufficiency in deep veins
• Continuous wave ultrasound:
o Used to detect points of incompetence, e.g. at the
saphenofemoral junction
• Duplex Doppler scanning:
o The anatomy can be clearly shown
o Valves can be visualised
o Reflux is demonstrated by the reversal of the direction
of flow using the same principle as with continuous flow
Doppler
• Venous pressure studies:
o Not used routinely
o Helpful in sorting out a complex problem of recurrence
after surgery or of deep venous insufficiency
• Venography
Compression hose:
• The indications are:
o Mild symptoms
486
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
o Those without skin changes
o The elderly
o Those who refuse other treatment
o Most pregnant women
• Patients should be instructed to apply compression hose
before they get up in the morning and only remove the
support last thing at night
Compression sclerotherapy:
• The principle is to produce sterile chemical inflammation in a
vein kept empty by compression; thrombosis and obliteration
of the lumen follow
• The solutions most commonly used are 5% ethanolamine
oleate or 3% sodium tetradecyl sulphate
• The method is suitable only for isolated varices without a
large site of deep to superficial incompetence, because if this
exists, recurrence rates are very high
• Further uses are:
o Obliteration of isolated incompetent perforating veins,
especially after surgery
o Vulval varices which persist after pregnancy
Surgery:
Technique:
• Aim is to interrupt, by ligation, the major points of
incompetence between the superficial and deep venous
systems
• To remove, if appropriate, the varices for both functional and
cosmetic reasons
• Can be done as day-surgery cases
487
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Vascular trauma
Mechanisms:
• The commonest non-iatrogenic cause of injury to blood
vessels in the UK is RTAs (usually blunt injuries)
• Penetrating injuries (e.g. knife and gunshot wounds) are
much less frequent
• Iatrogenic injury to the brachial and common femoral arteries
form angiography and angioplasty are by far the commonest
examples
• If the injury is caused by a sharp instrument, such as a knife,
the arterial or venous wound tends to be limited to the area of
immediate injury and the remaining vessel is uninjured
• In some, particularly high-velocity, missile wounds or in blunt
trauma, the extent of the injury is often more extensive, in
terms of both the vascular injury and the associated injuries
in other systems
Clinical features:
• The 2 principle consequences of arterial injury are:
o Haemorrhage:
• Blood loss tends to be greater if there is only
partial rather than complete transaction
• This is because in partial transaction, the
laceration is held open by the continuity part of
the wall, whereas in complete transaction
vasospasm and intimal retraction with thrombosis
occur, which limits loss
o Ischaemia:
• This is often severe because the injury is acute
and the vasculature has previously been normal;
there has not been any opportunity for collaterals
to become established
Physical findings:
• In young people, provided that systolic BP is >100mmHg,
peripheral pulses should be readily palpable
• Absent or diminished pulsation should immediately alert the
clinician to the likelihood of vascular injury
• In a closed injury, an expanding haematoma may be palpable
• Doppler examination:
o An audible Doppler signal may be present from a collateral
circulation even if the artery is transacted proximally
o However, in the lower limb, if the ABPI does not equal that
of the uninjured side, vascular injury should be suspected
488
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Investigation:
• Angiography should be considered in any instance where
there is doubt about the diagnosis or where the site of injury
is uncertain
Management:
• Resuscitation
• Immediate control of haemorrhage by direct pressure and
then operation rapidly to restore flow are essential
• The latter is achieved either by direct repair of the artery and
accompanying large veins , if possible, or by means of a
bypass graft
• Because of the risk of infection, prosthetic materials should be
avoided wherever possible
• All patients who sustain vascular trauma should receive
appropriate antibiotics and, when indicated, tetanus
prophylaxis
• The use if thromboembolic prophylaxis has to be decided on
an individual basis and must balance the risks of thrombosis
against those of haemorrhage
• The risk of reperfusion injury is greatest in vascular trauma
and fasciotomy is frequently indicated for prevention
489
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Epidemiology:
• 80-85% of leg ulcers are of venous origin
• 70% of those with active ulcers are >70 years of age
• Female:male ratio of 3:1
Aetiology:
• Oedema from venous HT and raised pressure at the venular
end of the capillary loop, skin and subcutaneous hypoxia are
and an episode of minor trauma are the usual pathological
antecedents of ulceration
• They are most likely to occur when there is damage to the
valves of the deep veins, but long-standing superficial HT
caused by deep to superficial incompetence alone is also a
well recognised cause
• Once an ulcer is established, healing of the poorly nourished
skin is difficult and granulation tissue and a fibrous base
develops
• The build-up of fibrosis with reduced input into the tissue from
the arterial side of the circulation is a further impediment to
healing
• Secondary infections by skin residents such as staphylococci
are common
Clinical features:
• The lesion occurs almost exclusively just above or in relation
to the medial malleolus
• It is usually:
o Oval
o Flat, without a raised edge
o Looks relatively healthy
o Has a granulating base
o Concomitant infection (with either surrounding
erythema or extensive cellulitis) may be present
490
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Venous Arterial
History Previous DVT, varices Intermittent
claudication, IHD,
HT, DM
Pain Uncommon Nearly always
present, worse at
night
Site Usually medial Toes, heal, foot,
malleolus lateral aspect
Size Variable, increases Variable but
slowly increases rapidly
Oedema Common, worse at Uncommon
night
Skin Pigmentation, white Shiny, thin, atrophic
patches nails
Temperature Usually warm Cool
Foot pulses Present Reduced or absent
Management:
• Most venous ulcers which are correctly diagnosed and treated
early respond readily to conventional treatment, but even
relatively small lesions can take up to 3 months to heal
• More chronic lesions require a more precise regimen, as
follows:
o Step 1:
• Establish if there is correctable superficial venous HT
which is the consequence of deep to superficial
incompetence only
• If this is so, surgery is indicated
o Step 2:
• If there are multiple points of incompetence or, what
almost always amounts pathophysiologically to the
same thing, deep venous damage, the starting point
is non-operative management
• The majority of leg ulcers fall into this category
• The essential component is to apply effective
compression to the limb and sustain it until the ulcer
has healed
• All venous ulcers heal if the patient is confined to
bed with the foot elevated above the heart so that
venous HT is abolished, the microenvironment
improved and healing promoted
491
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
• However, bed rest is a costly and, therefore, usually
inappropriate method
• Adequate local compression in a patient who is
otherwise mobile is an effective alternative
o Step 3:
• This runs concurrently with steps 1 and 2
• Is local management of the lesion
• The inappropriate use of topical agents, included
impregnated bandages, prescribed by either a
physician or a nurse should be AVOIDED
• Dressings are kept simple and pharmacologically
active substances applied only for specific and logical
reasons – which means hardly ever
• Systemic antibiotic therapy is only indicated if there
is spreading cellulitis – topical applications are
ineffective in controlling contamination unless the
causes of the ulcer are dealt with
492
Copyright Garry KJ Pettet 2004
Please consider donating (garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk)
http://www.igarry.com
Remember…
garry.pettet@imperial.ac.uk
or visit:
http://www.igarry.com
(where there are some forums to chat on as well!)
493